ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﻡ .ﺩﺑﻠﻴﻮ .ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺗﻠﺨﻴﺺ :ﺏ .ﮐﻮﺷﺎ
...
56 downloads
846 Views
17MB Size
Report
This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
Report copyright / DMCA form
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﻡ .ﺩﺑﻠﻴﻮ .ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺗﻠﺨﻴﺺ :ﺏ .ﮐﻮﺷﺎ
9ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺍﻭﻝ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ) ( ٢٠٠٤ ﺍﺛﺮ :ﻣﺎﻳﮑﻞ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺗﻠﺨﻴﺺ :ﺏ .ﮐﻮﺷﺎ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺍﻭﻝ
ﺯﻣﺴﺘﺎﻥ ١٣٨٧
ﻆ ﺍﻧﺴﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺍﺷﮑﺎﻝ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﺖ ﺍﺻﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻣﺎﻧﺖ ﺩﺍﺭي ﻭ ﺣﻔ ِ 9ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻋﺎﻳ ِ
ﺗﻘﺪﻳﻢ ﺑﻪ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﮕﺮ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺱ ﮊﺭﻑ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺶ ﺁﻣﻮﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ
ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺁﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﭘﻮﺭ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ
١
ﺖ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ ﻓﻬﺮﺳ ِ ﺳﺨﻨﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ٢ ………………..………………………………………………………………… : ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﺮﺍﻥ ٤……………………………..………………………………… : ﻧﮑﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ٥….………………………………………………………………… : ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ :ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ﻫﺎ ١١ ............................................................................................ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ :ﺁﺷﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ٩٥.......................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ :ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ١٠٣ .............................................................................................................................. ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ :ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ١٢٧ ........................................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ١٨٧ ............................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ٢١٢ .............................................................................................................. ( ١ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ٢٤٦ .............................................................................................................. ( ٢ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ :ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ٢٧٧ ...................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ :ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ٣٤١ ...................................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻫﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝﹺ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ) ٣٦٦ .................................................................................................. ( ١ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻳﺎﺯﺩﻫﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝﹺ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ) ٣٨٦ ................................................................................................ ( ٢ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﺍﺯﺩﻫﻢ :ﭼﺎﻗﻲ ٤٣١ .......................................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻴﺰﺩﻫﻢ :ﺟﻨﺲ ،ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ٤٤٩ ................................................................................................. ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﺩﻫﻢ :ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ٤٩٢ ........................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞﹺ ﭘﺎﻧﺰﺩﻫﻢ :ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ٥٢٧ ................................................................................................................ ﻓﺼﻞﹺ ﺷﺎﻧﺰﺩﻫﻢ :ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ٥٦٠ .......................................................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺪﻫﻢ :ﺭﻭﻳﺎ ٦٠٣ ............................................................................................................................. ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺠﺪﻫﻢ :ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺕ ٦٣٣ ............................................................................................................ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻮﺯﺩﻫﻢ :ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺕ ٦٧٦ ..................................................................................... ﻓﺼﻞ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ :ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ٧٣٧ ...........................................................................................................................
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﺳﺨﻨﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ : ﺏ » Psychology: An International ﺶ ﺍﻭ ﹺﻝ ﮐﺘﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺍﺛﺮي ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺭﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻓﺎﺭﺳ ﹺ « Perspectiveﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻡ .ﺩﺑﻠﻴﻮ .ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ١ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ٢٠٠٤ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﺍﻡ .ﺩﺑﻠﻴﻮ .ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ،ﭘﺮﻭﻓﺴﻮﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﺭﺋﻴﺲﹺ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻫﺎﻟﻮﻭي ﻟﻨﺪﻥ – ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻬﺎﺩﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﻳﺘﺎﻧﻴﺎ -ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺮﻳﺘﺎﻧﻴﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭ ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ٣٠ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺺ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﻘﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﻠﻴﺴﻲ ﻣﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺗﺨﺼ ﹺ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻂ ﺍﻭ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﮐﺎﺭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻧﻴﺰ ،ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺯ ٦ﺑﺨﺶ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ي ﺍﻧﮕﻠﻴﺴ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻟﻬﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎﻅ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮﻧﺪ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﻟﻮﻳﺖ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﻭ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻮﮐﻮﻝ ﮐﻨﻢ . M.W.Eysenck ١
٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻳﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﻻﻳﻠﻲ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ PDFﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺩﻻﻳﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﻞ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ١٣٨٨ﻗﻴﻤﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺷﺪﻡ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ١٥ﺗﺎ ٢٠ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﺗﻮﻣﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎ ﻫﺪﻑ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﺎ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺖ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺖ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜﺮﻳ ِ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ PDFﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﻫﻤﮕﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﺳﺎﺯﻡ . ﻞ ﺍﺩﺍﺭي ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺗﻲ ﺁﻥ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﻢ ،ﻃﻲ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻥِ ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﺩﻭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺗﺎﺯﮔﻲ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩ . ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻡ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ﻭﺳﻔﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﻌﺎﺩ ﻭ ﮐﻴﻔﻴﺘﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﻢ .
٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﺮﺍﻥ : ﻲ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﺏ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻫﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻨﺪﮐﺘﺎ ﹺ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺻﺮﻑ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺤﺖ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺟﺰ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺳﻄﺤﻲ ،ﺁﻣﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺧﺮﺍﻓﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻢ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺐ ﺩﺷﻮﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻋﺎﻣﻪ ي ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻧﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺪِﻓﺎﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎ ،ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﻄﺎﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺟﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺑﻬﺎﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺑﻴﺶ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎ ،ﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺣﻴﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺵ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺳﻄﺤﻲ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻥ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻏﺎﻓﻠﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺴﺘﺮ ﹺ ﺗﺨﺼﺼﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺏ ﺑﺴﺘﻦ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴﻢ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ " .ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﺶ ﺩﻳﺪي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻭ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻖ ﻣﻘﺘﻀﻴﺎﺕ ،ﻣﺴﺘﻌ ِﺪ ﻗﺒﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺸﮑﻞ ﮔﺸﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ،ﺍﻓﺴﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﮐﺮﺍﻣﺖ ﺁﻣﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﺗﺒﻠﻴ ﹺﻎ ﻣﻮﺍﻓ ﹺ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ،ﻭ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺟﺎﺩﻭ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻣﺮﻣﻮﺯي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺮﺩ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺎ ،ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﮐ ِ ﺖ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺑﺎ ﻗﻠﻨﺪﺭي ،ﭼﻠﻪ ﻧﺸﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﻃﻠﺴﻢ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻭ ﺟﻦ ﮔﻴﺮي ،ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻁ ﻣﺄﻧﻮﺱ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ،ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺷﺘﻬﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺍﻟﻪ ي ﺵ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﻬﺪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻄﺤﻲ ﻭ ﺯﺑﺎﻟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻧﺒﺎﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ١" .ﺍﻣﻴﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻼ ﹺ ﻧﻮﮔﺮﺍ ،ﻫﺮ ﭼﻪ ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﮑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﻲ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﻭ ﭘﻮﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺟﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.
١ﺍﻗﺘﺒﺎﺱ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻘﺎﻟﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪﻳﺴﻢ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺁﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﭘﻮﺭ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺁﺧﺮ
٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﻧﮑﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ : ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﻪ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ " ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺘﺨﺼﺼﺎﻥ ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ".ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺭﺍ ﻭﺭﻕ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ ،ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺩﻋﺎي ﺗﻮﺧﺎﻟﻲ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺘﺎﺳﻔﺎﻧﻪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮﻝ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﺩﻋﺎﻫﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻳﻢ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻞ ،ﺟﺰ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻌﺪﻭﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺁﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﭘﻮﺭ ،ﻧﻮﺭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻴﺨﺘﻪ ،ﻣﺤﻤﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ ،ﻋﺒﺪﺍﻟﺤﺴﻴﻦ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺗﻦ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ... ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺟﺎﻣﻪ ي ﻋﻤﻞ ﻧﭙﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ. ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻣﺘﻮ ِﻥ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﻓﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺍي ﮔﺬﺭﺍ ﻭ ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺘﻦ ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ﻭ ﻣﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺣﺘﻲ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩﻧﺪ.ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺿﻊ، ﺑﺮﺍي ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﭼﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﺸﮑﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮓ ﻭ ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪ )ﻏﻴﺮﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ( ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺳﺮﺩﺭﮔﻢ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﻧﺎﺍﻣﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ).ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﭘﺎﻭﺭﻗﻲ ﻭ ...ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺟﺒﺮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺮﺩﺭﮔﻢ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺨﺎﻃﺐ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﻨﺪ(.
ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻣﺘﻮﻥ ﺗﺨﺼﺼﻲ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﮕﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻣﺘﻮﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺤﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺳﻨﮕﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻓﺸﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ،ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﺖ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺸﺮﺩﮔ ﹺ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭي ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺏ ﻧﺎﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ.
٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﻭ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ : ﻑ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺨﺼﺼﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻫﺪﻑ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻏﻴﺮﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ♣ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ،ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍي ﺁﻥ ﺁﻧﻘﺪﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻫﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻫﻞ ﻓﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺳﻮﺩﻣﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ! ♣ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍي ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻭ ﻓﺸﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ،ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺎﻥ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ " ﮐﺘﺎﺑﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﻳﮑﺒﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ! " . ﺕ ﺭﻭﺯﺍﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺳﺮﻳﺎﻝ ♣ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻄﺒﻮﻋﺎ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻧﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﺒﻠﻲ ﻓﮑﺮي ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺮﻭي ﻓﮑﺮي ﺻﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ♣ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﮔﺎﻧﻲ ﻭﺯﻳﻦ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻓﻨﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﻨﻢ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻡ .ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺍي ﻓﻨﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻡ ﺗﻼﺵ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻡ ﺗﺎ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﺳﺎﺯﻡ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﭼﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻮﻓﻖ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ♣ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴﻢ ،ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺒﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﻧﻮﻳﺲ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻋﻠﺖ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ : .١ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺗﻌﺎﺭﻳ ِ ﻒ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻦ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﻋﻤﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺑﻨﺪﺩ. .٢ﺑﺮ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ،ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺫﻫ ﹺ
٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﻞ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﻴﺎﻓﺰﺍﻳﻢ ،ﺍﺯ ﻧﻤﺎ ِﺩ } { ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ♣ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﮐﻪ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺩﻳﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎﺗﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻦ ﺩﻭ } { ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻡ .ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺖ eﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺒﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﺩﺭﻫﺎي ﺭﻧﮕﻲ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻋﻼﻣ ِ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺿﺎﻓﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﮐﺎﺩﺭﻫﺎي ﺭﻧﮕﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻼﻣﺖ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻﻞ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ . ﻑ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ♣ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺭﺳ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻣﺎﻧﺖ ﺩﺍﺭي ﺣﻔﻆ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﺪ ِ ﺐ ﺵ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺨﺎﻃ ﹺ ﻑ ﻧﻮﻳﺴﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﮕﺎﺭ ﹺ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻫﺪ ِ ﺐ ﻧﻮﻳﺴﻨﺪﻩ ،ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎﻥ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻏﻴﺮﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﺍﻣﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺨﺎﻃ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍي ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻢ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ » ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ« ﺭﺍ ﺍﻭﻻً ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺚ ﻞ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭي ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺤ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺗﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻞ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭي ﻭ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ » ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ « ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺼ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ، ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺣﺬﻑ ﮐﻨﻢ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﻭ ﻣﺒﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺐ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺍﻓﺰﻭﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺖ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻧﻮﺁﻣﻮﺯ ﻣﻄﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻧﮕﻴﺮﻳﻢ . ♣ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻫﺮ ﻓﺼﻞ ،ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻫﺪﻑ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻢ . ♣ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ) ﺑﻪ ﺟﺰ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﻨﺞ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ( ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﻓﺰﻭﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .
٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ي ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺑﺨﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻠﻲ ﻣﻮﻓﻖ ﻧﺸﺪﻡ ﺗﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ♣ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﺖ ﻋﺪ ﹺﻡ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻣﺘﻦِ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﻢ .ﮐﻮﺷﺶ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻘﺺ ﺩﺭ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳﺶِ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺭﻓﻊ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺍﺟﻌﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﻦِ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ . ♣ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ي PDFﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﺖِ Full Screenﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .
♣ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﻃﺮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ : ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ،ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺳﭙﺲ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺕ ﻣﻮﺿﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ. ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺳﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻧﻘﺎﻁ ﺿﻌﻒ ﻭ ﻗﻮ ِ
ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ،
ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻭ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﺗﺤﻠﻴﻞ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ
٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
ﻭ ﺳﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ : ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻨﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﻋﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮي ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﻧﻘﺺ ﻫﺴﺘﻢ .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﺳﻌﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﻪ ﻧﮑﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺷﺪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﮐﻨﻢ ،ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺷﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻧﻮﺍﻗﺺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺳﺖ " .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﺳﭙﺎﻧﻴﺎﻳﻲ، ﺧﻄﺎ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﺧﻄﺎ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻥ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ" ) ! ١ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﻧﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ !! ( ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺗﺎ ﺶ ﺑﻌﺪ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﻣﻐﺮﺿﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺩﻟﺴﻮﺯﺍﻧﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺍﻗﺺ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﻃﺮﻑ ﺳﺎﺯﻡ.ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻡ.ﮐﻮﺷﺎ ﺗﺸﮑﺮ ﮐﻨﻢ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺼﻞِ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭيِ ﺍﻭ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻡ . ﺖ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ،ﻃﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺭﻡ ﺗﺸﮑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻢ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﺣﻤﺎﻳ ِ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﻧﺒﻮﺩ . ﺏ .ﮐﻮﺷﺎ ﺯﻣﺴﺘﺎﻥ ١٣٨٧
١ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻳﻴﻦ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺁﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﭘﻮﺭ -ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٥
٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﺎﺭ
١٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١١
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ :ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ﻫﺎ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٢
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ :
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١١ ................................................................................................................................. ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ :ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ﻫﺎ ١١ ................................................................................................. ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٢ ....................................................................................................................... : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ؟ ١٤ ....................................................................................................................... ﺗﻨﻮﻉﹺ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺚ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ١٥ .............................................................................................................. : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ٢١ ........................................................................................................................ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ٢٤ ...................................................................................................................... : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ٢٤ ...................................................................................................................... : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ٢٧ ............................................................................................................ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ٢٩ .......................................................................................................................... : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ٣١ ...................................................................................................................... : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ٣٣ ...................................................................................................................... : ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ٣٥ ....................................................................................................... : ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ؟ ٣٨ .................................................................................... ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ٤٦ ................................................................................................................ : ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮيﹺ ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ) ٥٠ ........................................................................................... : ( hindsight bias ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ٥٢ ............................................................................................................ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ٥٥ ................................................................................................................ : ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي ٥٧ .......................................................................................................... : ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻥِ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻬﺎ ٥٩ .............................................................................................................. : ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭي ٦٠ .......................................................................................................................... : ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭي ٦١ ............................................................................................................................ : ﺗﻌﺼﺒﺎﺕ ٦٢ .................................................................................................................................. : ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ٦٣ .............................................................................................................. : ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ٦٩ ................................................................................................................. : ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ ٧٩ ........................................................................................................................ :
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٣
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ٨١ ................................................................................................................... : ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ٩٤ ...................................................................................................... :
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٤
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ١ﭼﻴﺴﺖ؟ ﻖ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ.٢ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻴﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺶ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻗﺎﺋﻞ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﺴﺖ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻋﻠﺖ ﻭ ﺶ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ،ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎ ٣ﻭ ﭼﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ٤ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻒ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﻴﻢ : ﻧﮑﺎﺕ ،ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺷﻮﺍﻫ ِﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻓﻬﻤﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻳﺪ.
Psychology ١ : behaviour ٢ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ،ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺎﺑﻞِ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [١ : process ٣ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻌﺎﻧﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻡِ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ي ﻻﺗﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲِ » ﭘﻴﺶ ﺭﻓﺘﻦ« ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖِ ﮔﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﻫﺪﻓﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭِ ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡِ » ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ « ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮِ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤﺖِ ﻳﮏ ﻫﺪﻑِ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( -١ motive ٤ﺣﺎﻟﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﻫﺪﻑ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺭﻫﺒﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ – ٢.ﺩﻟﻴﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺵ ﺫﮐﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﻋﻠﻲ ﺍﮐﺒﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ (
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٥
ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺚ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ : ﮎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺸﺮ ﻦ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ١ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻴ ﹺ ي ﻫﺮ ﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺳﺮﺩﺭﮔﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﻳﺪ .ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺳﻬﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ } .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺢ ﻳﮏ ﺡ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄﻮ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ {؛ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻫﺴﺘﻴﻢ.
ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺫﮐﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ: ﻣﺮﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺧﺸﻢ ﻭ ﻏﻀﺐ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺸﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﮑﺮﺭي ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺍﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﺪ .ﭼﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ؟ ﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺑﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ﺍﻭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻣﺜﻼً ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺧﺸﻮﻧﺖ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ. ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻞ ﮔﻴﺮ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺮﺍﻓﻴ ِ ﮏ ﺳﻨﮕﻴﻦ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﻢ ﺙ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺯﺍي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﻪ ي ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﻪ ي ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺿﺪ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺍﻓﮑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮﻫﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺖ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑﺶ ﻣﺸﺎﺟﺮﻩ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﭼﻨﺪ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭﺳ ِ
: approach ١ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ " ﺍﺯ ﺯﺍﻭﻳﻪ ي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﻳﺴﺘﻦ " ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ : ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﻓﻘﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻋﻠﺖِ ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﺟﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺟﻨﺎﻳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﻢ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ي ﺟﺮﺍﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻳﻢ . ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺗﺮﺷﺤﺎﺕ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻋﻠﺖ ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﺟﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺟﻨﺎﻳﺖ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ِ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺟﺮﺍ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺧﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻢ . ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي approachﺭﺍ » ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ « ﻭ » ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ « ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ – .ﻡ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٦
ﻲ ﺍﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺖ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﺍﻭ ﺗﻮﻫﻴﻦ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﻧﺎﻣﺘﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻭ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺮﻩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺖ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧ ﹺ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺏ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﮓ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﻣﺸﺖ ﻭ ﻟﮕﺪ ﺯﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻞ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﺎﻧﻴﺖ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻣﺮي ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﺸﻤﻨﺎﮎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻌﺒﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺷﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.١
١ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲِ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﻫﻤﮑﻨﺶ ) ﺗﻌﺎﻣﻞ ( ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ! ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝِ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲِ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻴﺮﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺮﺍﻓﻴﮏ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺸﺎﺟﺮﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭﺳﺖِ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ...
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٧
◄ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻨﺎﻫﮕﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺎﺗﺮﻫﻮﺭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻮﻳﻴﺲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻓﮑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﭼﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻠﻪ ي ﺳﺮﺳﺨﺖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭘﻨﺠﻪ ﻧﺮﻡ ﮐﻨﺪ ؟
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ١٨
ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺑﻨﺪي ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﻂ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ( . ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ١ﻫﺎي ﻣﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﮏ ﺳﻨﮕﻴﻦ ( ﺕ ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﻣﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﮔﻴﺮ ﺍﻓﺘﺎﺩﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺮﺍﻓﻴ ِ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺗﻬﺎﺟﻤﻲ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮي ( ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ( ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ٢ﻣﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺎ ( ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ٣ﻣﺎ ) ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮐﺎﺕ ،ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ،ﺧﺎﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﻂ ٤ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﺎ }ﻣﺜﻼً ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺤﺮﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻗﺘﺼﺎﺩي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ { . ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﮓ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ( ﻂ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻣﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺯﺩ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺕ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ( ﻲ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ي ﻣﺎ ) ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﻣﺎ ) ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﻫﻮﺵ ،ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ١ﻭ ﺳﻼﻣﺖِ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ (
: Stimulus ١ﻫﺮ ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻭﺍﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( : physiology ٢ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﭙﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﭼﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﻭ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ) ( biologyﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ) ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﻳﺶ ﻭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ِ( ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ِ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩ ِ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻫﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ،ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﻭ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ – ﻡ : cognitive ٣ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ِ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ،ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﻴﺮي ،ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ِ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ..ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﮎِ ﺑﻬﺘﺮِ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ :ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ﻣﻲ ﺗﺮﺳﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢِ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻥِ ﺑﺪﻥِ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ،ﺑﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺗﺮﺱِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻄﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ِ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺗﺮﺱ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ -.ﻡ Environment ٤ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ -١ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻭ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﮔﺮﻣﺎي ﻫﻮﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻋﺎﻣﻞِ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﮕﺬﺍﺭﺩ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( -٢ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﻔﻮﺫي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻡ ِ ﺁﺑﺴﺘﻨﻲ ) ﻳﺎ ﻟﻘﺎﺡ ( ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ،ﺍﺯ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) ..ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳﺖِ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌﺖِ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸﺮِ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎﭖِ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ١٩
ﻞ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻫﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺳﻴﻊ ﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺜﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺮﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ،ﻗﻗﻠﻤﺮ ﹺﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺑﺎﻳﺴﺖ ﺭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺯ ﺤﺖ ﭘﻮﺷﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻣﻮﺛﺛﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤ ﻲ ﻠﻢ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ٢ﺩﺭ ١٩٩٤ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻋ ﻢﹺ ﺲ ﻭﺟﻬﻲ ٣ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪ ﻭ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ " ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻴﻠﻪ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ،٤ﺍﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ،٥ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻭ.... ﺭ ﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ،ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺳﺎﻥ، ي ﻓﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﺴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ،ﻋﺼﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﺪﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻧﮕﺮ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ".ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺖ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺳ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ، ﻲ ﺳ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ، ﺳ ﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺍﺻ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ. ﻲ ﺍﺟ ﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ،ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩي ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳ ﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺗﻬﺎي ي ﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﻋﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺳﻲ
ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﮊي
ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨ
ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻥ
ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ
ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳﻲ
ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺗﺪﺍﻭﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﻴﺖ ﻡ ﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ِ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﭘﺎﻳﺪﺍﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻃﻲ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﮔﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ : peﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ersonality ١ ( ٣٣٣ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ ،ﺻ ﻦ ﻦ ) ( ١٩٩٠ﻧﻘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي pervinﭘﺮﻭﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩn ) . ﻪ H. Eysenck ٢ multi – d disciplinaryy ٣ Zoologistts ٤ ي، ﺨﻲ ،ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻧﮋﺍﺩي ،ﺗﻮﺯﻳﻊ ﺟﻐﺮﺍﻓﻓﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺨ ، ﻟﺤﺎﻅ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﺎﺕ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ، ﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻅ : anthropologists ٥ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﺩ ﺑﻂ ،ﻣﺤﻴﻂِ ﻓﺮﻫﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٢٠
ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻠﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﺎﻁ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﭼﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺜ ﺖ ﻣﻮﺭﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺮ ﺨﺼﻴﺖ « ﺭﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺿﻮﻉ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﻣﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﺪ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻮﻁ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻤﻮﻧﻪ » ﺷﺨ ﻣﻮﺿ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ) ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺗﻬﺎي ي ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ( ،ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺪي ) ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺭﺭﺷﺪ ( ﻭ ﻓﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ي ﻞ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻲ ﺷﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ( ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺧﺘﻲ )ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ) ﻑ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺖ ﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻴﹺﺎﺟﺘﻤﺎﺎﻋﻲ ( ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺖ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺮﺳﺳﺪ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﻧﻴﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﻞ ﻒ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑ ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺨ ﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ: ﻲ ﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ﮑﺮﺩ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺻ ﺭﻭﻳﮑ
ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻬﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳﻲ
ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ
ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ
ﺭﺷﺪ
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺧﺘﻲ
ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ
ﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮﺮﹺ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺯ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ :
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٢١
ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ:١ ﺏ » ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﻧﻮﻮﺍﻉ « ٢ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺗﺼﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﻨﮑﻪ ﮐﺘﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﭼﺎﺭﺭﻟﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ (١٨٨٢ -١٨٠٩ ) ٣ﭼﭼﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺵ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﻧﺴ ﻋﻤﻴﻴﻘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺷﻴﻮﻮﻩ ي ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ .ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺩﺷﺎﻥ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ،١١٨٥٩ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻣﺮﺩﺩﻡ ﮔﻤﺎﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺍي ﺭﻭﺡ ﻳﻳﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﻣﺘﻤﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻭ ﺍ ﺖ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ٤ﻫﺎي ﻩ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺪ ﺷﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﺮﻳﻪ ٥ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﻣﻣﺎﻫﻴﺘﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺩﻳﮕ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺮ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ي ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﺩﺭﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺣﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺑﺎﺯﻧﮕﺮ ﹺ ﺚِ ﻀﺎي ﻗﻠﻤﺮﻭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻫﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺵ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﻀ ﻣﺤﻮﻮﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﭘﺬﻳﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺖ .٦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺩ
b biological p psychologyy ١ Origin n of Speciess ٢ Charrles Darwin n ٣ ﮕﺮ ﺗﺤﺖِ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂِ ﻃﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﻮﻉ ،ﮔﻮﻧﻪ .ﻭﺍﺣﺣﺪِ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺩﺩﻩ ﺑﻨﺪيِ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﺘﻲ .ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻥِ ﺳﺳﺎﺩﻩ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺖ : speciess ٤ ﻧﻮﻉ ﮑﻴﻞ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﺳﺐ ﻫﺎ ﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﻼ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻳﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺩ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻧﻲ ﺯﺍﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻲ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵِ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺖ ﮔﺎﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻮﻧﻪ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵِ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺯﺍﻳﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﺜﺜﻼً ﺍﺳﺐ ﻭ ﮔﺎ ﺵ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪِ ﺣﺎﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻗﺎﺩﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩ ﺗﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡِ » ﮔﻮﻧﻪ « ﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞِ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺗﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ي ﺭ ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﻴﺪ ] [٢ : theoryy ٥ ﺗﺌﻮﺭﺭي ،ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ [٣] e ٦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٢
ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻳﮏ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻭ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ : ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻧﺪ . ﺖ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺖ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺸﺎﻥ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ١ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺒﺮﻧﺪ . ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي )ﻣﺜﻼًﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ( ﺶ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺶ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺚ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﻳﺪ.
: Heredity ١ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ] [٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٣
ﮔﺴﺘﺮﻩ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﺎ ﮐﺠﺎﺳﺖ؟ ﻲ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻒ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ .ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺜﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﻭﻇﺎﻳ ِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ...ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ،ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﻔﺼﻞ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ.
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ؟ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩي ) ﺑﻪ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ( ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﮊﻥ١ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ﻲ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻫﻮﺵ ،ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ . ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻣﺎ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻴﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺻﻮﻻ ً ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺕ ﻲ ﺖ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮊﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺴﺘ ﹺ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺗﺨﺎ ِﺫ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺏ ﻧﺎﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .
: gens ١ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞِ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﻔﺼﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ – ﻡ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٢٤
ﻲ: ١ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻖ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮎ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺧﺖ ٢ﻭ ﺍﺩﺭﺭﺍ ِ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ﺫﻫﻦ ،٣ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻲ ﻦ ﺍﻓﮑﺎ ﮑﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻓﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺍﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﻧﺨﺴﺴﺘﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳﺳﻂ ِ ﺍﻓﻼﻃﻮﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺳﻄﻄﻮ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﻮﻮﺟﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﻭ ﺶ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺩﻭ ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮏ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﻤﻪ ﻢ ﺐ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ) ٤ ﻞﹺ ﻇﻬﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﮑ ﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ي ﺍﺍﻭﻝ ﻗﺮ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺴ ﮑﺘ ﹺ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲﹺ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ( ﺗﺎ ﺣﺣﺪي ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺮﺩ ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻦ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎً ﺑﺮ ﻓﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺩﺩﺭﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺎ ﻑ ﺭﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ، ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ .ﺑﺮﺧﻼ ِ ﻩ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺧﺘﻲ ﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﮎ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﺪ ﺖ ﻭ ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﺳﺎﺧﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﮑﺸﻨﻨﺮي ﺍﻧﮕﻠﻴﺴﺴﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺎ ﺖ " ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﮐﺎﻟﻴﻨﺰ ٥ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻴ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻲ ﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ " .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻃﺮﻳﻳﻖِ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺷﻨﺎﺎﺧﺖ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺕ ﻻﻻﺯﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺭﺩ ﺐ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺴ ﹺ ﻞ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮐﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ.٦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺧ ﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺑﻨﻴﻴﺎﺩ ﹺ
:Cﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥ Cognitive p psychologyy ١ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﮔﻔﺘﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﺣﺎ ﻲ ،ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕِ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ، : cognitionﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪِ ﮐﺴﺴﺐ ،ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻧﺪﻫﻲ n ٢ ﺼﻞ ﻋﻘﻠﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻓﺮﺩﺩ ،ﺫﻫﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ e.ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﺗﻤﺎﺎﻡ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻲ : mindﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺠ d ٣ ﺭﺟﻮﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ] [٦ Be ehaviorism m ٤ Colllins English h Dictionarry ٥ ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ][٧ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ e٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٥
ﺱ ﺖ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﺍﺳﻂ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ١٩٥٠ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﻪ )ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﻭﻧﺎﻟﺪ ﺑﺮﻭﺩﺑﻨﺖ ،ﺟﺮﻭﻣﻪ ﺑﺮﻭﻧﺮ،ﺟﺮﺝ ﻣﻴﻠﺮ ،ﻫﺮﺏ ﺳﻴﻤﻮﻥ ( ١ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﻞ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺁﻏﺎﺯ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻣﻔﺼ ﹺ ﻞ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺪ ،ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺩﺭ ﮐ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﺑﮕﺬﺍﺭﺩ.٢ ﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﻲ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ،٣ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ،٤ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ،٥ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ،ﺣ ﹺ ﺚ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﻣﺒﺎﺣ ِ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺮﻩ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ .ﺭﻭي ﻫﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺚ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺶ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺳﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﺎﻭﺭﺩ. ﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ي ﺑﻴﻦ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ
George Miller , Herb Simon ,Donald Broadbent , Jerome Bruner ١ e ٢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [٨ e attention ٣ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [٩ : perception ٤ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ،ﺩﺭﮎ e.ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [١٠ : learning ٥ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٦
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮ ِﺩ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺖ ﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﭙﻴﻮﺗﺮﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻬﻮﻟ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻃﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺰﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺷﮕﺮﻓﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺭﻭﺯﺍﻓﺰﻭﻧﻲ ﺶ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻖ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺎﻥ ) ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺣﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ،ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ( ...ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٢٧
ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩﺩي:١ ﮔﺎﻟﺘﻮﻥ،(١٩١١-١٨٢٢٢) ٢ ﻂ ﻓﻓﺮﺍﻧﺴﻴﺲ ﮔﺎ ﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺑﺑﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮ ﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻡ ﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ .ﺍﻧﻧﺘﺸﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺏ ﭘﺴﺮﺮﻋﻤﻮي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻭﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ » ﻧﺒﻮ ﹺﻍ ﻭﺭﺭﺍﺛﺘﻲ « ﮔﺎﻟﺘﺘﻮﻥ ،ﻧﻘﻄﻪ ي ﺁﻏﺎﺯي ﺑﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻟﻌﻪ ﮕﺎﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺑﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻓﻲ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﮕ ﮕﻔﺖ ي ﻞ ﺷﮕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺁﻥ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ي ﺗﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ي ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﮐﮐﻮﺍﭺ ٣ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ " ﺗﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺁﻥ ،ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ي ﺦ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳ ﻧﺸﺪﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺪ ﺟﻠﺐ ﮐﺮﺩ". ﺣﺴﺴﺎﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ .ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻨﻴﺴﺴﻢ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺐ
ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ -.ﻡ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ،ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻓﺘﺮﺍﻗﻗﻲ ﻫﻢ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي .ﺑﻪ ﻦ : individual dﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ي differencess ١ Sir Fran ncis Galton n ٢ Kovach & Murphyy ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٨
ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎً ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ي ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥِ ﺳﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ }،ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭼﭗ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ{ ﻭ.... ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻋﻤﻼ ً ،ﻣﺘﺨﺼﺼﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﺩﺭ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺜﻲ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﺪ ﭼﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ.
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻬﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺷﻌﺎﻉ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ،ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﺐ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺛﺮي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺗﮏ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺁﻣﻮﺯﺷ ﹺ ﮏ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺪﻑ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺷﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺗ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﺖ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ،ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼﻴ ِ ﻖ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺮﺳﺸﻨﺎﻣﻪ ي ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﻃﻮﺭي ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺰﻳﻨﺶ ﮐﺮﺩ . ﺁﻥ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﺑﺎ ﺷﺨﺼﻴ ِ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٢٩
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ:١ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﻫﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐ ﹺ ﺖ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻲ ﺟﻬﺖِ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻣﺮي ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻞ ﻗﺮﻥِ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﮑﺎﻭي ِ ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ-١٩٣٩) ٢ ﺕ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ (١٨٥٦ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﺟ ِﻪ ﺟﺪي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺷﺪ.٣ ﻂ ﮊﺍﻥ ﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺟﻨﺒﺶﹺ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺎﮊﻩ (١٨٩٦-١٩٨٠) ٤ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ .ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺑﻨﺪي ﭘﻴﺎﮊﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻣﻌﺘﺒﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺕ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ِ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.
: developmental psychology ١ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲِ ﺭﺷﺪ e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٢ ٢ ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ) ( Sigmund Freudﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺩﻋﺎ ﮐﻪ " ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭِ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮِ ﺣﻮﺍﺩﺛﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ " ﺍﻧﻘﻼﺑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺮِ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﻣﻨﺒﻊ :ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻧﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﻝ .ﻣﺎﻥ -ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻗﺘﺒﺎﺱ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﭽﻲ -ﻧﺸﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﮐﺒﻴﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢ e ٣ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٣ Jean Piaget ٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٣٠
ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ي ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻗﺼﺪ ﺳﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺳﺎﺯي ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ : ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻲ ﻲ
ﺟﻬﺖِ ﻞ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﻮﺩﮎ ﺖ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺷﻨﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ :ﺷﺎﻣﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻔﺎي ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﺭﻭﺯﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﭘﻴﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ. ﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻞ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ي ﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ :ﺷﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺍﺟ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲﹺ ﻂ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻋﻲ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺩﺭﺭ ﻲ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭيﹺ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﮎ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ .
ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺖ ﭼﺮﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑ ﮎ ﺩﺭﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺧﺧﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻲ ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐ ﹺ ﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﻴﺎ ِ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﻭ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﻴﻢ . ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴ ﻥ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﺘﻲ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻋﻮﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻪ ﻫﻴﻢ ﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺍﺳﺘ ﻲ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻬﺒﺒﻮﺩ ﺑﺨﺸﻴﻴﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺁﻣﻣﻮﺯﺷ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﺷﮑﻮﻓﺎ ﺳﺎﺯﺯﻳﻢ . ﺯ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻮﻩ ي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺧﻴﻠﻲ ﺑﻬﺘﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺵﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﻲ ﻲ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﻞ ﻣﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺷ ﻖ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻋﻤﻴ ﹺ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻤﻴ ﺁﻣﻮﺯﺵ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻋﻲ ﮑﻨﺪ . ﮏِ ﺷﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﮑ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ،ﮐﻤﮏ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣١
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ:١ ٢
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﻣﺴﻮﻥ
ﺩﺭ ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺨﻲ ﺍﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﺪ " :ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨﮓ ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﻭ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺘﻪ ي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺟﺪي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ " . ﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻂ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ) ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ( ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻌﺎﻣﻼﺕِ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ي ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ .ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻫﻢ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻝ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﺑﻴﻦ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻀﻼ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﻞ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻌﺼﺐ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺒﻌﻴﺾ ﻫﺎ ) ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﻋﻘﻴﺪﺗﻲ ،ﻧﮋﺍﺩي ،ﻓﺮﻗﻪ ﺍي ( ﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ.
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻞ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺷﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻃﺮﺍﻓﻤﺎﻥ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻌﮑﺲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋ ﹺ ﺶ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬﻤﻴﺪﻥِ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ.ﺣﺘﻲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ . ﺶ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ
: social psychology ١ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ[١٤] Thomson ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٢
ﮎ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﺎﻥ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ِ ﮎ ﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺩﺭ ِ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻒ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ي ﺍﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺿﻌﻒ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﻮﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﺐ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ ﻑ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺷﮕﺮ ِ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .
◄ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲِ ﻣﺤﻴﻂِ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻤﺎﻥ ﺳﻤﺖ ﻭ ﺳﻮ ﺩﻫﺪ ؟
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٣
ﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ:١ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ٢ﺭﻧﺞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﻭﺣﺸﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﻗﺮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ،ﺷﻴﺎﻃﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺎﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻳﮏ ﺑﺎﻭ ﹺﺭ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺖ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﻭﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻲ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻗﺪﺭي ﻧﺎﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻂ ﺑﺪﻧ ﹺ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﻣﺘﺪﺍﻭ ﹺﻝ ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺏ ﺟﻮﺵ ﻏﺴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺷﻼﻕ ﻣﻲ ﮎ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﻭ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ! ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺁ ﹺ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮ ِ ﺯﺩﻧﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺷﮑﻨﺠﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ،ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺨﺴﺘﻴﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺟﺎﻣﻊ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﮑﺎﻭي ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺒﻨﺎ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ.
: abnormal psychology ١ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲِ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٥ : mental disorders ٢ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝِ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ .ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻋﻘﻠﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ،ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡِ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝِ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٤
ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺭﻧﺞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺑﺪﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺭﻭﺷﻬﺎي ﺩﺭﻣﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﮎ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺩﺧﻴﻞ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ِ ﺖ ﺗﺸﺨﻴﺺ ﻭ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ،ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻭ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ.١
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻑ ﺩﻳﺮﻳﻨﻪ ي ﻞ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﻞ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﮎ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻲ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻭﻗﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﻞ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭﺩﻫﺎي ﺑﺸﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺎﻫﺪ .٢
١ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬﻢ ،ﭘﺎﺳﺦِ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺮﺯي ﺑﻴﻦِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭِ ﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪ ؟ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺷﺨﺎﺻﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮِ ﺍﻧﻴﺸﺘﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ؟ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻧﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﻝ .ﻣﺎﻥ -ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻗﺘﺒﺎﺱ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﭽﻲ -ﻧﺸﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﮐﺒﻴﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٢٧ ٢ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞِ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩِ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻﺕِ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲِ ﻣﺮﺿﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺳﺎﺭﺍﺳﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﺠﺎﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (٤٥ - ٤٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٥
ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ : ﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ. ﮎ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭ ِ ) ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ،ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻭ .( ...ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ،ﺩﺭ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻂ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﺩ .ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺩﺳﺘﻴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﺤ ِ ﺵ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ١ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩي ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺕ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻓﺎﻗ ِﺪ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺘﺎﺳﻔﺎﻧﻪ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺢ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺳﻄ ﹺ
ecological validity ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٦
ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ،ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻒ ﻭﺳﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﻴ ِ ﺐ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ي ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺴ ﹺ ﻖ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺧﺎﺹ ( ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩي ) ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﻖ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺎﺭي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻊ ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺷﻬﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﻂ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ) ،( ٢٠٠٠ﮔﺮﺍﻭﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻒ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ،ﺿﻌﻒ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﻮﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺮﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻓﻮﺭﺯﺍﻧﻮ ( ٢٠٠٢ ) ١ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.٢
Eysenck ١ Gravetter& Forzano ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٧
ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺦ ﻗﻄﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ.ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺿﻌﻒ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﻮﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﺷﻲ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻖ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﻲ ﺵ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺭﻭ ﹺ
١
ﺖ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ) ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ( ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ) ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ( ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.٢ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﺪﺍﻑِ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺭﺯﻭ ﺟﺎﻣﻪ ي ﻋﻤﻞ ﭘﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ !
: experimental method ١ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ) ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻲ ( .ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﻗﺎﺑﻞِ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﺵِ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻗﺪﺍﻣﺎﺕِ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﻣﺨﺘﺺِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲِ ﺍﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺣﺎﻻ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ) . ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ [١٦] ٢ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎ :ﺍﺻﻮﻻً ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻥِ ﺍﻭ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺑﻞِ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [١٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٨
ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ؟ ﺦ ﻗﻄﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻗﺒﻮﻝ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺳﻌﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﻠﻢ ١ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻳﻢ ﻭ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺷﺪ .ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺷﺶ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﺮﺷﻤﺮﺩ : ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺑﻪ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ
.١ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ: ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ) ﺑﻪ ﺟﺰ ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﻧﺠﻮﻡ ﻭ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﻭﺗﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ( ﺗﺠﺎﺭﺏ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﺕ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺹ ﻭ ﻋﻤﺪي ﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻭ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ( .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻂ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺷﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
١ ﻋﻠﻢ ؛ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩِ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻈﻢِ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ،ﺗﻔﮑﺮِ ﻧﻈﺮي ،ﻭ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲِ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ي ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ِ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ) .ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎﭖِ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٣٩
.٢ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ) ١ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻧﻈﺮي ( : ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺴﺮي ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﮐﺎﺭﻝ ﭘﻮﭘﺮ ( ١٩٧٢ ،١٩٦٩ ) ٢ﻓﻴﻠﺴﻮﻑ ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﻃﺒﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺍﻭ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺍﺕ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺍﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺨﻨﺮﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﺿﺮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﮔﻔﺖ ":ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺏ ﻓﻮﺭي ﻭ ﻗﻄﻌﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ! " ٣ﺟﻮﺍ ﹺ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ " :ﭼﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺭﺍ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ٤؟ " .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﮕﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭽﮑﺲ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻭ ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ي ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﭼﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺯﻧﺪ. ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﻧﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ) ﭼﻴﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻦ ﻣﺎﺳﺖ ( .ﭘﺲ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺗﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.٥
e Objectivity ١ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [١٨ : Popper ٢ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻴﻠﺴﻮﻓﺎﻥِ ﻣﻄﺮﺡِ ﻋﻠﻢ Observe ! ٣ Observe what? ٤ e ٥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٤٠
ﺍﺳﺖ :١ ﻂ ﻧﻈﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺖ ﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺶ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ .٣ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺷﺪﺪﻩ ﻂ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻴﻦ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻲ ﻲﹺ ﺖ ﻲ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺶ ﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﺪﻭﻭﻥ ﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻏﻏﻴﺮﻋﺎﻗﻼﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﺳﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻔﻴﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺍﻧﺠ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺶ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﺰﻧﻴﻢ .ﭼﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎﺎﻳﺖ ﺶ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺖ ﻫﻤﭽﻮﻥ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻥ ﻦ ﺭﺭﺍﻫﻨﻤﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎﺎﻳﻲ ﻦ، ﺶ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭ ﺁﺯﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻦﹺ ﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺮﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺮﺍﻳﻦ، ﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ . ﺍﺭﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻧﺘﺨ
.٤ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﭘﺬﻳﺮي: ٢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺼﻪ ي ﻣﻤﺘﺎ ﹺﺯ ﻋﻠﻢ ،ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭘﻮﭘﺮ ) ،( ١٩٦٩ﻭﻭﺟ ِﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺼ ﺑﻪ ﻪ ﮑﻦ ﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻣﻤﮑ ﮎ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﮕ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻌﻌﺠﺐ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﺪ :ﺗﻼﺵ ﻭ ﮐﮐﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻧﻪ ﺭﺩ ﺁﻧﻬﻬﺎ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺩ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﻧﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺻ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻤﻲ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﺭ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺻﺪﻫﺎ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺣﺘﻲ ﻦ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﭘﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻞ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺸ ﻂ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺻ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻒ ﮐﺸ ِ ﭻ ﻧﻘﺸﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ.٣ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ﻦ
ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺵ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﺑﮕﻴﺮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻨﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺭﺕ ﻲ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻫﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ١ﺩﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺻﻼﺡ ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﺻ ﺒﺎﺭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﻓﺰﻭﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﻏﻴﺮِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﺪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺻ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﻲ ﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ[٢٠] e : Falsifiabilityﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎ F y ٢ e ٣ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤١
.٥ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي : ١ ﺶ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ،ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﭘﮋﻭﻫ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺍﻋﻈﻢ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺳﻨﺪ. ﺞ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻧﻘﺺ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ.
.٦ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ : ٢ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻮﻣﺎﺱ ﮐﻮﻭﻥ١٩٦٢ ) ٣ﻭ ( ١٩٧٧ﺿﺮﻭﺭي ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻢ ﭘﺎﻳﺒﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺵ ي ﻧﻈﺮي ٤ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻲ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻬﺖ ﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨ ﹺ ﻒ ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻒ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﮐﻮﻭﻥ ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﺶ ﻭﺳﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥِ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺖ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﻗﺴﻤ ِ
: replicability ١ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻼً ﺗﻮﺳﻂِ ﺳﺎﻳﺮِ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻳﺪ. ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲِ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٢٧ T.S. Kuhn ٢ : theoretical ٣ ﻧﻈﺮي ،ﺗﺌﻮﺭﻳﮑﻲ :ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄﺢ ﻧﻈﺮي ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺳﻄﻊ ﻋﻤﻠﻲ. : paradigm ٤ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ،ﺍﻟﮕﻮ ،ﻣﺪﻝ ،ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ،ﺩﻳﺪﻣﺎﻥ .ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉِ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎ ،ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎ ،ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩِ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﻘﺒﻮﻝِ ﻳﮏ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻘﻄﻊِ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻣﺮﮐﺰﻳﺖِ ﺯﻣﻴﻦ ،ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ِ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي (
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٢
ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻠﻢ : ١ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻤﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻃﻴﻒ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎﺩﺍﺕ ﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﺍﺕ ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ . ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟﻲ :٢ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳ ﹺﻢ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻭ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ . ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻧﻘﻼﺑﻲ :٣ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺍﺷﮑﺎﻻﺕ ﻭ ﻣﺴﺎﻳﻞ ِﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳ ﹺﻢ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪي ﺷﺪﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﻭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﻓﮑﺮي ﻭ ﺟﺎﺑﺠﺎﻳﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺎ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﻭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﻓﮑﺮي ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺗﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ . ) ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ٤ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ(.
pre science ١ normal science ٢ revolutionary science ٣ : paradigm shift ٤ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي » ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮِ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ « ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : .١ﻳﮏ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ،ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻣﺮﮐﺰﻳﺖِ ﺯﻣﻴﻦ ﺟﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺣﺮﮐﺖِ ﺯﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺧﻮﺭﺷﻴﺪِ ﮐﻮﭘﺮﻧﻴﮏ ﺩﺍﺩ . .٢ﻳﮏ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮِ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻨﺪﺳﻪ ي ﺍﻗﻠﻴﺪﺳﻲ ﺟﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻧﺴﺒﻴﺖِ ﺍﻧﻴﺸﺘﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺩ. ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏِ» ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ « ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﺭﺷﺎﻝ ﺭﻳﻮ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻳﺤﻴﻲ ﺳﻴﺪ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي -ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕِ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٣
ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺷﺪ ﻫﻤﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺕ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻫﻤﻪ ) ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ( ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ : ﻖ ﺣﺠ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺳﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﺤ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ← .ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ 9 ﻖ ﮐﺎﻣﭙﻴﻮﺗﺮ ( ﺖ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻖ ﺛﺒ ِ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ← ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ 9 ﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ←.ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺤ ِ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ 9 ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺳﺨﺖ ) ﻭ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﻢ ﻏﻴﺮﻣﻤﮑﻦ ( ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﮐﺘﺸﺎﻓﻲ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ) ،( idﻣﻦ ) ،( egoﻓﺮﺍﻣﻦ ) ( super egoﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ي ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻤﺎ ِ ﮐﻨﺪ ← .١ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي 9 ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭﭘﺬﻳﺮﻧﺪ ← .ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭﭘﺬﻳﺮي 9
ﻦ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﻣﺮﺩﻭﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻞ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ،ﮐﻮﻭﻥ ) ( ١٩٦٢ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺎﻗﺒ ﹺ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﺘﻲ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺗﮑﻪ ﻭ ﻗﻄﻌﻪ ﻗﻄﻌﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ
١ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ﻟﻘﺐ ﻏﻴﺮﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴﺖ ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [٢٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٤
ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ،ﺑﻴﻮﺷﻴﻤﻲ ،ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺗﮑﻪ ﺗﮑﻪ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﻣﺤﺮﻭﻡ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻭﻟﻨﺘﺎﻳﻦ ( ١٩٩٢ ،١٩٨٢ ) ١ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ٢ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻣﻼﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻻﺯﻡ ﺶ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻬﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺍﻭ ﺟﻨﺒ ﹺ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﭘﺎﻓﺸﺎﺭي ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ . ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻖ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺤ ِ ﭘﺎﻓﺸﺎﺭي ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﺩ. ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺢ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺷﻬﺎي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺎي ﭘﮋﻭﻫ ﹺ ﺶ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﮐﻮﻭﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻬﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻧﻈﺮي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺟﺎي ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭘﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻫﻤﭽﻮﻥ ﮐﻮﻭﻥ ) ﻞ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ. ( ١٩٦٢ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺎﻗﺒ ﹺ
Valentine ١ : behaviourism ٢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [٢٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٥
ﻞ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﺨﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻢ ،ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺸﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي .( ١ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺤ ِ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺩﺍﺭﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻞ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﺴﺖ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺟﻤﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺟﺮ ﻭ ﺑﺤﺚ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻞ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻞ ﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ( ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺙ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻃﻼ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺎ ،ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﺖ ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﺎ ،ﺷﺨﺼﻴ ِ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻤﺎﻥ ( ،ﺳﻼﻣ ِ ﺕ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ...ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺭﺍ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭﺍ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ،ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٦
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ:١ ﻒ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻇﺎﻳ ِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪﻧﺪ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺘﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻳﮏ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﮐﺲ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻋﺎﺩ ﹺ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺩﺳﺘﺎﻭﺭﺩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﻢ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺑﺸﻤﺎﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮐﻪ : ﻖ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ " :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺍﺯ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﻓ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻢ " ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ " :ﻧﻪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﻢ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻗﺒﻮﻝ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ " .٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭼﻴﺰي
: common sense ١ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ،ﺣﺲ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ) ﻋﻘﻞ ﺳﻠﻴﻢ ( : ﺑﻪ ﻋﻘﺎﻳﺪي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺿﺎً ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﻪ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮐﻨﺪ . ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩِ ﺑﺮﮔﺰﻳﺪﻥ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﻣﺮﺍﺟﻌﻪ ﻭ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ .ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﺒﺐ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ » ﻓﻬﻢِ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( ﻋﻘﺎﻳﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻠﻲ ِ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( e ٢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٧
ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻔﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ :ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ .
.١ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎ : ﺏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺕ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮓ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘ ﹺ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﺎ ِ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺩﺧﺘﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺸﻮﻗﻪ ﺍﺵ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ " ﺍﺯ ﺩﻝ ﺑﺮﻭﺩ ﻫﺮ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺭﻭﺩ " ١ﻓﮑﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻏﻤﮕﻴﻦ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ " ﺩﻭﺭي ﻭ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻲ " ﻳﺎ " ﻣﻴﺨﻮﺍي ﻋﺰﻳﺰ ﺷﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺷﻮ ﻳﺎ ﮔﻮﺭ ﺷﻮ "٢ﻓﮑﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻀﺎﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻓﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ » ﻋﺠﻠﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺷﻴﻄﻮﻧﻪ ،« ٣ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ » ﺗﺎ ﺗﻨﻮﺭ ﺩﺍﻏﻪ ﻧﻮﻥ ﺭﻭ ﺑﭽﺴﺒﻮﻥ « ٤ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ » ﺁﺷﭙﺰ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺸﻪ ﻏﺬﺍ ﻳﺎ ﺷﻮﺭ ﻣﻴﺸﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻲ ﻧﻤﮏ ،« ٥ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ » ﻳﮏ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺻﺪﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻩ« ٦ ﻞ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻨﺎﻗﻀﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺒﻨﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .
Out of sight, Out of mind ١ Absence makes the heart grow fonder ٢ Look befor you leap ٣ He who hesitates is lost ٤ Too many cooks spoil thr broth ٥ Many hands make light labour ٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٨
ﺶ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ : .٢ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺟﺰ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ}ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻖ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻞ ﻭ ﻓﺼﻞ ﮐﻨﺪ { ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ١
ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﻣﻨﺘﻈﺮﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﻨﻠﻲ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﭘﮋﻭﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺻﺤﻨﻪ ي ﺶ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺦ ﻏﻠﻂ، ﻞ ﻫﺮ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﺍﻋﻼﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﮎ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺟﺮﻳﻤﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺷﻮ ِ ﺕ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﻮﮎ ﻫﺮ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺷﺪ ِ ﮎ ١٨٠ﻭﻟﺘﻲ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﻓﺮﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ : ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺷﻮ ِ " ﻣﻦ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻢ ﺩﺭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﮐﻨﻢ " ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﺷﻮﮎ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ٢٧٠ﻭﻟﺘﻲ ﻋﮑﺲ ﺍﻟﻌﻤ ﹺ
ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻴ ﹺﻎ ﻭﺣﺸﺘﻨﺎﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺷﻮﮎ ﺧﻮﺩﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﻨﺪﻩ ) ﭘﺮﻭﻓﺴﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ( ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ي ﺷﮑﻨﺠﻪ ﺗﺮﻏﻴﺐ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺷﻤﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻓﮑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ؟ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﮎ ﻣﺮﮔﺒﺎ ﹺﺭ ٤٥٠ﻭﻟﺖ ﺑﺪﻫﻴﺪ ؟ ﻓﮑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺩﺭﺻ ِﺪ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺶ ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺷﻮ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺣﺎﺿﺮﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ ؟
Stanly Milgram ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٤٩
ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ) ( ١٩٧٤ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺷﺨﺼﺎً ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﮐﺎﺭي ﺑﺸﻮﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲِ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ١ﻧﻔﺮ ﺩﺭ ﮎ ٤٥٠ﻭﻟﺘﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ٦٠%ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ١٠٠٠ﻧﻔﺮ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺷﻮ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺷﻮﮎ ٤٥٠ﻭﻟﺘﻲ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ٦٠٠ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺁﻥ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﺨﺼﺺ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ! ١ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺩﻣﻬﺎ ﺧﻴﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻭ ﺣﺪﺱ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﺎﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎﺑﻊ ﻭ ﺕ ﺶ ﺷﺪﻳﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻴﺮﻭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻤﺎ ِ ﻣﻄﻴ ﹺﻊ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ) ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﭘﺮﻭﻓﺴﻮﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ( ﮐﻪ ﻣﻘﺘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺻﻼﺣﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﻨﺪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ . .ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ← ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺻﺤﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﮎ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﭼﻴﺰي ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺟﺰ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺭﺍﻩ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻲ ﻣﻌﺘﺒﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺻﻔﺤﺎ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ.
١ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﺷﻮﮎ ٤٥٠ﻭﻟﺘﻲ ﺟﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ !؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ :ﻧﻪ .ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺍﺻﻼً ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻟﻴﮑﻦ ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﺭﺍﺳﺦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺗﺎﻕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻭي ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﺩ ،ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻌﻠﻢ ﺗﺸﺨﻴﺺ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻨﻮﺩ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺿﺒﻂِ ﺻﻮﺕ ﭘﺨﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺷﺎﮔﺮﺩ ﻃﺒﻖ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﮕﻲ ﻓﺮﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﺕ ﺁﺭﻭﻧﺴﻮﻥ .ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﺮ ﮐﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺭﺷﺪ ١٣٨٦ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي – ٦٦ﻡ (
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٠
ي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ) : ( hindsight bias ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺚ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﻫﻤﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﭘﺲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺤ ِ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﺩﻋﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭼﻴ ﹺﺰ ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺷﮕﻔﺖ ﺯﺩﻩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ؟ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ " ﻣﻦ ﺧﻮﺩﻡ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻢ " ؟ ﺕ ﻓﻴﺸﻮﻑ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺖ ( ١٩٧٥ ) ١ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻤﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ي ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻔ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺳﻴﻪ ﺩﺭﺁﻥ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻔ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺴﻮﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍً ﺑﻪ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ « ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﻣﻨﺪ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺲ » ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ .ﻋﻼﺭﻏ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻪ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ﹺ ﺶ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﻢ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻦ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﮑﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺶ ﻧﺎﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ .ﮔﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ . ﺑﺎﺧﺒﺮﺷﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً » ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺞ ﺶ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲﹺ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺳﻠﻮﻭﻳﮏ ﻭ ﻓﻴﺸﻬﻮﻑ ( ١٩٧٧ ) ٢ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺞ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻡ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﮑﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺑﻮﺩ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ،ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﺑﻮﺩ.
Beyth & Fischhoff ١ Fischhoff & Slovic ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥١
ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺣﺬﻑ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺁﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ،ﻓﻴﺸﻬﻮﻑ ) ( ١٩٧٧ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﺪﺩﮔﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺮﻏﻴﺐ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻀﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﺒﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻖ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺍﺛﺮي ) ﻳﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺎﭼﻴﺰ ( ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺖ. ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻌﻠﻤﺎﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻌﻀﻞ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﻲ ﺳﺖ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻴﭻ ﻣﺴﺌﻠﻪ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎﻥ ﺟﺬﺍﺑﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ! } ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻠﺖ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻋﺘﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺞ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕﺮ ﻧﺎ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺕ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺷﺎﻥ،ﺍﻋﻼﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺎ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ! {
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٢
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ : ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬﺎ ِﻥ ﻏﺮﺏ ،ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺯﻧﺰﻭﻳﮓ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ
١
ﻖ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ) ٦٤% ،(١٩٩٢ﺍﺯ ٥٦ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﻣﺤﻘ ﹺ ﺏ ﺑﺎﺭﻭﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺮﻧﻪ ( ١٩٩١ ) ٢ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﺵ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﺘﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻳﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ٩٤%ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎي ﺷﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ٢%ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎ ١% ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﻟﻴﺎ ﻭ ٣%ﺍﺯ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﻧﻘﺎﻁ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺩﻧﻤﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺑﺎﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ( ١٩٩٨ ) ٣ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ي ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻧﺪ " :ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺘﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﻠﻴﺴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ١٢ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ٢٠٠ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ؛ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ % ١٠ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ".
Rosenzweig ١ Byrne & Baron ٢ Smith & Bond ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٣
ﺙ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥِ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻼﺭﻏﻢ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ،ﺗﻤﺎﻡ ﻣﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ١٠٠ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﻪ ي ﻗﺮﻥ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ِ ﻫﺎﮔﺒﻠﻮﻡ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ (٢٠٠٢) ١ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺷﺪﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣﻼﮎ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﻧﻘﻞ ﻗﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺠﻼﺕ ﻞ ﻗﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺘﺐ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺱ ﻗﺮﻥ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻲ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺎﺭﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻌﺮﻓ ﹺ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ . ﺱ ﺑﺮﺗﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ % ٢٠ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ % ٢٠ﺍﺯ ١٠٠ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﺳﺎﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﮊﺍﻥ ﭘﻴﺎﮊﻩ ،ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ،ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ ) ،( H. J. Eysenckﮐﺎﺭﻝ ﮔﻮﺳﺘﺎﻭ ﻳﻮﻧﮓ ) ،( Carl Jung ﺍﻳﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻒ ) Ivan ،( Pavlovﻭﻟﻔﺎﻧﮓ ﮐﻬﻠﺮ)،( Wolfgang Kohlerﺟﻮﺯﻑ ﻭﻟﭙﻪ ) ،( Joseph Wolpe ﺩﻭﻧﺎﻟﺪ ﺑﺮﻭﺩﺑﻨﺖ ) ،( Donald Broadbentﮐﻨﺮﺍﺩ ﻟﻮﺭﻧﺰ ) ،( Konrad Lorenz ﺁﻟﻔﺮﺩ ﺁﺩﻟﺮ ) ،(Alfred Adler ﻣﺎﻳﮑﻞ ﺭﺍﺗﺮ ) ،( Michael Rutter ﺍﻟﮑﺴﺎﻧﺪﺭ ﻟﻮﺭﻳﺎ ) ،( Alexander Luriaﻟﺌﻮ ﻭﻳﮕﻮﺗﺴﮑﻲ ) Lev ،( Vygotskyﺁﻣﻮﺱ ﺗﻮﺭﺳﮑﻲ ) ،( Amos Tverskyﻭﻳﻠﻬﻠﻢ ﻭﻭﻧﺖ ) (Wilhelm Wundtﻭ ﺁﻧﺎ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ).( Anna Freud ﺕ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺪﻭ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺎﻣﻲﹺ ٥٠ﻧﻔﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﺮﻥ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ) ﻭﻟﻲ ﻧﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ !! ( ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺸﻬﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒِﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
Haggbloom et al ١
٥٤ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ: ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ
١- B.F Skinner
١١-Gordon
٢١- Clark Hull
٣١-Martin
٤١- Solomon
ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨﺮ.ﺍﻑ.ﺑﻲ
Allport ﮔﻮﺭﺩﻭﻥ ﺁﻟﭙﻮﺭﺕ
ﮐﻼﺭﮎ ﻫﺎﻝ
Seligman ﻣﺎﺭﺗﻴﻦ ﺳﻠﻴﮕﻤﻦ
Asch ﺳﻮﻟﻮﻣﻮﻥ ﺍﺵ
٢-Jean Piaget
١٢- Eric Erikson
٢٢-Jerome
٣٢- Ulric
٤٢- Gordon
ﮊﺍﻥ ﭘﻴﺎﮊﻩ
ﺍﺭﻳﮏ ﺍﺭﻳﮑﺴﻮﻥ
Kagan ﺟﺮﻭﻣﻪ ﮐﺎﮔﺎﻥ
Neiser ﺍﻭﻟﺮﻳﮏ ﻧﻴﺰﺭ
Bower ﮔﻮﺭﺩﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﻭﺭ
٣- Sigmund
١٣- H.J.
٢٣-Carl Jung
٣٣-Donald
٤٣- Harold
Freud
ﮐﺎﺭﻝ ﮔﻮﺳﺘﺎﻭ ﻳﻮﻧﮓ
ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ
Eysenck ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺁﻳﺰﻧﮏ
Campbell ﺩﻭﻧﺎﻟﺪ ﮐﻤﭗ ﺑﻞ
Kelley ﻫﺎﺭﻭﻟﺪ ﮐﻠﻲ
٤-Albert Bandura
١٤-William
٢٤- Ivan Pavlov
٣٤- Roger
٤٤-Roger
ﺁﻟﺒﺮﺕ ﺑﺎﻧﺪﻭﺭﺍ
James ﻭﻳﻠﻴﺎﻡ ﺟﻴﻤﺰ
ﺍﻳﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻒ
Brown ﺭﺍﺟﺮ ﺑﺮﺍﻭﻥ
Sperry ﺭﺍﺟﺮ ﺍﺳﭙﺮي
٥- Leon Festinger
١٥-David
٢٥- Walter
٣٥- R.B.
٤٥-Edward
ﻟﺌﻮﻥ ﻓﺴﺘﻴﻨﮕﺮ
McClelland ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺪ ﻣﮏ ﮐﻠﻨﺪ
Mischel ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮ ﻣﻴﺸﻞ
Zajonc ﺯﺍﺟﻮﻧﮏ
Tolman ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻤﻦ
٦- Carl Rogers
١٦- Raymond
٢٦- Harry
٣٦- Endel
٤٦-Stanley
ﮐﺎﺭﻝ ﺭﺍﺟﺮﺯ
Cattell ﺭﻳﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﺎﺗﻞ
Harlow ﻫﺮي ﻫﺎﺭﻟﻮ
Tulving ﺍﻧﺪﻝ ﺗﻮﻟﻮﻳﻨﮓ
Milgram ﺍﺳﺘﻨﻠﻲ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ
٧-Stanley
١٧- John
٢٧- J.P.
٣٧- Herbert
٤٧- Arthur
Schachter
ﺍﺳﺘﻨﻠﻲ ﺷﺎﺧﺘﺮ
Watson ﺟﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﺗﺴﻮﻥ
Guilford ﮔﻴﻠﻔﻮﺭﺩ
Simon ﻫﺮﺑﺮﺕ ﺳﻴﻤﻮﻥ
Jensen ﺁﺭﺗﻮﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﻦ
٨- Neal Miller
١٨- Kurt Lewin
٢٨- Jerome
٣٨-Noam
٤٨-Lee
ﻧﻴﻞ ﻣﻴﻠﺮ
ﮐﺮﺕ ﻟﻮﻳﻦ
Bruner ﺟﺮﻭﻣﻪ ﺑﺮﻭﻧﺮ
Chomsky ﻧﻮﺍﻡ ﭼﺎﻣﺴﮑﻲ
cronbach ﻟﻲ ﮐﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﺥ
٩- Edward
١٩- Donald
٢٩- Ernest
٣٩- Edward
٤٩- John
Thorndike
ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺛﻮﺭﻧﺪﺍﻳﮏ
Hebb ﺩﻭﻧﺎﻟﺪ ﻫﺐ
Hilgard ﺍﺭﻧﺴﺖ ﻫﻴﻠﮕﺎﺭﺩ
Jones ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ
Bowlby ﺟﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻭﻟﺒﻲ
١٠- A.H Maslow
٢٠- George
٣٠-Lawrence
٤٠-Charles
٥٠-Wolfgang
ﺁﺑﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ ﻣﺎﺯﻟﻮ
Miller ﺟﺮﺝ ﻣﻴﻠﺮ
Kohlberg ﻻﺭﻧﺲ ﮐﻮﻫﻠﺒﺮﮒ
Osgood ﭼﺎﺭﻟﺰ ﺍﺳﮕﻮﺩ
Kohler ﻭﻟﻔﺎﻧﮓ ﮐﻬﻠﺮ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٥
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ:١ ﻒ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻥ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﺷﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻁ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﭘﻴﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻦ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻠﺰﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ " ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ".ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺘﻲ ﻁ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﮕﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻓﺮﻳﻘﺎ ( ﻲ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﮎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭ ِ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ٢ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻧﺪ " : (١٩٩٨) ٣ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﻧﺴﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ" . ﻣﻌﺎﻧ ﹺ ﮓ ﮊﺍﭘﻦ، ﭼﺮﺍ ﻧﺴﺒﻲ ؟ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ .ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﮐﺎﺭ« ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺖ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﮐﺎﺭ « ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﮊﺍﭘﻦ " ﮐﺎﺭ" ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺳﺎﻋ ِ ﺕ ﮔﺮﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍ ِﻩ ﺖ ﮐﺎﺭي ﻭ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻔﺮﻳﺤﺎ ِ ﻑ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪﻧﻲ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻋ ِ ي ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻝ ،ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺷﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺻﺮ ِ ﮐﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
cross‐cultural psychology ١ Bond & Smith ٢ : culture ٣ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٦
ﻒ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ؟ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻃﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ) ﻳﺎ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮﺍ ً ( ﺑﺮﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺩ ﹺﻡ ﺳﺎﮐﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﺭﻳﺰي ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﺎﺭﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ .ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻣﻴﺴﺮ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ . ﻖ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺳﺘﻴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﮎ ﺑﻲ ﺷﮏ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﮓ ﺣﺎﮐﻢ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻭ ﺿﺮﻭﺭي ﺳﺖ . ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻋﻤﻴﻖ ﺗﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺟﻬﺎﻧﺸﻤﻮﻝ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻳﺪ . ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻠﻲ ﻭ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﮎ ﺭﻧﮕﻬﺎ ،ﺭﺩﻳﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﺩﻳﻦ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ،ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﺖ ﻣﺤﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ( ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ،ﻇﺮﻓﻴ ِ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﮐﺸﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺗﺤ ِ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ،ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٧
ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي:١ ﻂ ﻳﮏ ﺯﺑﺎﻧﺸﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﻨﺖ ﭘﺎﻳﮏ ٢ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺷﺪ .ﭘﺲ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭ ،ﺑﺮي ( ١٩٦٩) ٣ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ : ﮓ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي ) : (emicﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﮓ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ . ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ : (etic) ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ » ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ « ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻣﻲ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .٤
Etic vs. Emic constructs ١ Kennet Pike ٢ Berry ٣ ٤ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡِ » ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ « ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻝِ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡِ » ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺎﻡِ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ « ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺘﺎﺏِ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎﭖِ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٨
ﺦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻤﻠﻮ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺟﺰﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺮي ) ،( ١٩٦٩ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ي » ﻫﻮﺵ « ١ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ﺕ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻮﺵ ﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ،ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮي ) (١٩٧٤ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻭ ﻃﺮﻓﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﻧﺴﺒﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻧﺴﺒﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻫﻮﺵ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻧﺒﺮﮒ (١٩٧٤) ٢ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﺑﺪﻭي ﻭ ﻧﺎﻧﻮﻳﺴﺎ
٣
ﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺿﺮﻭﺭي ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﺫﮐﺎﻭﺕِ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﮑﺎﺭﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺁﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻴﺮﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯي ﺑﺎ ﺗﻴﺮ ﻭ ﮐﻤﺎﻥ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ( .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻣﺮﺩ ﹺﻡ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺑﺎ ﺳﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺎ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺫﮐﺎﻭﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻞ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﻭ ﺗﻔﮑ ﹺﺮ ﺧﻼﻕ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺣ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺩﺍﻧﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺫﮐﺎﻭﺕ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺗﺤ ِ ﻂ ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻦ ﻂ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭي ﺑﺎ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻘﺶ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺶ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺫﮐﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ
: Intelligence ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩِ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﺏ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴﺖ ﺁﻣﻴﺰ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻭﺿﺎﻉِ ﺗﺎﺯﻩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻫﻮﺵ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( Sternberg ٢ : preliterate ٣ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺍي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﺒﺎ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ – .ﻡ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٥٩
ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ١ﻫﺎ : ﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ي ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ) ( ١٩٩٨ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ " : ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻣﺎ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻏﺎﻓﻞ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ .".ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺤﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ( ﻭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺟﻤﻊ ﻣﺤﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ( ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻭﻧﺪﻟﻮ ﻭ ﮐﻦ (١٩٩٩ ) ٢ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺩﻋﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﺎﻃﻖ ﻣﺎﻭﻧﺘﻴﻦ ﻭﺳﺖ ) ( Mountain Westﻭ ﮔﺮﻳﺖ ﭘﻠﻴﻨﺰ )Great Plains ( ﮐﺸﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﭗ ﺳﺎﻭﺕ ) ( Deep Southﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﻋﮑﺲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻟﺬﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮓ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﻭ ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻴﻢ . ﮓ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ) ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ( ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ
: culture ١ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺯﺷﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﭘﻴﺮﻭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻻﻫﺎي ﻣﺎﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ » ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ « ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٧ Cohen & Vandello ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٠
ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭي : ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺞ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺭﺍ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺜﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻳﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺽ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ. ﻖ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻧﺪ ) (١٩٩٨ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﮎ ﻣﺴﺘﻤﺮ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻧﺪ " :ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﺁﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻮﺿﻮ ﹺﻉ " ﻓﺮﻣﺎﻧﺒﺮي ﻭ ﺍﻃﺎﻋﺖ" ﺍﺳﺖ " .ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي » ﺍﻃﺎﻋﺖ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻣﺎﻧﺒﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ « ) ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ( ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺎﻓﻮﻕ ،ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺷﻮﮎ ﺖ ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺩﺍﻭﻃﻠﺒﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ِ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮔﺒﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ( ١٩٧٤ - ١٩٦٣ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑ ﹺ
ﺍﻣﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺷﺎﺭﻭﻥ ٦، ( ١٩٨٧ ) ١ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﻦ ٦٤ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﮐﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺍﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﺷﺪ ٤٠ ) .ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ٢٤ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻧﻴﺎﻣﺪ ( ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ٦ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺖ . ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ،ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﭼﺸﻤﮕﻴﺮي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
Sharon & Amir ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦١
ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭي : ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﻮﻭﻳﺖ ﻭ ﺍﺳﻮ ﺑﻤﭙﺎﻩ ) ١ (١٩٩٠ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ِ ﻣﻌﺘﺒﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺕ ﻧﮋﺍﺩي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺗﻌﺼﺒﺎ ِ ﺚ ﻣﺠﻠﻪ ﻲ ﻣﺒﺎﺣ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻠﻴﻨﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺮﻳﺘﺎﻧﻴﺎ ﻃﻲ ﺖ ﺣﻴﺮﺕ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﻟﻬﺎي ١٩٦٢ﺗﺎ ١٩٨٠ﺑﺎ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﻲ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺘ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﺒﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ) ﺖ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺘ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ " :ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻼﺷﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻖ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﮕﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻣﺜﻼً ﻏﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎ ( ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻼﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻭ ﻧﺎﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ".٢
Owusu _Bempah & Howitt ١ e ٢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ[٢٦]
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٢
ﺗﻌﺼﺒﺎﺕ:١ ﻲ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ،٢ ﺾ ﻧﮋﺍﺩي ﺩﺭ ﻣﺘﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﺸﻬﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮎ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﺒﻌﻴ ﹺ ﺍﻭﺳﻮ ﺑﻤﭙﺎﻩ ﻭ ﻫﻮﻳﺖ ) ( ١٩٩٤ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ،ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻢ ) (١٩٩٣ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ،ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﺩﺭ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﺁﻓﺮﻳﻘﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺖ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﻓﺮﻳﻘﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻼﺷﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺒﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﮕﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻫﻮﻭﻳﺖ ﻭ ﺍﻭﺳﻮ ﺑﻤﭙﺎﻩ ) ( ١٩٩٤ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻨﺪ " :ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ) ( ١٩٩٣ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺗﮑﻨﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﺎﻭﺭﺩ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎ ﻭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ " .ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻦ » ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ «» ، " ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘﺒﺪﺍﻧﻪ ي ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎ ﻣﺤﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻨﺎﻭﻳ ﹺ ي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ﻧﻴﺎﻓﺘﻪ « ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ » ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ « ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻒ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﭘﺮﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ،ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺧﻼﻗﻴﺎﺕ ،ﺁﻳﻴﻦ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻮﻣﻲ -ﻣﺬﻫﺒﻲ ،ﻭ ...ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﮕﺎﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ﭘﻮﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺤﺮﻭﻣﻴ ِ ﺍي ﺟﺰ ﺑﺮﺗﺮ ﺷﻤﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺳﻔﻴﺪ ﭘﻮﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴ ِﺪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻗﻠﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﮓ ﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ "٣ . ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ،ﺗﻮﺟ ِﻪ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻋﺘﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﻧﮕﺮﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺑﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻧﮕﺮﺍﻧﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺷﺒﺨﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ﻲ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﻨﻬﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺧﺸﮑﻴﺪﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﭘﺮﺳﺘ ﹺ
: bias ١ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ،ﺗﻌﺼﺐ .ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮﻓﺪﺍﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻗﻀﻴﻪ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲِ ﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺁﻥ .ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﺎﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﻭﺭي ﺷﺨﺺ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( Atkinson ٢ e ٣ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٣
ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ:١ ﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻢ ﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻀﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺶ ﺭﺩﻳﻒ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻤﺴﺖ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﻭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﺍﻳﮕﻠﻲ (٢٠٠٢ ) ٢ﺩﻭ ﭘﺮﺳ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻞ .١ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺷﮑﺎﺭ ( ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺁﺷﭙﺰي ( ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ .٢ﭼﺮﺍ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻗﺼﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﺩﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮي ﮐﻪ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﻭ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ – ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ .ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ :
: gender differences ١ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ِ » ﺟﻨﺲ « ﮔﺎﻩ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﮔﺎﻩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵِ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺍﺯ ﻣﺘﻦ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ِ ﺍﺑﻬﺎﻡ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ِ ﺟﻨﺲ ) ( sexﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ِ » ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖ ) « ( genderﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻳﻢ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﮐﺮﻡِ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ – ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (١٩ Eagly & Wood ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٤
ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﻭﻝ :ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ : ١ ﻂ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ) ٢ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺍﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻭﻭﺩ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ( ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞ ٢ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ( .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻭ ﺍﻳﮕﻠﻲ ) : ( ٢٠٠٢ ﺖ ﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﺎ ﺏ ﺭﻗﺎﺑ ِ " ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺭﺍ ،ﺑﺎﺯﺗﺎ ﹺ ﺏ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻨﺪ .ﺯﻧﺎ ِﻥ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ،ﮐﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻑ ﺟﺬ ﹺ ﻫﺪ ِ ﻦ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺁﻳﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺎﻣﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻧﻈﺎﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻦ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﻲ ،ﺑﺮ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻼﺕ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﺶ ﭘﺪﺭي ٣ﺷﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺗﺎﻣﻴ ﹺ ﻗﻄﻌﻲ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻈﺎﺭﺕ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻃ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻼﺗ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ،ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘ ﹺ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻣﻴﻞ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ". ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ.
evolutionary psychology ١ e ٢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٨ ٣ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﻣﻄﻤﺌﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﭽﻪ ي ﻣﺘﻮﻟﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﭽﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﺸﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﻣﻄﻤﺌﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﭽﻪ ي ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﻴﺎ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺑﭽﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ –.ﻡ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٥
ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﻭﻡ :ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ – ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ : ١ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﺍﻳﮕﻠﻲ ) ( ٢٠٠٢ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺶ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺏ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺪ " :ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﺎﺯﺗﺎ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺟﺜﻪ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ﮓ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ،ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺎﺭﺁﻣ ِﺪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺗﺨﺘﺼﺺ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ي ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻣﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﻭ ﺭﺍﺣﺖ ﺗﺮ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺐ ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ﺑﺮﺗﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ". ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺗ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻦ ﺟﺜﻪ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻏﺬﺍ ( ،ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺖ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺶ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ،ﻣﺎﻧ ﹺﻊ ﺷﺮﮐ ِ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺖ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴ ِ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺗﻌﻠﻖ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺶ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﻧ ﹺﻊ ﺕ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺜﻪ ي ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﺲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺖ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴ ِ ﺷﺮﮐ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺴﺎﻭي ﺑﻴﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.٢ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ،ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
biosocial psychology ١ e ٢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ] [٢٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٦٦
ﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ : ﺷﻮ
ﭼﻪ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﺷﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﺭﮎ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺗﺎ ﭼ ﻝ ﻖ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺒ ﺩﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﭘﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﻲ ﺣﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ – ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻋﻲ ،ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻤﻊ ﻲ ﻧﻈﺮﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺭﺍﮎ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﺷﮑﮑﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺎﺎﻫﻴﮕﻴﺮي ﻲ ﮎ ﺁﻭﺭﺭي ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴﺖ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺩﺭ ﺖ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻧﺴﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻪ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﺖِ ﻞ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﺧﺧﻮﺭﺍﮎ ﺷﺎﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﮐﺎﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺼﻮﻝ ﻭ ﻦ ﻣﺤﺼ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺩﺍﻥ ﻧﻘﺶ ﻧﺴﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻏﻴﺮﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻣﺒﺮ ١٨٨١ ،(١٩٧٨) ١ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ي ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺩﺭ ٩٩%ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺟﻤﻊﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﻨﺎﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﭘﺮﺮﺭﻧﮓ ﺗﺮي ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺎﺎﻥ ﻃﺮﻳﻳﻖ ﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﮕﻴﺮي ﺻ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﺯﻧﺎﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖِ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻲ ﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻣﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻬﻴﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻏﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﺮﻳﻖ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﻳﻳﺪ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺎ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﺣ ﻲ ﻧﻘﺸﺸﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﭼﮕﻮﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻞﹺ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺶﹺ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻥ ﻖ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖِ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﺻ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻳ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻳﻲ ﺍﻳﻔﺎي ﻧﻘﺶ ﺎ ﻞ ﺯﻧﺎﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﻧ ﹺﻊ ي ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﭼﮕﻮﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ ؟ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺶ ﺗﻮﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؟ ﻲ
Emberr ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٧
ﺷﻠﮕﻞ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺭي (١٩٨٦ ) ١ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ،ﺗﺎﺑﻮﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﻠﻨﺪﻣﺪﺕ ﺗﺮي ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺕ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺯﺍﻳﻤﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻣﺪ ِ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﻫﺎ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺍﺟﺎﺯﻩ ي ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺖ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺶ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻓﺮﺍﻏ ِ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ. ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷ ِ ﻲ ٩٣ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ٦٧ %ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻭﻳﺖ ( ١٩٧٨ ) ٢ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﺲ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ٣%ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺷﻮﻫﺮﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﺴﻠﻂ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ٣٠%ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺗﺴﻠﻂ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ _ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻌﻲ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻳﻔﺎي ﻧﻘﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬﻢ ﻭ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﺠﻬﺰﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ،ﺑﺮ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﮔﻠﺪﺷﺘﺎﻳﻦ ( ٢٠٠١) ٣ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﮔﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻞ ﺶ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺟﻨﮓ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺖ .ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻂ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺗﺴﻠ ِ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺚ ﺗﺴﻠ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺍﻗﺘﺼﺎﺩي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﺷﻠﮕﻞ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺭي( ) ( ١٩٨٦ ﮏ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﮐﻤ ِ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺷﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ.
Barry & Schlegel ١ Whyte ٢ Goldstein ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٨
ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ : ﺶ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﺮ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ 9ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺍﻓﺰﻭﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺢ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺭﺩ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ 9ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ _ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﻬﺮ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﺪ. 9ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ _ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻧﺎ ِﻥ ﺕ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺢ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻫﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﺍﻳﮕﻠﻲ ) ( ٢٠٠٢ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﻲ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺩﺳﺎﻻﺭي ) ﺗﺴﻠﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ( ، ي ﺳﻨﺘ ﹺ " ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻣﺎﻥِ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﻂ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﻫﺎي ﻖ ﺭﻭﺷﻬﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﮕﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺍﺭي ﻭ ﺳﻘ ِ ﺶ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﻧ ِﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺑﻲ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺶ ﭼﺸﻤﮕﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻣﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺶ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺶ ﺷﻤﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺘﻬﺎي ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺟﺜﻪ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﹺ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ" . 8ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﻭ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺖ ﺗﺴﻠﻂ ﻂ ﻋﻠﻲ _ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﻭ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ 8ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ،ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﺶ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻋﻴﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺗﺴﻠﻂ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻞ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻃﻠﺒﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺣﮑﻤﻔﺮﻣﺎ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻞ ﺗﺴﻠ ِ ﺖ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﮓ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺴﻠ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٦٩
ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ١ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ: ٢ ﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﮐﻦ،ﺍﻭﻳﺰﺭﻣﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻤﻞ ﻣﺎﻳﺮ ( ٢٠٠٢ ) ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ " :ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﻑ ﻓﺮﺩي ،ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ _ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻞ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﻓﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﺭﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ،ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺗﻌﻬﺪ ﻫﺎي ﮔﺮﻭﻫﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻮﻇﻒ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺟﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ" .
ﺕ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺍﻭﻳﺰﺭﻣﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ( ٢٠٠٢ﺑﺎ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ٢٧ﭘﺮﺳﺸﻨﺎﻣﻪ ي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ،ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺘﺎ ً ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻨﺪ ٦ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ٨ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ :
Individualism ١ Collectivism ٢ Con , Oyserman , Kemmelmeier ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٠
» ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ «
» ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ «
ﻦ ﺍﻃﺮﺍﻓﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ -١ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ) ﺁﺯﺍﺩ – ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ -١ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ) ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ (
ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ (
-٢ﺗﻌﻠﻖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ) ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻀﻮ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ -٢ﺍﻫﺪﺍﻑ ) ﺗﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﺪﺍﻑ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴﺖ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ (
ﻫﺎي ﺷﺨﺼﻲ (
-٣ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ) ﺁﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ﻭ ﺍﺯ -٣ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ) ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ﻭ ﮐﺴﺐ ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻋﻀﻮي ﺍﺯ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ (
ﺷﺨﺼﻲ (
-٤ﺗﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ) ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ -٤ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﮕﺎﻧﻪ ) ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﺑﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮔﺮﻭﻫﻲ(
ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ(
ﻦ ﻋﻘﺎﻳﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻭ -٥ﻣﺸﺎﻭﺭﻩ ) ﮐﻤﮏ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ -٥ﻋﻘﺎﻳ ِﺪ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ) ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻫﺎ (
ﭘﻨﻬﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ (
ﺐ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ -٦ ،ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﻫﺎي ﺻﺮﻳﺢ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻪ ) ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺖ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺘﻲ ) ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺣﺴ ﹺ -٦ﺑﺎﻓ ِ ﻫﻤﺮﻧﮓ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﺎ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ (
ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ (
ﺖ -٧ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺐ ) ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺎﻡ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ( -٨ﮐﺎﺭ) ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺸﮑﻞ ﻫﺎ (
ﻅ ﻧﻈﺮي ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﻫﺎﻓﺴﺘﺪ ١٩٨٠) ١ﻭ (١٩٨٣ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﮐﺴﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﺍﻭ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﻼﻝ ﻭ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻋﻀﻮﻳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺣﺎﺋﺰ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ.
Hofstede ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧١
ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ : ﺕ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎﻅ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﮎ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ) ( ١٩٨٠ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺵ ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﺍﺭﺯ ﹺ ﻲ IBMﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ٤٠ ﻦ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﻨﺎﻥ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻤﭙﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻂ ﮐﺎﺭي ١ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺗﺮي ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﻭ ﺕ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ﺩﺭ ١٩٨٣ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﮐﺸﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻖ ﺁﻣﺎﺭي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺟﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﺑﻴﻦ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﺍﻭﻝ ( ،ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﻟﻴﺎ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﺩﻭﻡ ( ،ﺑﺮﻳﺘﺎﻧﻴﺎ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﺳﻮﻡ ( ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺩﺍ ﻭ ﻫﻠﻨﺪ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ( ﺑﻮﺩ .ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺧﻮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﺋ ﹺﺰ ﮐﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﮔﻮﺍﺗﻤﺎﻻ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ،( ٥٣ﺍﮐﻮﺍﺩﻭﺭ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ،( ٥٢ﭘﺎﻧﺎﻣﺎ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي (٥١ﻭ ﻭﻧﺰﻭﺋﻼ ) ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ي ( ٥٠ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ .ﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﺸﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺁﺳﻴﺎي ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺪﻭﻧﺰي ،ﮐﺮﻩ ي ﺟﻨﻮﺑﻲ ،ﺗﺎﻳﻮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺗﺎﻳﻠﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺭﺗﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻨﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﮐﺴﺐ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ.ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ،ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺍي ﻣﺘﻀﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻣﻌﮑﻮﺱ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ .
work realated value ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٧٢
ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺗﺪ ) ( ١٩٨٠ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎ ﻮ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺪ ﺕِ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺪي ﺷﺪﻩ ﺖ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﻘﺎﺩﺍ ِ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﹺ ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﺎﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺖ ﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻘﺎﺩﺍﺕ ﻣﺼﻮﻮﻥ ﻧﻤﺎﻧﺪ .ﻫﻤﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻧﺪ ) ( ١٩٩٨ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ: ﻥ ﻲ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ﻋﻋﻤﺪﺗﺎً ﻣﺮﺩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ . .١ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺯﺍﺭﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ . ﻲ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ،ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺧﺪﻣﺎﺗﻲ ﻭ ﻲ ﺖ ﮑﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺟﻬ ِ .٢ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻣﮑ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﻢ ٢٥ﺳﺳﺎﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺖ ﺕِ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭﺭي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻣﺮﺑﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺖِ .٣
ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻭ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ،ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻠﻴﺪي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺖ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ﻋﻼﻭﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤ ﺲ ﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﺎﻥ ﺠﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ (.ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕ ﺛﺮﻭﺕ ﻣﻠﻲ ﺳﻨﺠ ﻣﻴﺰﺰﺍ ِﻥ + ٠/٨٢ﺑﺎ ﻣﺪﺭﻧﻴﺘﻪ ) ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺕ ﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺎﺯﹺ ﮐﻤﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻً ﺯ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺸﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﺛﺮﺮﻭﺗﻤﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻮﻮﻻً ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻴ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻣﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻗﺎﺑﺑﻞ ﻞ ﺍﻗﺘﺼﺎﺎﺩي ﻭ ﺮ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻧﻴﺎﺯي ﺯ ﺍﺯ ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺕ ﮐﺎﺷﻴﻤﺎ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺷﻴﻤﺎ ( ٢٠٠٣٣) ١ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ. ﺗﻮﺟﺟﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺛﺮﺮﻭ ِ
Kashima & Kashima & ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٣
ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺩﺭﺟﻪ ي ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ -ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﻲ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺭﺍ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺟﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺖ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ -ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ ﻣﺜﺒ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻲ ٤٠ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺳﻮ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ (١٩٩٨ ) ١ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭ٢ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ. ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ :ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎﺕِ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭﺿﺎﻉ ﻭ ﺍﺣﻮﺍ ﹺﻝ ﻲ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ( ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕ ﹺ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋ ﹺ
Suh et al ١ ٢ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕِ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﺩﺭ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎ ) ( normﻗﻮﺍﻋﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﻭ ﻗﻮﺍﻋﺪ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻋﺎﻳﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي " ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﺎ " ﻭ" ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﺎ " ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﻫﺎ ) ( valuesﺁﺭﻣﺎﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﺰﺍﻋﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي – ٥٦ﻡ (
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٤
ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺍﻭﻳﺰﺭﻣﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ٦ ،( ٢٠٠٢ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ٨ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻓﻴﺴﮏ ) ( ٢٠٠٢ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﺪ : ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ" ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺭﻳﻨﻬﻮﻟﺪ ﻣﺴﻨﺮ ،ﻭﺍﻥ ﮔﻮﮒ ،ﻣﻬﺎﻣﺘﺎ ﮔﺎﻧﺪي ،ﻣﺎﻳﮑﻞ ﺟﺮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﺁﺩﻭﻟﻒ ﻫﻴﺘﻠﺮ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ" ! ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ " ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺗﻌﻬﺪﺍﺕ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻧﻮﻉ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻭ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺷﮑﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺩﻟﻴﻠﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻞ ﺗﺎﮐﻴ ِﺪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ،ﻋﻀﻮ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎ ً ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ي ﺍﻭﻳﺰﺭﻣﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ " . ﺕ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ
ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍ – ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ،ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺕ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺷﻮﺍﺭﺗﺰ ( ١٩٧٧ ) ١ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻞ ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ : ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﺍﺻ ﹺ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ :ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﺨﺘﺎﺭي ) ٢ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ( ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻞ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ) ٣ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ( ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ . ﺺ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ :ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻭ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻻﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺗﺨﺼﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻌﺘﻘﺪﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺐ ) ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﻁ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ( ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.
Schwartz & Smith ١ Autonomy ٢ embeddedness ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٧٥
ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ٤ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﮓ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺍﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺷﺷﻮﺍﺭﺗﺰ ) ،(١٩٩٩٧ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻦ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭﻧﻈﺮ ﭼﻬﺎﺎﺭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﻨﮓ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪﺪ ﺍﺯ : .١ﺧﺎﺹ ﮔﮔﺮﺍ ) ١ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ +ﻧﻈﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻲ ( :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﭼﮏ ﻭ ﺭﻭﻣﺎﻧﻲ ( ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﻭ ﺷﺮﻕ ﺍﺭﻭﭘﭘﺎ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﻭﺳﻴﻪ ،ﺟﻤﻤﻬﻮﺭي ﮏ ﺷﻤﺎﻝ ﻭ ﺏ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺩﺭ ﺷﻤ .٢ﻋﺎﻡ ﮔﺮﺮﺍ ) ٢ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ +ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ( :ﻦ ﻏﺮﺏ ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎ ،ﺁﻣﺮﺮﻳﮑﺎ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﻟﻴﺎ ﻭ ﻧﻴﻮﺯﻟﻨﻟﻨﺪ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ . ي ) ٣ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ +ﻧﻈﻈﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﻪ ﻣﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻲ ( :ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺸﻮﻮﺭ .٣ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﮔﺮﺍي ﻋﻤﻮﺩي ﺟﻨﻮﺑﻲ ﻭ ﮊﺍﭘﻦ ( ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ . ﻲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻧﺪﻭﻧﺰي ،ﮐﮐﺮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺳﺳﻴﺎي ﺣﻮﺯﻩ ي ﺍﻗﻴﺎﻧﻮﺱﹺ ﺁﺭﺍﻡ ) ﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﮐﺸﻮﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺭ ﮓ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮي ( :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ي ﮔﺮﺍي ﺍﻓﻘﻲ ) ٤ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ + .٤ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﺟﻨﻮﺑﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ﻳﻮﻧﺎﻥﻥ ،ﺗﺮﮐﻴﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺳﭙﺎﻧﻴﺎ ( ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩ
Particularism m ١ un niversalism m ٢ vertical ccollectivism m ٣ ho orizontal collectivism m ٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٦
ﺕ ﻫﺎﻓﺴﺘﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺷﺪ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﺑﻨﺪﻩ ﺗﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻂ ﺗﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺗﻲﹺ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﻧﺪﻳﺲ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ١٩٩٦ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﮔﻠﻔﺎﻧﺪ ،ﺗﺮﻳﺎﻧﺪﻳﺲ ﻭ ﭼﺎﻥ ،١ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ١٩٩٣ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺕ ﻫﺎﻓﺲ ﺗﺪ ) ١٩٨٠ﻭ ( ١٩٨٣ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺗﺮﻳﺎﻧﺪﻳﺲ ﻭ ﻫﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺩﺭﺟﺎ ِ ﻒ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺽ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎً ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ٢ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻓﺮ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﻫﺎﻓﺴﺘﺪ ﻣﺒﻨﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎ ،ﮔﻠﻔﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ،ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ﻞ ﭘﺸﺖ ﮔﺮﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﮔﻲ، ﺏ ﺍﻫﺪﺍﻑ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﻓﮑﺮي ( ،ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﻨﺤﺮﻓﻴﻦ ( ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻞ ﺳﻠﻄﻪ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ،٤ﻣﺠﺎﺯﺍ ِ ﺖ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ( ﻭ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻗﺘﺪﺍﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ٣ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺧﺪﻣ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ :
.١ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ . .٢ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﻣﻌﮑﻮﺳﻲ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﺒﺪﺍﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻗﺘﺪﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺺ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺨﺼﺎ ً ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺷﺨ ﹺ ﺍﻗﺘﺪﺍﺭﮔﺮﺍ ﻗﺼ ِﺪ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
Gelfand , Triandis & Chan ١ : correlation ٢ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ .ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺁﻣﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ e ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣٠ : authoritarianism ٣ ﻣﮑﺘﺐ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﺗﺴﻠﻂ : submissiveness ٤ ﺗﺴﻠﻴﻢ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻦ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻣﺎﻧﺮﻭﺍﻳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻫﺒﺮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ(
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٧
ﮏ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺁﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﭘﻨﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﮏ ﺗ ِ ﮓ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ) ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺤﻮﺭي ( ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﮓ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) ﺟﻤﻊ ﻣﺤﻮﺭي ( .ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺗﺮﻳﺎﻧﺪﻳﺲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) (٢٠٠١ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻭ ﮓ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺤﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ٦٠ %ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻦ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ٦٠%ﺟﻤﻊ ﻣﺤﻮﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﮓ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ. ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٨
ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ : 9ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻅ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ 9ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﺩ. ﺷﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ،ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮓ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ،ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎﺕِ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ – ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ 9ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺭﺿﺎﻳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻫﻨﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺳﻮ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ (١٩٩٨ ﺽ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﺮ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮ ﹺ 8ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺻﺪﻕ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﮏ ﺗﮏِ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺍﺳﺖ. 8ﻣﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. 8ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ) ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ( ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺭﺩ ﺕ ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺑﺎ ﺞ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﺗﺮﻳﺎﻧﺪﻳﺲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ١٩٩٣ ) ﻭ ﮔﻠﻔﺎﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ( ( ١٩٩٦ ) 8ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻧﺎﻣﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻓﺮﺩﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻗﺒﻮﻝ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺧﻮﺩﺷﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺪﺍﻧﻲ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﺟﺰﺍي ﻣﺘﻨﻮﻉ ﻭ ﻣﻤﻠﻮ ﮐﻪ " ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ﻭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺑﻲ ﺭﺑﻂ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) " .ﺍﻭﻳﺰﺭﻣﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ٢٠٠٢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﺎ ِ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٧٩
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ،ﺑﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺒﺮﺩ . ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﺩ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮐﺎً ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ . ﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ،ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩي ،ﺭﺷﺪ ،ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﮐﺎﺭﺍﻳﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ. ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺑﻲ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺖ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺳﺘﻴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺪﻑ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺷﻬﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮ ِﻥ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ . ﻳﮏ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﮑﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺗﻠﻘﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﻋﻴﻨﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﻃﺮﻓﻲ ،ﻣﺤ ِ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ،ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﺍﻳﻢ. ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ) ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ( ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﻧﺘﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ي ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ .
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻝ ٨٠
ﺖ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺖ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺭﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﺟﺟﻬ ِ ﺕِ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﻓﻬﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭ ﺮ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺭﺍ ﻲ ﻣﻮﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻬ ﺏ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﻨﺎﺎﻗﺾ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺁﺁﺷﻔﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﻴﻴﻠﮕﺮﺍﻡ ( ،ﮐﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﺑﺎ ﺶ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ )ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ي ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻨﻴﻦ، ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻧﮕﺮ « ﺚ ي ﭘﺲ ﻧﮕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ » ﺳﻮﮔﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺖ ﺕ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎﺎي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﺭﻑ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻢ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻧﺪ . ﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﻳﺎﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﺳﺳﺘﺎﻭﺭﺩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﻫﻤﻤﮕﻲ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ٨٠%ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﻪ ي ﻗﺮ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ٢٠% .ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺰ ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ . ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﻭﭘﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ) ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺧﺎﺹ ( ﻭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﻫﺎي ﮓ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺍي ) ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﻪ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ي ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﮎ ﺗﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺩﺭ ِ ِ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ( ﺍﺯ ﺍﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻲ ﮓ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻫﻫﻤﻪ ي ﮎ ﺩﺭ ﻝﹺ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ،ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﻏﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﮐﮐﻢ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻮﺩﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﺣﺎﻝ ،ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻝ ﻴﺮ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ( ﻣﻣﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ي ﮎ ﺕ ﺩﺭ ِ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ) ﺭ ﺶ ﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﮕﻲ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺮ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕِ ﺕِ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺭﻗﻴﺐ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻣﺜﺎﻝ، ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺐ ﺎ ﺏ ﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻪ ﻲ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻥ ﺏ ﻣﻨﺸﺎ ِﺀ ﺗﻔﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺘﻲ ﺭ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ _ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻋﻲ ﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﺏﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺒﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﮔﺎﻩِﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﻲ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻳﻲ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ِ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺍ ﻭ ﻊ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻭ ﮓ ﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺧﻴﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺕ ﺍﺧﻴ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺗﺤ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻣﻣﺘﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ، ﺩﻭ ،ﺭ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻲ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻉ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻧﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺗﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺻ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺖ ﺻﺪﻕ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﮓ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻕ ﮏ ﺍﻓﺮﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺗ ِ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨١
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ] [١ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺩﻭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡﹺ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺖ ﺍﻭﻝ :ﺑﻪ ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻇﺎﻫﺮي ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷ ِ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ﻋﻀﻼﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﺍﻩ ﺭﻓﺘﻦ ،ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ) motor ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ( behaviourﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰﻡ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻨﺪ . ﺐ » ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ « ﺩﺍﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﻟﮕﺪ ﺖ ﺩﻭﻡ :ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻟﻘ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷ ِ ﺯﺩﻥ ،ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﻟﮕﺪ ﺯﺩﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻣﺒﺤﺜﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺳﺮﺩﺭﮔﻤﻲ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ،ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ « ﻧﮕﺮﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٠٥
ﻒ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺯ » ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ « ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ] [٢ﭼﻨﺪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ ﻑ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ .١ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﺨﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﺪ ِ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯي ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴ ﹺﻢ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺍﻥ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻮ ﹺﻝ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﺯﻩ ي ﻣﺤﻮﺭي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺭﺍ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﺕِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﺻﻼﺡ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﻢ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ . ﺢ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺷﻤﺲ ﺍﺳﻔﻨﺪ ﺁﺑﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ -ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٧ -٢٨ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴ ﹺ
ﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻞ ﻑ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ﹺ .٢ﻫﺪ ِ ﮏ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ،ﺳﻌﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﮐﻤ ِ ﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻭ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺻ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺍﮔﻴﺮﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﺷﻤﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻦ ﻳﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺎﻧﻮ ِﻥ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻣﻮﺭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺻﺎﺩﻕ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ . ﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺳﺎﺭﻭﺧﺎﻧﻲ ١٣٦٦ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٢
ﻦ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﭘﻴﺪﺍﻳﺶ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺒﻮﻝ ][٣ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺕ ﻧﻴﻤﻪ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ،ﻧﻴﻤﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﺁﻏﺎﺯﮔ ﹺﺮ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺤﺚ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺗﺮﻳﻦ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻗﻨﺎﻉ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩﺍ ِ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ – ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥٧ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
ﺦ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺮ ِﺩ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭ ] [٤ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﮔﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﭘﺮﺳﻴﺪﻧﺪ " ﺁﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﺭي ؟ " ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﻃﺮ ﺑﻴﺎﻭﺭﻳﻢ ؛ ﺍﻭ ﺟﻮﺍﺏ ﺩﺍﺩ " :ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ؛ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺭﺍﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺙ ﺙ ﺣﻘﻮﻗﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻦ ﻣﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺩﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻡ ." ! ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻦ ﺛﺮﻭ ِ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻗﺎﺋﻞ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺘﻦ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ،ﻭﺭﺍﺛ ِ ﮏ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻖ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺻﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤ ِ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦ ﭼﺎ ﹺ
] [٥ﺭﻭﺷﻲ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ،ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺕ ﺁﺷﮑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺱ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﺵ ﺢ ﺭﺧﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ،ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺸﻬﺎ ي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ،ﺑﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎ ،ﻗﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﭼﻴﺰﻫﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺵ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎ ً ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﺿﺪ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎ ِﺩ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩي ﻧﺎﻗﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩي ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
] [٦ﻣﺘﺎﺳﻔﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺷﻔﺘﮕﻲ ،ﺍﺑﻬﺎﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي mind ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻭ ﺟﺪﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺳﺮ ﺁﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺫﻫﻦ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ،ﺭﻭﺡ ،ﻋﻘﻞ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٣
ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺫﻫﻦ « ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻢ .ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺸﺪﺍﻭﺭي ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ -ﻡ ﻑ ﻭﺍﺗﺴﻮﻥ ،ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ] [٧ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍي ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ،ﺑﻲ .ﺍﻑ .ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺘﺂﺧﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﻞ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻲ ﻦ ﻋﻠ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻦ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺫﻫﻦ ﻳﺎ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻧﮑﺎﺭ ﻧﮑﺮﺩ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﻌﺘﻘﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻦ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻮﺍﻓﻘﻲ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻞ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ،ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍ ﻭ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﺟﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ،ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻦ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺟﻪِ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺷﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻬﻲ ﻣﻨﺤﺮﻑ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨﺮ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺭﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﭘﻲ ﻧﮕﺮي ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺰﻟﻪ ي ﻣﻨﺒﻌﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻖ ﻋﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ،ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﺎﺑﻪ ي ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺣﻘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﻴﻨﻲﹺ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﻪ ي ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨﺮ ،ﻣﻮﻟﻔﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺟﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻟﺬﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺐ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻭ ﺗﺎﮐﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻮﻟﻔﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻞ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗ ﹺ ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩
ﺏ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫﻪ ﻫﺎي ١٩٦٠ﻭ ١٩٧٠ﺩﺭ ] [٨ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮔﺎﻩ ﺍﻧﻘﻼ ﹺ ﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ – ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﻋﻨﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺣﺬﻑ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎي ﺷﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﺎﺑﻪ ي ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ – ﻇﻬﻮﺭﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﻧﻮ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ، ﺶ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻗﺒﻠ ﹺ ﻭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺹ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺹ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺡ ﻓﺮﺍﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﺎﺗﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﺑﺮﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ. ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٤
ﺕ ﻂ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮑﺎ ِ ﻦ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﺮﮐﻲ ﺧﺎﺹ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ] [٩ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﺖ ﺺ ﺑﻴﺪﺍﺭ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺑﻲ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ،ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺻﺪﺍ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺮﮐ ِ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺷﺨ ﹺ ﺺ ﺑﻴﺪﺍﺭ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ،ﻳﺎ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭﺭ ﻭ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻭ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺟﻠﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺨ ﹺ ﻑ ﮏ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ،ﻣﺘﺮﺍﺩ ِ ﺖ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﺭﻭي ﻳﮏ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﺕ ﺑﻲ ﺭﺑﻂ ﺭﺍ ﺣﺬﻑ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮑﺎ ِ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ) ( alertnessﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺯﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ) consciousness ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ) alertnessﻭ ( consciousnessﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ( ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ) ( alertnessﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻳﻌﻨﻲ consciousnessﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﻔﺼﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﺍﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
ﺕ ﺧﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻦ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ،ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺿﻤ ﹺ ] [١٠ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ) ﭼﺸﻢ ،ﮔﻮﺵ ﻭ ( ...ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺷﺨﺺ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ
ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ :ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮓ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻢ ﺁﻣﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺢ ﺣﺴﻲ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺟﺰ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺧﻂ ﻭ ﺭﻧ ِ ﺻﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺒﻠ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺍﺻﻮﻻً ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) ( sensationﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ -ﻡ ﺢ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ] [١١ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ .١ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻗﻠﻤﺪﺍﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺗﺠﺎﺭﺏ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ،ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ . ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١
ﺖ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻭ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻫﺎ .٢ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﺟﺎﺕِ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٥
ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﻣﺮﺗﺐ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺩﺭﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮﭼﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ي ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﺗﺎ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﻳﻢ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨﺴﺘﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺻﺎً ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻩ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ، ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ي ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺝ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ .ﻫﺮﭼﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﹺ ي ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ،ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﻌﻄﺎﻑ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﮐﻠﻴﺸﻪ ﺍي ) ( streotypeﻭ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﺮي ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺁﺑﻨﻮﺱ ،ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺎﻫ ﹺ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﺮ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭﺩﺍﺩي ﻭ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺏ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺎﺭ ﹺ ] [١٢ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ ،ﻋﻤﺪﺗﺎً ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﭖ ﻫﻔﺪﻫﻢ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١١ ﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ -ﺍﺛﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﺳﻮﺍﻻﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ي ﺍﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﻫﺪ ،ﻭﺿ ﹺﻊ ﺭﺷﺪ ﹺ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺳﺎﻟﻬﺎي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ،ﻧﻮﺟﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ؟ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ١٢ﺳﺎﻟﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻠﻮ ﹺﻍ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ١٦ﺳﺎﻟﮕﻲ ﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﭖ ﻫﻔﺪﻫﻢ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٤ ﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ -ﺍﺛﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﺖ ﺕ ﺯﻳﮕﻤﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺎﻳﺪﺍﺭي ﺑﺮ ﺷﺨﺼﻴ ِ ] [١٣ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻲ ﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺻﺎً ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ .ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﮑﺎﻭﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐ ﹺ ﻲ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ. ﺖ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮏ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﮐﻤ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻮﻝ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻧﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﻝ .ﻣﺎﻥ -ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻗﺘﺒﺎﺱ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﭽﻲ -ﻧﺸﺮ ﺍﻣﻴﺮﮐﺒﻴﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٦
][١٤ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ :ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻮﺷﺪ ﺑﻔﻬﻤﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﻫﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ، ﻲ ﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺩ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﻪ ،ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺣﻀﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ،ﺧﻴﺎﻟﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺤ ﹺ ﻁ ﺗﻨﮕﺎﺗﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭﻳﮑﻪ ﺗﻔﮑﻴﮏ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎ ِ ﺱ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﻧﻈﺮﺍﻥ ،ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
] [١٥ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ » ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ : .ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﺹ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎﺭ ) ﻧﻮﺍﺑﻎ ،ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﻋﻘﻞ ﻫﺎ ،ﺩﻳﻮﺍﻧﮕﺎﻥ ( .١ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺷﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
.٢ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﻋﺎﺩي ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
] [١٦ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ .ﺗﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺩﺧﺎﻟﺖ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺶ ﻫﺮﻳﮏ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﭘﻴﺶ ﺁﻣﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﺞ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ي ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎ ﹺ ﺶ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻄﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻓﺮﻳﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺧﺎﻟ ِ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﻁ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﮒ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺳﻘﻮ ِ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺩﺧﺎﻟ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺮﻭي ﮔﺮﺍﻧﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﻧﻴﺮﻭي ﻣﻘﺎﻭﻣﺖِ ﻫﻮﺍ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺮﮒ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺴﻴﺮي ﻁ ﺑﺮﮒ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﺧﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺯﻳﮕﺰﺍﮔﻲ ﻓﺮﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﻫﺮﮔﺎﻩ ﻭﺿﻌﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻘﻮ ِ ﻁ ﺑﺮﮒ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﺍﻧﺶ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ؛ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﻥ ﻫﻮﺍ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺳﺎﺯﻳﻢ ،ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻘﻮ ِ ﺢ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻁ ﺳﻨﮓ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻫﺮﮔﺎﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺠﺮﺍي ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺹ ،ﻫﻮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻘﻮ ِ ﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻦ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺍ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻤ ِ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﻗﻮﺍﻧﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٧
ﺐ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﺍﺟﺰﺍي ﺁﻥ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﻪ ﺭﻳﺰي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺮﮐ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻋﻠﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺍﺑﺮﺍ ﹺﺯ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﭖ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺕ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﻳﺶ ﻓﻠﺴﻔﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺭﺍﻳﺸﻨﺒﺎﺥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺳﻲ ﺍﮐﺮﻣﻲ – ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍ ِ -١٣٨٤ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٢٨ -١٢٧
eﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﻣﺰﺭﻋﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞِ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮ ﺭﺷﺪِ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥِ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ.
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٨
ﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ] [١٧ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎ :ﺍﺻﻮﻻً ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺍﻭ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻧﻮﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖ، ﺳﻦ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ،ﺻﺪﺍ ﻭ ...ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻋﻨﺪ : ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ :ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﺎﺭي ﻭ ﮐﻢ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ﺶ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﺗﺎﻕ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ . ً ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ :ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﻨﮓ ﺶ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﮏ ﭼﺸﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻣ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﻖ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﮕﺮ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ،ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺕ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ،ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٣ -١٢
] [١٨ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﮎ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻋﻴﻨﻴﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺵ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮﻳﻬﺎي ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮي ﻳﺎ ﺗﻌﺼﺐ ﺭﻫﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ. .١ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
.٢ﺁﻥ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﺍﻭﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎﺕ ﻣﺘﺎﺛﺮ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ ؛ ﺁﺯﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺗﻌﺒﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
ﻦ ﺣﻘﺎﻳﻖ ﺁﻧﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻧﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻨﺎﻧﮑﻪ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺁﺭﺯﻭﻣﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺩﻳﺪﻥ ﻭ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ .٣ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
ﻂ ﭘﻮﭘﺮ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﻋﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ] [١٩ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي :ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻓﻠﺴﻔﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺐ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻗﺪﺍﻡ ﺖ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺗﮑﺬﻳ ﹺ ﺻﺤ ِ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﻪ ﺑﺪﻟﻴ ﹺ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٨٩
ﻲ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺤﻘﻖ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻠﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘ ﹺ ﺕ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ( verificationismﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺪﻋﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻮﺷﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺛﺒﺎ ِ ﻖ ﻣﻨﻄﻖ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ. ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺩﺭﺳﺘ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﮐﺸﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي
] [٢٠ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻨﺮي ،ﻣﺬﻫﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺑِﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻼ ﹺ ﺵ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﻫﺪ – ﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﺑﻪ ﺣﺮﮐ ِ ] [٢١ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻲ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﻋﺒﺚ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﺖ ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺖ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺳﺖ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﺕ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﻪ ي ﻗﻮ ِ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ – .ﻡ ] [٢٢ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﭼﻮﺑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺤﻘﻖ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻭ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﻫﻨﻤﺎﻳﹺﻴﺂﻥ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﺒﻨﺪي ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺮﮔﺰ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﺑﻪ ﺹ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ي ﺧﺎ ﹺ ﺕ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺁﺯﻣﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻫﺎ ﹺ ﺁﺯﻣﻮﻥ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭﺍ ِ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻳﺎ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺤﻘﻖ ﻭ ﺐ " ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺏ ﺭﺥ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ .ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺩ " ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻄﻼ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ، ﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﺕ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺛﺒﺎ ِ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ ﻞ » ﺑﺪ « ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﮐﻪ » ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ « ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﻭ ﭼﻴﺰﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﮐﻪ " ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻃﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﻳﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ" ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺧﻄ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻃﺎ ِﻥ ﺭﻳﻪ ﺭﺍ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٩٠
ﻞ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺯﺍي ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺳﻞ ﺶ ﺑﺸﺮي ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺢ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺎ ً ﺍﺑﻄﺎﻝ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺧﺪﻣﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻻﺑﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺞ ﻋﻤﻠﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺍﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍي ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﮑﻨﺪ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻃﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮﺧﺎﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺵ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺁﺯﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ،ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺮ ﹺ ي ﺁﻥ ﺗﻨﺎﻗﺾ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺟﺮﺡ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻳﮑﺴﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺖ. ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ :ﻳﮏ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﻭﺍﻡ ﻭ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺭﻫﻴﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻮﺩﻣﻨﺪي ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺩﻫﺪ". ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي٦٠-٥٩ ﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻴﺘﺲ ،ﭘﻼﮒ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﻞ ﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻖ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺿﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ] [٢٣ﺟﻨﺒﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻂ ﻭﺍﺗﺴﻮﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ١٩١٣ﺍﺑﺪﺍﻉ ﺷﺪ. ﻞ ﺳﻨﺠﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ
– ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ
ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( -٢ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ،ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ – ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺣﺬﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ) ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ( ﺭﺍ ﻑ ﺑﺎﻭﺭ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ، ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ) ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ( ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺧﻼ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺘﺎﺧﺮ ﺭﻭﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻧﺪﻫﻲ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺳﺨ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻴﻢ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ، ﻑ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﻣﺎ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ،ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺻﺮ ِ ﻒ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻧﮕﺮي ﻭ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ) .ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻖ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻴﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻼﻡ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﺨﺎﻟ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﺧﻮ ِﺩ ﻓﺮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻳﮏ ﻒ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻧﮕﺮي ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺻﻴ ِ ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﮎ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺩ ﭘﺮﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﭼﻪ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ؟ ( ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٠ -١٣ -١٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٩١
ﺕ ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺨﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻘﺎﻳﺪﺷﺎﻥ ،ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻳ ِﺪ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ] [٢٤ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻧﮕﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻗﺒﻮﻝ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ) ﻲ ﺧﺎﺹ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺖ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ( cognitive dissonanceﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻳﺎ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺩﺭ ﺗﻨﺎﻗﺾ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ،ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﺕ ﺁﺭﻭﻧﺴﻮﻥ .ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﺮ ﮐﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺭﺷﺪ ١٣٨٦ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻲ ] [٢٥ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻔﺘﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺯﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻳﻢ ،ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ،ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺫﻫﻦ – ﻫﻨﺮ ،ﺍﺩﺑﻴﺎﺕ ،ﻣﻮﺳﻴﻘﻲ ﻭ ﻧﻘﺎﺷﻲ – ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ .ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ،ﺁﻧﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻴﺒﺮﻧﺪ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺒﻴﺮﹺ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ي ﺁﻥ ،ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﻭﺭ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﻫﺎ ،ﺭﺳﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻄﺒﻴﻖ ﺑﺎ ﺟﻬﺎﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺁﻣﻮﺯﺵ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ . ﻲ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﮔﻲ ،ﺍﻟﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﮐﺎﺭﺷﺎﻥ ،ﻣﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺬﻫﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻲ ﻟﺒﺎﺱ ﭘﻮﺷﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ،ﺭﺳﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺯﺩﻭﺍﺝ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻏﺖ ،ﻫﻤﻪ ﺟﺰ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺳﺮﮔﺮﻣﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻗﺎ ِ ﻞ ﮐﺎﻻﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ي ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ – ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻴﺮ ﻭ ﮐﻤﺎﻥ ،ﺧﻴﺶ ،ﮐﺎﺭﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺷﻴﻦ ،ﮐﺎﻣﭙﻴﻮﺗﺮ ،ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻭ ﻣﺴﮑﻦ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥٦ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٧ ﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻴﺘﺲ ،ﭘﻼﮒ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺴ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﮓ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﻭﺭي ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ] [٢٦ﻳﮏ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺧﻮﺩﻣﺪﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺩي ،ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﺪﺍﺭي ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻮﺍﻣ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ.ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺍي ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺧﻮﺩي ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺭﺳﻮﻣﺸﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺪﮔﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻃﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻧﻔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٣ ﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻴﺘﺲ ،ﭘﻼﮒ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٩٢
◄ ﺳﺎﻝ -١٩٥٧ﺩﻭﺭﻭﺗﻲ ﮐﺎﻧﺘﺲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺭﻭﺯ ِ ﻭﺭﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺑﻴﺮﺳﺘﺎﻥ ِ ﻫﺎﺭي ﻫﺎﺭﺩﻳﻨﮓ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ .ﮐﺎﻧﺘﺲ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ﺁﻣﻮﺯِ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ﭘﻮﺳﺘﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺑﻴﺮﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﺍﺭ ﻭ ﺍﺫﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻭ ٤ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺑﻴﺮﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺮﮎ ﮐﻨﺪ.
] [٢٧ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﺯ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﻧﺴﺒﻴﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﮐﻪ ﻋﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﻓﺎﻉ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ » ﺖ ﻧﺴﺒﻴﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ « ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻀﻴﻪ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺑﺤﺚ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٣ ﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻴﺘﺲ ،ﭘﻼﮒ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ٩٣
ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻧﻲ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺕ ] [٢٨ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻂ ﻧﺎﻣﺴﺎﻋﺪِ ﺍﻗﻠﻴﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻏﺬﺍ ﻭ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺣﻔﺎﻇﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ي ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﺯﻣﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊﹺ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﮕﻬﺪﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺯﺍﺩ ﻭ ﻭﻟ ِﺪ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻏﺬﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﺸﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ،ﮐﻪ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻧﺎﺑﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺒﺎﺭﺯﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻠﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻣﺪ ِ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻋﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥٧ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ " ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ" – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
ﺕ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ] [٢٩ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﻭ ﺗﺪﺍﻭﻡ ﺑﺨﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿ ﹺﻊ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﺎ ِ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ " ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮي ﻭ ﺳﻠﻄﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﺴﻠﻂ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﺎﺑﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ " .ﺳﭙﺲ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺑﻊ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﭼﻴﺰي ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺟﺰ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ. ﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺑﻴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ– ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﮐﺮ ﹺﻡ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ – ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٧١
] [٣٠ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺟﻮﺩِ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺩﻭ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ﻭ ﭼﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﻑ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮﻫﺎي » ﺍﻟﻒ « ﻭ » ﺏ « ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻧﺎﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺻﺮ ِ ﮐﻪ » ﺍﻟﻒ « » ،ﺏ « ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﺎ » ﺏ « » ،ﺍﻟﻒ « ﺭﺍ .ﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻈﻴﺮ » ﺝ « ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺐ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ » ﺍﻟﻒ « ﻭ » ﺏ« ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻦ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻋﻠﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ. ﺣﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﺗﺼﺎﺩﻑ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻀﻤ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﺮﺿﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺳﺎﺭﺍﺳﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﺠﺎﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦٤
٩٤ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ: ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ
: ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ Eysenck , M. W. ( ٢٠٠٠ ). Psychology : A students handbook. Hove , UK : Psychology Press . ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺜﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﺷﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ، ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ٣٢ ﺗﺎ٣٠ ﻓﺼﻞ Eysenck , M.W. ( ٢٠٠٢ ). Simply psychology ( ٢nd ed. ). Hove , UK : Psychology Press. . ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ٢١ ﺐ ﺳﻮﺩﻣﻨﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺮﻥ ﻣﻄﺎﻟ ﹺ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ Gravetter , F. J. , & Forzano , L.–A.B. ( ٢٠٠٢ ). Research methods for the behavioural sciences. New York : Thomson / Wadsworth. .ﺵ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮي ﻣﺤﻘﻘﺎﻥ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺜﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭ ﹺ Gravetter , F. J. , & Wallnau , L. B. ( ١٩٩٨ ). Essentials of statistics for the behavioural sciences. New York : Thomson / Wadsworth. .ﺕ ﺁﻣﺎﺭي ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ِ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ Smith , P. B. , Bond , M. H. ( ١٩٩٨ ). Social psychology across cultures ( ٢nd ed. ). London : Prentice Hall. . ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﺁﺷﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ Biological Psychology
٩٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺗﻼﺵ ﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻧﻮﻳﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﻧﻮﺑﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ١ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞ ي ﻗﺒﻞ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ " ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ،ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ،ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺻﺎً ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﻲ ﺕ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎﺕ ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ) .ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ( ١٩٩٨ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ) ﻭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ( ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ) (١٩٩٧ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ٦ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ :
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ
ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ
ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ
ﻋﺼﺒﻲ
ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ
ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ
biological psychology ١ﻳﺎ biopsychology
٩٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ: ١ .١ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ،ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﺎﺭي ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﺪي، ﻣﺸﻐﻠﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺪﻓﻤﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺕ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺖ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻨﻈﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺮﺍﺣﻲ ،ﺷﻮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺞ ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻣﺪ. ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﮎ ﺑﻬﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ :ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭ ِ ﻑ ﻣﺎ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮ ﹺﺯ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﻭ ﻫﺪ ِ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ي ﺑﺮﻕ ﺭﺍ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺍﻓﺘﺎﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﮎ ﺭﻧﮕﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻣﻀﺤﮏ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺘﺤﺮ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﺍﺗﺼﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﻕ ﺍﺳﺖ ! ﺢ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻤﻨﻮﻋﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻼﻗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻴﺎﺯي ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺞ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﻌﻤﻴﻢ ﺩﺍﺩ ؟ ﺑﺤﺚ ﻭ ﺟﺪﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﮎ ﻞ ﺗﻌﻤﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﺋﻴﺪ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻣﺤﮑﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ
physiological psychology ١
٩٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ: ١ .٢ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺧﺎﺹ ،ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺷﺒﻴﻪِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺖ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺗﻮﺟ ِﻪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻨﺎﻭﺭي ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﮎ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺽ ﺟﺎﻧﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺕ ﻣﺨﺮ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺮ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻨﻴﺎﺩي ﺗﺮي ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺟﺰﺋﻴﺎﺕِ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ.
ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :٢ .٣ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ .ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﺴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲﹺ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ،ﺍﺗﺴﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺐ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺶ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﺿﺮﻳ ﹺ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﻬﺎ ،ﺍﺯ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﮏ ،ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺍﻧﺴﻔﺎﻟﻮﮔﺮﺍﻡ ( EEG ) ٣ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ. psychopharmacology ١ psychophysiology ٢ ﺝ ﻣﻐﺰي ﻣﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ . : electroencephalogram ٣ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﻧﻮﺳﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻭﻟﺘﺎﮊ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻢ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺍﻣﻮﺍ ﹺ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﻭ ﺛﺒﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺍﻧﺴﻔﺎﻟﻮﮔﺮﺍﻑ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ﺑﻪ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻖ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺩﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﭘﻮﺳ ِ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﮐﺎﻭﺵ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺖ ﺳﺮ ﮐﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻂ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺍﻧﺴﻔﺎﻟﻮﮔﺮﺍﻑ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺍﻧﺴﻔﺎﻟﻮﮔﺮﺍﻡ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ EEG . ﻣﻮﺟﻬﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺪﺍﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺺ ﺻﺮﻉ ،ﺗﻮﻣﻮﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﻭ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺸﺨﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲﹺ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ، ﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤٧
٩٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﺵ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ( ERP ) ١ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي EEG ﺩﺭ ٢٠ﺳﺎﻝ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي EEGﺑﻨﺎ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮ ﻃﺮﻓﺪﺍﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺐ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺗﺮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ( ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ERP .ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﻳﻢ.
ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ،ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﻧﮕﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً PET ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻲ ﺍﺳﮑﻦ MRI ،ﺗﺎﺑﻌﻲ ﻭ ( ...ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻒ ﻣﻐﺰ _ ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺳﺖ _ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
event –related potential ١ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ : • ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ،ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ . ﺐ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ • ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي EEGﮐﻪ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﻫﺮ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﺁﻏﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺮﺗﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ . •
ﺝ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﺟﺰﺍي EEGﺭﺍﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻫﻢ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺎ ERPﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
٩٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻡ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﻲ: ١ ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺳ .٤ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺯﺩ. يﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻲ ﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰﺰي ﺑﺮ ﻋﻤﻠ ﺕ ﺐ ﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺐ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ ﮐﺪﺍﺍﻡ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺎﻳﺎ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ي ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺒﺎ ً ﺗﻼﺵ ﻲ ﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﺼ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺪﺪﻑ ﺍﺯ ﮏ ﻣﻐﻨﺎﻃﻴﺴﻲ ﺗﺸﺪﻳﺪMRI ) ٢ ﻲﹺ ﻣﺨﺘﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮﺑﺮﺩﺍﺭﺭي ﻦ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ( ﺍﺳﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺷﺒﺎﻫ ِ ﺼﺒﻲ« ٣ ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻋﺼ ﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ » ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﺼ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺷﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﹺ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ. ﺁﻧﺖ ) ٤ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺩﺭ (١٩٩٩ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺖ ي ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺷﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﭼﭗ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﻔ
ﮔﻴﺞ .ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪ ﺮ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺟﻤﺠﻤﻪ ي ﻓﻴﻨﻴﺎﺱ ﺞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭ ﺳﺨﻦ ﺧﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﮔﻔﺖ .
ﺖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡﻡ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
neuropsychology ١ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮﺳﺎﺯي ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﻳﺮﺳﺎﺯي ،ي : magneticc Resonancce imagingg ٢ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮﺳﺎﺯي ﺭﺯﻭﻧﺎﻧﺲ ﻣﻐﻨﺎﻃﻃﻴﺴﻲ .ﺩﺭ ﻦ ﺗﻔﮑﻴﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺳﻔﻔﻴﺪ ﮏ ﺟﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺷﺷﻌﻪ ي Xﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﻐﻨﺎﻃﻴﺲ ﻭ ﺍﻣﻮﻮﺍﺝ ﺭﺍﺩﻳﻮﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ MRI .ﺭﻭﺵ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺭﺯﺯﺷﻲ ﺩﺭ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻲ ﮓ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ) (CSFﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﻴﻦ ﺣﺣﺠ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻄﻦ ي ﻦ ﻣﺎﻳﻊ ﻣﻐﺰي – ﻧﺨﺎﻋ ﹺ ﺧﺎﮐﺴﺘﺮي ﻣﻐﺰ ،ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻦ ﻭ ﺧﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( coognitive neeurosciencee ٣ Annettt ٤
١٠٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻡ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﻲ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪﻪ ﺍي: ١ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺳ .٥ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺭي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺮﺩ ،ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺕ ﮐﻨﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻲ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﭘﺬﻳﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻲ ﺦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﻘﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺗﺎﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻳ ﻳﮑﺪﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﺴﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﺪ .ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي ،ﺗﻼ ﻖ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺚ ﻣﺨﺘﺼ ﻲ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺼﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻣﻴﺎﺎﻥ ﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ،ﺑﺤ ِ ﺁﻣﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﻲ: ٢ .٦ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺳ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﻣﺘﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺯ ٥ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘ ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭﺭي ﺑﺎ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑ ﻲ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻲ ﻣﻘﺎﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﻦ ﻪ ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﻳﮑ ﺗﺎﮐﻴ ِﺪ ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﺑﺮ ﻲ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﺴﻪ ﺍي ﻴ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺭﻭﻳﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺖ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﻳﺴﻪ ي ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺎ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻨﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺽﹺ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻠﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﻲ ﻲ ﻣﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺳﺎﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺽﹺ ﻣﻌﺮﺽ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻧﮋﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻃ ﹺ ﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻴ ﻲ ﺗﮑ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺖ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺘﺮي ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻲ
ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ : Comﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﻄﻄﺒﻴﻘﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻪ mparative psychology p y١ p y ٢ evollutionary psychology
١٠١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ
ﺶ ﭘﺮﺭﻧﮓ ﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ،ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ) (١٩٩٧ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ " :ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﻴﭽﮑﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺪﺭﺕ ﮒ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﺰﺭ ِ ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻧﻘﺺ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ،ﻣﻌﻀﻼ ِ ﭘﻨﺞ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻂ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ي ﺧﺎﺹ ﺕ ﻫﺮ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ،ﺿﻌﻒ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻁ ﻗﻮ ِ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻓﻊ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ". ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻳﻢ.
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻲ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ٦ ،ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ. .١ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ :ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﺪي ﻭ ﻫﺪﻓﻤﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ. ﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ .٢ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ. ﻲ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ .٣ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ. ﺕ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ .٤ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ :ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ. ﻲ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﹺ .٥ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺍي :ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ .٦ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ :ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ.
١٠٢
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺼﻞ ﺳﺳﻮﻡ ﻓﺼ ﺩﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﺎﻣﻠﻲ
١٠٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
١٠٤
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ : ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ :ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ١٠٣ ............................................................................................................... ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ١٠٤ ...................................................................................................................... : ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ١٠٥ ........................................................................................................................... : ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ١١٣ ......................................................................................................................... : ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ١١٨ .................................................................................................................... :
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺩﻳﺪﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﺎﻣﻠﻲ : ﺩﺍﺑﺰﺍﻧﺴﮑﻲ ( ١٩٧٣ ) ١ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﮐﺮﺩ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺎﺭ ﺷﺪ .ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮑﻲ ﺖ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻘﺎﻟﻪ ﺍي ﮐﮐﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻤﻴ ﺕ ﺗﮑ ﻞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻧﺨﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻣﮕ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻗﺎ ﻣﻘﺎﻟﻟﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ " :ﻫﻴﭻ ﭼﻴﺰﺰي ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﮑﺎﻣﻞ ." ٢ﺑﺮﺍي ﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﭘﻨﺎ ِﻩ ﮐﮐﺸﻔﻴﺎ ِ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ : ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ،ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﻳﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺮ ﻮﻉ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ
ﺠﺎﺩﻟﻪ ي ﺳﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺗﺮﺑﻴﺖ : ﻣﺠ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻲ ﻳﺴﺖ ﮑﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺴ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﺭﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺠﺎﺩﺩﻟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻓﮑ ﻲ ﺑﺤﺚ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺚ ﻋﻠﻮﻮﻡ ،ﺟﺪﺍ ﹺﻝ ﺳﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺑﺑﻴﺖ ٣ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﺪﺍﻝِ ، ﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ) ﺳﺳﺮﺷﺖ ( ﻭ ي ) ﺗﺮﺑﻴﺖ ( ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼ ﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ٤ﻭ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺗﺎ ﭼﭼﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺗﻮﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻭ ﭼﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻂ ﻣ ً ﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﭼﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺷﺷﺨﺼﻴ ِ ﺖ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ؟ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑ ﺕ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻄﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻮ ﻂ ﺗﺠﺮﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺨﺼﻴ ِ ﺷﺨﺼ ﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﻧﻘﺸﺸﻲ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺮ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺠﺎﺩﻟﻪ ﺍﻳﻔﻔﺎ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻫﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮑﻞ ﺖ ﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻤﻴ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺑﺮﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .
Dobzhansky D y١ ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١ e evolutionn ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺑﺑﻴﺖ ،ﺫﺍﺗﻲ – ﺍﮐﺘﺴﺎﺑﻲ ،ﺳﺮﺷﺷﺖ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﻪ ﻲ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي : naturre_ nurturee ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻞ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ eﺑﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻞ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺮﻭﺭﺵ ،ﺖ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣ e enﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﻮﻉ nvironmentt ٤
١٠٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺑﺎ ﭼﺎﺭﻟﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ( ١٨٥٩ ) ١ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ،ﺁﻟﻔﺮﺩ ﺭﺍﺳﻞ ﻭﺍﻻﺱ ٢ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ( .ﻫﺪﻑ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﭘﺎﺳﺨﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ : ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻨﻘﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﺍﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﻃﺮﺍﺣﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺍﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ " ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻳﺒﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﺍﻩ ﻭ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻦ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺭﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭﺧﺖ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﺨﺶ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺑﺬﺭ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﮐﻮﺏ ﻳﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻗﻮﺭﺑﺎﻏﻪ ي ﺩﺭﺧﺘﻲ ﺣﻴ ﹺ ﻂ ﭘﺮﻫﺎ ﻭ ﭼﻨﮕﮏ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ .ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻢ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻋﺘﻨﺎ ﺑﺎﺷﻢ .ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ( ﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮕﻔﺖ ﺑﻮﺩﻡ ) " .ﺍﺗﻮﺑﻴﻮﮔﺮﺍﻓ ﹺ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ٣ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ
Charles Darwin ١ Alfred Russell Wallace ٢ e species ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤
١٠٦
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﻲ ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﻴﻴﺮ ﻫﺎ ،ﻃﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻣﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ، ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻮﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺜ ﮎِ ﺷﻮﺍﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺗﮑﺎﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﺎﻝ ،ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻓﺴﻴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺸﻒ ﺷﺷﺪﻩ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻨﺴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻃ ﹺ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩﺩﻩ ﺑﺲ ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ،ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻪ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻠﻮ ﻭ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺭﺭﺍﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺖ
ﺍﺳﺖ : ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻣﺤﺪﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﺖ ﺕ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻓﻓﺴﻴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﮐﮐﺸﻒ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻞ ﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﺠ ﺣﻠﻘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻔﻘﻮﻮﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻪ ﻦ ﻓﺴﺴﻴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺛﺒﺖ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺳﺨ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ } .ﭼﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺶ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺖ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﻲ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺨ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﺪﻩ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻣﺮﺑﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺶ ﺕِ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺮﺮﻡ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ{. ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺯ ﻣﻄﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﻭي ﺕ ﻞﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﻭ ﺷﻮﺍﻫ ِﺪ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﺮﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺋﻴ ِﺪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺗﻐﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻤﻤﻮﻣﺎ ً ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻪ ﻒِ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻀﺎي ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﻟﺨﻮﻮﺍﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺶ ﺍﻋﻀ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻌﻌﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮔﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺯ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻧﹺ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺷﮑﺎﺭﮔﺮﺍﻥ ﻲ ي ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻧﻧﮕﺎﺭﻧﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺁﺏ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺍﻫﺎ ،ﻏﺬﺬﺍﻫﺎ، ﺕ ﺳﺎﺯﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺿﺮﻭﺭ ِ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺿ ﺖ ﺑﻘﺎﺎﺀ ﻭ ﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻭ ﺳﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻓﺸﺎﺭﻫﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻧﺎﺷﺷﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ .ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻳﻦ ) ﻴ ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻳﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ( ١٨٥٩ي ﺟﻬ ِ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺢ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺖ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺟ ﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻃﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻧﻈﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨ ﺩﻭﺭﺭﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺶ ﺏ ﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﮐﺮﺩ.١ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻌﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺡ e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥
١٠٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺮ ٥ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺕ ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻗﺪ ( ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ) ﻣﺜﻼً .١ﺗﻨﻮﻉ : ١ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮي ( ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ.
ﺖ ﮐﻢ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻧﻮﺯﺍ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ .٢ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ : ٢ﺩﺳ ِ ﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺷﺒﻴﻪِ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳ ﹺ .٣ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ : ٣ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ .ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ) ( ١٨٥٩ﻣﺤﺎﺳﺒﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺸﮑﻠﻲ ﺑﻘﺎ ِﺀ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻬﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻓﻴﻞ ٧٥٠ﺳﺎﻝ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟ ِﺪ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺷﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ١٩ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻧﻮﻩ ﻭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻴ ِﺪ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ ﻦ ﺟﻔﺖ ،ﻏﺬﺍ ﻭ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺤﺎﺳﺒﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺖ ﺖ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻥ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭼﻪ ﺭﻗﺎﺑ ِ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺳﻬﻤﮕﻴﻨﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. : variation ١ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ،ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ e.ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٦ e: inheritance ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٧ competition ٣
١٠٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
.٤ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ : ١ﺍﻋﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻦ ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻮﻋﺎﻥ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺣﻴ ﹺ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺗﺮي ﺟﻬ ِ ي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ { ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻭ } ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻬﺪﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻲ ﺑﻘﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ٢ﺗﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.٣
ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻂ ﺍﻃﺮﺍﻓﺸﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ،ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﻓﻖ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ .٥ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي : ٤ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺟﺎﺯﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻏﺬﺍ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ،ﻳﺎ ﺯﻳﺮ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ : natural selection ١ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ .ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻨﻲ ﻣﺒﻨﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﻡ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﻕ ﺁﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﺸﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻫﺎ ،ﺗﺎﺑﻊﹺ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎ ﹺ e fitness ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٨ ﺖ » ﺍﻓﺘﺮﺍﻗﻲ « ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ٣ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ،ﺑﻘﺎ ،ﺧﺎﺻﻴ ِ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﻴﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ، ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻥ ﺗﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ -ﻡ : adaptation ٤ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ،ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٩
١٠٩
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
-1ﺣﻴﻮﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻳﺎ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﻴﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺗﺮي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻗﺪ ِ ﺑﻠﻨﺪﺗﺮ ،ﻣﻘﺎﻭﻣﺖ ﺩﺭﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ( ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﻏﺬﺍي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻧﺪ .
-2ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﮔﺘﺮ ﻭ ﻗﻮي ﺗﺮ ﺷﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺎﺭﺗﻲ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮﺮ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ( .
ﺷﺎﻧﺲ ِ ﺑﻘﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺲ -3ﺍﺯ ﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ .
-5ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺻﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﺴﻞ ، ﮔﺬﺷﺖ ﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻞ ِ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻪ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺪي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .
ﺻﺪ -4ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴﻞ ِ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺭﺻ ﺑﻴﺸ ﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﻀﺎ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﻴﺎﺕ ﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻨﺪﺗﺗﺮ ، ﺷﺎﻳﺴ ﻣﻘﺎﻭﻭﻣﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ِ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ (
١١٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ،ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍ ﹺﻡ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﺯ ﺕ ﻇﺎﻫﺮي ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤ ِ ﮐﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺩﻏﺪﻏﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﻑ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﺎﺩﻟﻪ ي ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺻﺮ ِ ﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺑﻴﺖ : ﺕ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ، ﺵ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮑﺎ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﺴﺰﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ، ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺗﺮﺩﻳﺪي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ
١١١
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﮕﻲ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ : ﻲ e ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻴﺎي ﻣﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﻃﻲ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻝ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻲ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﺭﭼﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺻﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻋ ﹺ ﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺩﺭﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻫﺎي ﺍﺻ ﺦ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﻫﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺸﻌﻌﺎﺏ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻨﻲ ،ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺩﺭﺧﺖ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮏ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﻣﺘﺘﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻑ ﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻫﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻪ ي ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮐﻲ ﺳﺮﭼﺸﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﻃﺮﻑ ﻧﻮﮎ ﺷﺎﺧﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﭼ ِ ِ ﻧﻤﺎﺩﺩي ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻮﻧﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﮔﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻣﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺷﺎﺧﺧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻠﻲ ،ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﻤﻤﻪ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ % ٩٩ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮﺮ ،ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﻩ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺒﺎﺭ ِ ي ﻣﻨﻘﺮﺽ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺑﻮﺩ ﺷﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ! ﺽ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩ ﻪ ﭼﺎﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭖﹺ ﺕ ﺯﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻲ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺒﻊﻊ :ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣ
١١٢
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺷﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ : ﮑﺎﻥ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﻧﻴﺴﺴﺖ .ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻣﮑ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ) ( ١٨٥٩ﺑﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﻲﹺ ﺏ ﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨ ﺖ ﻧﻈ ﻦ ﺻﺤ ِ ﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﻴ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺕ ﺏ ﻃﺒﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻃﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺴﺘﻲ ﺻﺪﻫﺎ ،ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻝ ِ ﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻳﮏ ي ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮏ ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺕﺟ ﺧﺼ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻥ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﻳﺸﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻪ ﺤ ِ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺮﺍﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺻﺤ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﻦ ﻣﺪﺕ ﻣﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ، ﺕ ﮎِ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺨﺎﺑﻲ ،١ﺷﻮﺍﻫﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﻮﻟﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺠﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﺪﻻﻝ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﺑﻲ ﺗﺮي ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﺁﻭﻭﺭﻳﻢ .ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ي ﺏ ﻃﺒﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻃﻲﹺ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺭ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺕِ ﻡ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ : ﮕﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺼﻮﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺭﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﺍﻋﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺭ ﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ. ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ. ﺪ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﺖ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻨﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﻧﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑ ﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﺍﻋﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺼ ﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻲ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺴﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺮ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻ ﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩِ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻧﺪ.٢ ﺖ ﺭﻭﺯﺍﻓﺰﺰﻭﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺼ ﻋ ﺳﺮﻋ ِ
ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٠ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﺪ e selectivﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻞ ve breedingg ١ ﮑﻲ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﮕﺲ ﺳﺮﮐﮐﻪ ) ( Drossophilaﮐﻪ ﻳﮑ ﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭ ٢ﻻﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻬﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻫﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻌﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﻭﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻫﺮ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﻮﺍﻥ ٣٦٥ﻧﺴﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ – ﻡ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩ
١١٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﺵ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩي ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﮐﺒﻮﺗﺮﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐـﺮﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨـﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﺸـﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴـﺮﺍ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷـﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴـ ِﺪ ﻣﺜـ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .١ﺍﺯ ﻂ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺎﮐﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨـﺎﺑﻲ ﺻـﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘـﻪ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﻭ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﻮﻟﻴـ ِﺪ ﻣﺜـ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ).ﻣﺜﻼً ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ،ﺩﻓﺮﻳﺰ ﻭ ﻣﮏ ﮐﻠﻴﺮﻥ .( ١٩٩٧ ٢ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌـﺎﺕ، ﮎ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﺍﺭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ
ﺏ ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻫﻲ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ، ﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ١ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻃﻲ ﺻﺪﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﭘﺲ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٣ Plomin , De Fries , & McClearn ٢
١١٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﻮﺵ ﺕ ﮐﻼﺳﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﻭي ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺗﺮﻳﻮﻥ ) ١ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺭ ( ١٩٤٠ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﭻ ) ﻣـﺎﺯ ( ٢ﭘﻴﭽﻴـﺪﻩ ﻗـﺮﺍﺭ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺭﺍﻫﺮﻭي ﻣـﺎﺭﭘﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺁﻣـﻮﺯﺵ ﺩﺭ ﭘﻴـﺪﺍ ﮐـﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺭﺍﻫـﺮﻭي ﺩﺭﺳـﺖ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺳﭙﺲ ﻣﻮﺷﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺣـﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ٣ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺷـﮑﻞِ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ،ﻣﻮﺷﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺭﺍﻫﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺫﻫﻦ
٤
ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﻃﻲ ٢١ﻧﺴﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﺍﺩﺍﻣـﻪ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌـﺪ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻋﻤـﻼً ﺞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﺭﺯﺷﻤﻨﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺗﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺷﺪ .ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻦ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﮐـﻪ ﻫﻤـﻪ ي ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺷﺘﺮﺍﮐﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺷﻬﺎي ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ _ ﮐـﻮﺩﻥ ي ﻣﻮﺷﻬﺎي ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ – ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﺣﺘﻲ ﮐﻨﺪﺫﻫﻦ ﺗﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﻬﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ.
ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﻳﻮﻥ ) (١٩٤٠ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ،ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ي ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺒﻮﺩ .ﺳﺮﻝ ( ١٩٤٩) ٥ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ٣٠ ﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺶ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ
Tryon ١ : maze ٢ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ ،ﺩﻫﻠﻴﺰ :ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺟﺎﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺭﺍﻫﺮﻭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﻫﺪﻓﻲ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺯ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍﻩ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( maze –bright ٣ maze-dull ٤ Searle ٥
١١٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﺳﻴﺮﻟﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ } ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍﻫﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﻳﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻣﻮﺧﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ { ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ي ﻏﺬﺍﻳ ﹺ ي ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮ } .١ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺳﻴﺮﻟﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪﺫﻫﻦ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺻﺮﻓﺎ ً ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻫﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ{ .
ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﻳﻮﻥ ) ( ١٩٤٠ﻧﻤﻲ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﮐﻮﭘﺮ ﻭ ﺯﻭﺑﮏ ( ١٩٥٨ ) ٢ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ،ﻣﻮﺷﻬﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮏ ﻓﻠﺰي ﭘﺮﻭﺭﺵ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ. ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺒ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﻣﺤﻴﻄ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﮑﻮﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﺩﻳﺪﺍﺭي ( ﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧ ِﻪ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ) ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺲ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ( .ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻲ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻮﺵ ﻗﻔ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻨﺪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻂ ﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺪﺫﻫﻦ ،ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ،ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻫﻮﺵ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻨﺪﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺮ ﮐﻨﺪﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﻏﻠﺒﻪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.٣
١ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺭﺍﻫﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ،ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭي ﻏﺬﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ – .ﻡ Cooper & zubek ٢ e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٣] [١٢] [١١
١١٦
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
» ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﺳﺐ ﺍﻣﺮﺮﻭﺯي «
ﻣﺮﻳﭽﻴﻴﭙﻮﺱ
ﻣﺰﻭﻫﻴﭙﻮﻮﺱ
ﻫﻴﻴﺮﺍﮐﺘﻴﺮﻳﻮﻡ
ﺍﮐﻮﻮﺱ
ﭘﻴﻠﻮﻮﻫﻴﭙﻮﺱ
٣٠ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻝ
ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻥ ٤٠
٦٠ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ
) ﺍﺳﺐ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي (
ﭘﻴﺶ
ﺶ ﭘﻴﺶ
ﭘﻴﺶ
ﺳﺎﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ
ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﺎﺑﺎ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭﺭ
ﺩﻭﻧﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺎﺯ ﻫﻢ ﻩ
ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ
ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ
ﺩﻧﺪﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ
ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ .ﺩﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﻊ ﻋﻠﻔﻔﺰﺍﺭﻫﺎي ﺧﺸﺸﮏ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي
ﭼﻤﻨﺰﺍﺍﺭﻫﺎي
ﭼﻤﻨﺰﺍﺭﻫﻫﺎي
ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﮏ ﻳﮏ
ﻳﺎﺎﻓﺘﻪ .ﻳﮏ ﺩﻭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺑﺴﻴﻴﺎﺭ
ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ
ﺧﺸﮏ ﻭ ﮏ
ﺧﺸﮏ ﺗﺗﺮ ﻭ
ﺭﮊﻳﻢ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥ
ﻻﻳﻖ ﻭ ﮐﮐﺎﺭﺁﻣﺪ.
ي ﺭﺭﮊﻳﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ
ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ي
ﺟﻨﮕﻞ ﻫﺎ .ﺩﻭﻧﺪﻩ
ﻧﺮﺮﻡ ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻً
ﻋﻠﻒ.
ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬﺖ ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ
ي ﺷﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎ
ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ
ﻳﺪﻥ. ﺩﻭﻳﺪ
ﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ. ﭘﺎﻫﺎي ﮐﺸﻴﺪ
ﺟﺟﻮﻳﺒﺎﺭ ﻫﺎ.
ﮐﻤﻤﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ١ﻣﻴﻠﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻝ ﭘﻴﻴﺶ ١٠ﻣﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻝ
ﻲ ﺼﻞ :ﺩﻳﺪﮔﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼ ﺧﻼ ﺕ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﺨـﺎﺑﺑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻌﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻲ ﻖ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻃﺒﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ،ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻖﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ.
١١٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ] [١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺯﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ » ،ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ « » ،ﻓﺮﮔﺸﺖ « ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ » ﺗﻄﻮﺭ« ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻪ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻝ ،ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺗﻄﻮﺭ « ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ « ﻭ » ﻓﺮﮔﺸﺖ « ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻟﻔﻈﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ، ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ، ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻨﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ. ﺖ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﺍﺗﺮ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻫﺎ ،ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺾ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ،ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺗﻄﻮﺭ « ) ﺍﺯ ﻃﻮﺭي ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ( ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺑﻪ " ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻓﻨﻲ ،ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ) ( Evolutionﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﺎﻣﺪِ ﮊﻧ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ" ١.
] [٢ﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺮﻭﺭﺵ ) : ( nature and nurture ﻞ ﺳﺮﺷﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺮﻭﺭﺵ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮﺑﻴﺘﻲ ،ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺗﺮ " ،ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻴﻢ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺣﺠ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺳﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺗﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺷﺎﺧﺺ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻴﺮﻭﻧﺪ ،ﺧﻮﺩ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ
١ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١٢
١١٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻞ ﻂ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺵ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ! ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻨﺪي ﻗﺒﻞ ﭘﺮﻭﺭ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻄﻠﻖ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ،ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ،ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ .ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ، ﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺭﺳﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﻬﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺖ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﻬﺘ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺭﺳﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﮐﺘﺎﺑﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺷﺎﺧﺺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺗﺤﺼﻴﻠ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﺕ ﺙ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ،ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻭ ...ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻪ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ،ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﺕ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻓﺮﻳﻨﻨﺪ. ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ،ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﺷﺨﺎﺹ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺑﻪ ﺩﻻﻳ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ :ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ي ٢٠ -١٩
١١٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
] [٣ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ » ﻣﺤﻴﻂ « ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﮐﺘﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : .١ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻭ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻭ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻲ ﺍﻭﺿﺎﻉ ،ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ .٢ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺳﺨﻦ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ :ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺭﺍﻩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺐ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪي ﻭ ﺕ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﮐﻴ ﹺ .٣ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺑﺸﺮ .ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺍﺧﻼﻗﻲ، ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
ﺡ » ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ) « ( speciesﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ] [٤ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ي ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻣﺘﻮﻟﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻂ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻂ ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﻲ ،ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﻧﻴﺰ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭ ،ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺸﻤﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ. ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ ﭼﺎ ﹺ
١٢٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
] [٥ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻮﻡ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻻﻭﺭﻧﺲ ﺍﺳﻠﻮﺑﻮﺩﮐﻴﻦ ) (١٩٦٨ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻴﺮﮔﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮕﻮ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺕ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ،ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺍ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ. :ﺍﻟﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺎﺯﮔﻲ ،ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺩﻓﻌﺎ ِ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻤﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺁﻥ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﻫﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﺶ ﺗﻄﺒﻴﻖ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻤﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﻌﻄﺎﻑ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺣﻔﻆ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ، ﺖ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﻲ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٣٧ ﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﻴﺘﺲ ،ﭘﻼﮒ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
ﺱ » ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻝ « ﺍﺳﺖ. eﻋﺪﺩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﺑﺎﻻ ،ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﻴﺎ ﹺ
ﻦ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻪ ] : variation [٦ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ،ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ .ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١
١٢١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
] : Inheritance [٧ﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي heredityﻭ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي inheritanceﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ » ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ « ) ﻭ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺕ ﻅ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻣﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ » ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ « ( ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺸﺨﺎﺵ ﻧﮕﺬﺍﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﺍي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ .١ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ :ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺍﻋﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﮔﻴﺎﻩ – ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻖ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ.ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻭﺭﺍﺛ ِ ﺕ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ. ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺖ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ :ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ي ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ،ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﭼﻴﺰﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .٢ﻭﺭﺍﺛ ِ ﻲ ﺖ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕ ﹺ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﻃﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺳﭙﺎﺭﺩ .ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻣﻮﺧﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﻭﺭﺍﺛ ِ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ. -
ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ
ﺐ » ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﻪ« ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ] : fittness [٨ﺑﺮﺍﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ،ﺗﻨﺎﺳﺐ ،ﺻﻼﺣﻴﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻟﻘ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻘﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻨﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺯﺭﺍﻓﻪ ،ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺯﺭﺍﻓﻪ ﻞ ﺯﺭﺍﻓﻪ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻘﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺣﺪﺱ ﺯﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ ،ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻘﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﺮﺩي ﺭﻭﺯي ١٦ﮐﻴﻠﻮﻣﺘﺮ ﺑﺪﻭﺩ ﻭ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﺑﻠﻨﺪ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺳﻴﻨﻪ ﺍﺵ ١٢٥ﺳﺎﻧﺘﻴﻤﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﺳﭙﺮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻭ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺍﻭ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ،ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ي ﺍﺧﻼﻗﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ. ﮓ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺎﺩيﹺ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻲ -ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ– ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﮐﺮ ﹺﻡ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ – ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦٦
١٢٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
] : adaptation [٩ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ،ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ :ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﹺ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﻘﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺣﺎﺋ ﹺﺰ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ
] [١٠ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ) : ( selective breeding ﺢ ﺩﻗﺖ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴﻢ inbreedingﻭ Cross breedingﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﻧﺸﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎﺕ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : .١ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ( selective breeding ) :ﺩﺭ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪي ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ. .٢ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺧﻮﺩي ) : ( inbreedingﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍﺩﺭ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ. ي ﺩﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺜﻼ .٣ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﻴﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ) : (Cross breedingﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ً ﺍﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻻﻍ.
١٢٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ. ] [١١ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﻴﺎﺗ ﹺ ﻲ ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻑ ﻭي ﺩﺭ ﺧﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ي ي ﺍﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﻂ ﺩﻳﺪﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻝ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻪ ي ﮐﻴﻔﻴ ِ ﺱ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﻭﺍﻗﻌ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ،ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ » ﺧﻄﻮﻁ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ،ﻣﺎ ﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺐ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ، ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ « ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻣﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻂ ﻲ ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ) ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ( ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺯﺍﺩي ﻭ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺶ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻟﻴﮑﻦ ﭘﺎﻻﻳ ﹺ ﺱ ﻑ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻭ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﺣﺴ ﹺ ﻂ ﺍﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺻﻼﺡ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﹺﻴﺎﻭﻟﻴﻪ ،ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺤﺼﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﺘﺎﺛﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻧﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ) .ﺑﺎﺋﺮ، ﮐﻮﻧﻮﺭﻭﺱ ،ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺩﻳﺰﻭ ( ١٩٩٦ ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٢١
ﺵ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ eﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﮔﺴﺘﺮ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﭘﺮﻭﺭﺵ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺲ ﺑﺎ ﺲ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ -ﻗﻔ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻫﻢ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻗﻔ ﹺ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ (
١٢٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻳﻢ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ] [١٢ﻣﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻣﺸﮑﻠﻲ ،ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﺱ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ .ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻮﺩﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻞ ﺱ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤ ﹺ ﺱ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﺪ ﺧﺸﻤﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮﺍ ً ﺍﻧﻌﮑﺎ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ ﺲ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻨ ﹺ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺷﻤﺎﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺟﺬﺍﺑﻴ ِ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰﺗﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺁﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﺿﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﭙﺬﻳﺮﻳﺪ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺤ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺐ ﺕ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺐ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ .١ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻘﺒﺾ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﮏ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺑﺰﺍﻕ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﭼﺸﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﺏ ﻟﻴﻤﻮي ﺗﺮﺵ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺴﻬﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻋﻠ ِ .٢ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺍﮔﺮﭼﻪ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺕ ﻗﻄﻌ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ،ﻧﻪ ﺿﺮﻭﺭ ِ ﺏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﭼﻪ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺭﺗﮑﺎ ﹺ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺴﻲ ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﻧﮑﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺶ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ي ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﺶ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺞ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻌ ﹺ ﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺷﻤﺎ ،ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺖ ﻓﻌﻠﻲ ﮎ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﻂ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﺏ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﺸﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﺠﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰي ﺍﺳﺖ( . ﻧﻴﺰ ﻳﮏ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ] [١٣ﺁﻳﺎ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻣﺪﺕ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺳ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ،ﺟﻨﮓ ﻭ ﺟﺪﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﺦ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﺭﻭﺷﻨﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺑ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ
١٢٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻮﻡ
ﻦ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ،ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﻣﺒﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ « ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﺎﻻ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﻭ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎ ِ ﺐ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ « ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﻢ ،ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﺎﺑﻪ ي » ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻦ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ : ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺍي ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘ ﹺ " ﺑﻴﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺍي ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﭼﻴﺰﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻏﺮﻳﺰي ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ ؟ ﺍﮔﺮ ﮐﺴﻲ ﻣﺸﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻪ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺁﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻏﺮﻳﺰي ﭼﺸﻢ ﺑﺮ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺯﻧﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻋﻘﺐ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﺸﻴﻢ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺡ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻳﮏ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ. ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ،ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺁﻥ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻳﮏ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﺯﻧﺠﻴﺮﻩ ﺍي ﻭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻲ ﺏ ﻣﻌﺎﺷﻘﻪ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺑﺎ " ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﺁﺩﺍ ﹺ ﺏ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻩ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻲ ﺁﺑﻨﻮﺱ ،ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺁﺩﺍ ﹺ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﺮ " ﻏﺮﻳﺰي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﺗﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﮔﻦ ( ١٩٧٤ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺯﺩ ِﻥ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻳﺎ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻧﻌﮑﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻧﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﮐﺸﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺳﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺿﺮﺑﻪ ي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﻳﮏ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺶ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻧﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻧﺠﻴﺮﻩ ﺍي ﻭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺨﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ﻲ ﺁﻥ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﻏﺮﻳﺰي ﺑﻪ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﻋﻠﻤ ﹺ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺴﻬﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻏﺮﻳﺰﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺩﻭﻡ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥِ » ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ « ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﻢ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻏﺮﺍﻳ ﹺﺰ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻣﻨﺒﻊ : ﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﻴﺎﺑﺎﻧﮕﺮﺩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻩ ﺷﺎﻫﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي١٥ -١٤ .١ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳ ِ ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦١ -٦٠ .٢ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
١٢٦
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﺘﻴﮏ
١٢٧
١٢٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ : ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ :ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ١٢٧ ......................................................................................................................
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ١٢٨ .................................................................................................................... :
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ١٢٩ ....................................................................................................................................:
ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻞﹺ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ؟ ١٣٠ ..................................................................
ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ١٣٣ ...............................................................................................
ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ١٣٤ ...................................................................................................................................... :
ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ١٣٥ ..................................................................................................................................... :
ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻡﹺ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪِ ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﭼﻪ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ؟ ١٣٦ ...........................................................................................
ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖِ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؟ ١٣٧ ...................................................................................................
١٣٨ .................................................................................................................................. : DNA
ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ؟١٤٢ ........................................................................................................................
ﺁﻟﻞ ١٤٤ ....................................................................................................................................... :
ﺣﺎﻟﺖِ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ١٤٥ .................................................................................................................... :
ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻭ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ١٤٨ ........................................................................................................................ :
ﺟﻬﺶ ١٥٠ .................................................................................................................................... :
ﻣﻨﺪﻝ :ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢﹺ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ١٥٣ .................................................................................................................. :
ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ١٥٦ ................................................................................................................................... :
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي١٥٩ ............................................................................................................................ :
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي١٥٩ ............................................................................................................................ :
ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ١٦١ ............................................................................................................................ :
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ١٦٩ .................................................................................................................... :
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ: ١ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ) ( ١٨٥٩ﻳﮏ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﺮﻭ ،ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺦ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺐ ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﻋﺠﻴ ﹺ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﺎ ِ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ،ﺩﺳﺖ ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺍي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻞ ﺷﺨﺼ ﹺ ﻭﺳﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺶ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ! ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺦ ﭘﺮﺳ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﻳﺎ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﻳﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻋﺘﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﮑﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺶ ﮔﻤﻨﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮔﺮﮔﻮﺭ ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﻑ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺸﻴ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮ ِ
٢
ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺍﺭﺳﺎﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ،ﭘﺎﺳﺨﻲ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﻴﺎﺑﻴﻢ.
ﺢ ﻂ ﺑﻴﺘﺴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎ ﹺﻝ ١٩٠٧ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ .ﻭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ : Genetics ١ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ .ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺷﺎﺧﻪ ي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥ ،ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻖ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١ Gregor Mendel ٢
١٢٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ؟ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﻳﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ١ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻮﺳﺘﻲ ،ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ،ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﺍي ،ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭼﺮﺑﻲ ﻭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﻒ ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻫﺮ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺍﺯﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻭﻇﺎﻳ ِ ﻓﺎﺭﻍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﭼﻪ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ﺍي ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ي ي ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ٢ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ.٣ ) ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ٤ﻋﺪﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ( .
ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ : cell ١ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﺣﺪِ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١ Chromosome ٢ e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١
١٣٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ٤٦ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ( .
eﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻞ ﺁﻓﺘﺎﺑﮕﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﮔﺮﺑﻪ ،ﭘُﻒ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻧﺨﻮﺩ ﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ،ﮔ ﹺ ﻣﺎﻫﻲ ،ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺳﮓ.
ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ١ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي ،١ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي ٢ﻭ ...ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ٤٦ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺐ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﻇﺎﻫﺮي ﺷﺎﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺣﺴ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺩﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺩﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺐ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ) ﺍﺯ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤﺖ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮﻳﻦ ( ﻣﻨﻈﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ٢ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ) .ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﺬﮐﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ( ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ،ﺩﻭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﻫﻢ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي : organism ١ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢ ﺱ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺷﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺷﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻈﻢ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ : karyotype ٢ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٧
١٣١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻫﻤﻮﻟﻮﮒ ) ﻫﻤﺘﺎ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﮐﭙﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي ،١ﺩﻭ ﮐﭙﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي ٢ﻭ ...ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺠﺎي ٤٦ﻋﺪﺩ ﺕ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ٢٣ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ٢ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﺀ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻳﺎ ﮔﺎﻣﺖ٣ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻑ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ٢٣ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ٢٣ﻋﺪﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﻳﺪ ٤ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺖ ﭼﭗ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺍﺯ } ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺩﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ .ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺬﮐﺮ ﻭ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺳﻤﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻮﻧﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ{ .
١ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ي ﺑﺤﺚ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﺩﻳﺪ ،ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﻮﻟﻮﮒ ،ﮐﺎﻣﻼًﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ) : diploid ٢ﺩﻭﻻ ( : Gametes ٣ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ » ﮔﺎﻣﺖ « ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. : haploid ٤ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ
١٣٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ ! ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ DNA % ٩٨ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺷﺎﻣﭙﺎﻧﺰﻩ ﺳﻬﻴﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ! ١ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮕﻔﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺗﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺖ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺷﺒﺎﻫ ِ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪي ﺑﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﮐﺮﻡ ﺷﺐ ﺗﺎﺏ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﮐﺎﺋﻨﻮﺭﻫﺎﺏ ﺩﻳﺘﻴﺲ ٢ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺟ ِﺪ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ) ٣.ﻭﻳﺪ ( ١٩٩٧ ٤ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ٤٦ ،ﻋﺪﺩ ) ٢٣ﺟﻔﺖ ( ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺰ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( .ﺍﻣﺎ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.
ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﻖ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺪﻳﻤﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ :ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻭ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ .ﺍﻭﻟﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻭﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ.
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣ elegans Caenorhabditis ٢ e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ Wade ٤
١٣٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻣﻴﻮﺯ: ١ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ) ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻫﺎ ( ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻃﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺟﺮﻡ ٢ﻃﻲ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ،ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺎﻫﺸﻲ ٣ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ : ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺟﺮﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ٤ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺟﺮﻡ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ٤ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
ﻲ ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺻ ﹺ : meiosis ١ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻣﺘﺸﮑﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟ ﹺ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ) ( ٢ nﺑﻪ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ) ( nﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٠ e germ cells ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥ ﺖ ﮔﺎﻣﺘﻲ ) ﺖ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺗﻲ ) ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪي ( ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ : reductional division ٣ﻃﻲ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯ ﹺﻡ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻫﻴﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪي ( ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺎﻫﺸﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢١
١٣٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺍي ﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫﺎ ) ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.١
ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ: ٢ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .٣ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻡ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ).٤ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ (
ﻞ ﻣﻲ ﻓﻬﻤﻴﻢ ﻋﻼﺭﻏ ﹺﻢ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻭ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺢ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ.
ﻖ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻴﻀﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ١ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٢١ Mitosis ٢ ٣ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺳﺨﻦ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻭ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻧﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ – .ﻡ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٦ ٤ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻨﻲ ) ( somatic cellsﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
١٣٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ١ﭼﻪ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺯ ِﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻟﻘﺎﺡ ٣ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻞ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺨﻢ ﻳﺎ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ٤ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺸﮑﻴ ﹺ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﻳﺪ ) ( nﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ٢٣ﻋﺪﺩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻟﻘﺎﺡ ٢٣ ،ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﺑﺎ ٢٣ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺸﮑﻴ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ) ( ٢nﺑﺎ ٢٣ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺗﺨﻢ ﻳﺎ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﻮﺑﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ) ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ( ﺭﺍ ﺗﮑﺜﻴﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺚ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﮐﭙﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭي ﺗﺨ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻣﮑﺮﺭﺍً ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻒ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ.٥ ﻒ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻭﻇﺎﻳ ِ ١ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﮕﺮ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ !؟ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٧ ﻞ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ٢ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻇﺮﻳﻒ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﭘ ﹺ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤ ( eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٨ : syngamy ٣ﻟﻘﺎﺡ .ﻣﻌﺎﺩ ﹺﻝ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي fertilizationﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ -ﻡ : Zygote ٤ﺗﺨ ﹺﻢ ﺑﺎﺭﻭﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ :ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﮐﻴ ﹺ ﺐ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ،ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺲ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ .ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺟﻨ ﹺ ﻣﺜﻠ ﹺ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤ ﻦ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ٥ﻫﺮ ﺑﺎﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﻧﺪﻩ ) ﭘﻴﺮﻭﺯ ( ﺑﺎ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻣﻴﺨﺘ ﹺ ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﺳﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١١
١٣٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺖ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؟ ﺟﻨﺴﻴ ِ ﺖ ،( ٢٣ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ.١ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﻭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺁﺧﺮي ) ﺟﻔ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞِ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ Xﻭ Yﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ) ﺑﺠﺰ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺐ ﻳﮏ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Xﻭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ) ﺑﺠﺰ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻤﻞ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯ ﹺﻡ Xﻭ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Yﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Yﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﻳﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ٢٣ ) .ﻋﺪﺩ ( ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Xﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ Yﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ Xﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ Xﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪﻣﺜﻞ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺩﺧﺘﺮ ) (XXﻭ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Yﺧﻮﺩ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﭘﺴﺮ ) (XYﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ) .ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ (
ﻲ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻨﻬﺎي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺍﺗﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ -ﻡ ١ﺑﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ
١٣٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺶ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺭﻭﻧ ِﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻭ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻪ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ،ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ.
: ١DNA ﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ DNAﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .٢ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺕ ﺿﺮﻭﺭي ﺟﻬ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ي ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ DNA ،ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﻭ ﹺ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﻣﻠﻤﻮﺱ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ DNA :ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ! } ﺩﻗﺖ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎ ً ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ Xﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻫﺮ ﭗ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٣١ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ { ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ
ﻒ ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ي » ﺩﺋﻮﮐﺴﻲ ﺭﻳﺒﻮﺯ ﻧﻮﮐﻠﺌﮏ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ « ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ،ﻣﺨﻔ ِ ٢ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺰ DNAﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻫﻴﺴﺘﻮﻥ ) ( histoneﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺑﺮﺩﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺻﺮﻑ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ – .ﻡ
١٣٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻭﺍﺣﺪﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﻩ ي DNAﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻗﻨﺪ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺴﻔﺎﺕ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ : ١ﺩﺭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي DNA ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ :ﺁﺩﻧﻴﻦ ) – ( A ﺗﻴﻤﻴﻦ ) - ( Tﮔﻮﺍﻧﻴﻦ ) – ( Gﺳﻴﺘﻮﺯﻳﻦ ) C ( .ﺍﻳﻦ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺯ ،ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ DNAﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎ ﻃﻮﺭي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﺁﺩﻧﻴﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻴﻤﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺘﻮﺯﻳﻦ ﺑﺎ ﮔﻮﺍﻧﻴﻦ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي DNAﺑﻪ ﺩﻭﺭ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻴﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﭻ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﮔﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﺮﺩﺑﺎﻥ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺷﺪ .ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻓﺴﻔﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺣﮑﻢ ﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺣﮑﻢ ﭘﻠﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺮﺩﺑﺎﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﻑ ﻧﺮﺩﺑﺎﻥ ( ﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎي ﻳﮏ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي ) DNAﻳﮏ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎي ﻃﺮ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻃﺮﻑ Aﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻣﻄﻤﺌﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻞ ،Gﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ي ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ Tﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺯ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ٤ﺑﺎﺯ ﻳﻘﻴﻦ Cﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺗﻮﺍﻟ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ
: bases ١ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎ :ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﮏ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ -.ﻡ
١٣٩
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ : ﻢ DNA ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻄﻮﺭ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺷﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ،DNAﺍﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻮﻉ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي A
.١ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﺯي
١
ﺖ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ DNAﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻝ :
ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﺵ ﮐﭙﻲ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪﺳﺳﺎﺯي ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭي ﺧ DNﺍﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺭﺩ ( .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻌﻨﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي NA ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻳﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﺪﺪﺍ ﻞ ،ﺟﻔﺖ ي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻫﺮ ﺭﺷﺘﺘﻪ ﮕﺮ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺩﻭ ﺭﺷﺘﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﻦ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﺧﻮﻮﺩ ﺟﺬﺏ ﮐﺮﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﻭ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﻞ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺎ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻣﮑﻤ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ .ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺖ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺒﺒﻼً ﻓﻘﻂ ﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣ DNﭘﺪﻳﺪ ﻲ ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴﭻ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ NA DNAﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻗﺒﻠﻠﻲ D ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻳﮏ ﮐﭙﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﻖ ﻉ ﺑﺴﺎﺯﺩ ﻣﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
e Replicationﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٩ R n١
١٤٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺕ ﺭﻣﺰي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ DNAﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ : ١ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ .٢ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺕ ﺭﻣﺰﮔﺸﺎﻳﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺭﻣﺰﮔﺸﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﻃﻲ ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﺭﻭﻧﻮﻳﺴﻲ : ٢ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ DNAﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺭﻭﻧﻮﻳﺴﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ RNAﮐﭙﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺕ RNAﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﻴﺪﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ } .ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ : ٣ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻫﺎ ،ﻭﺍﺣﺪﻫﺎي ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﻮﻉ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦﹺ ﺑﮑﺎﺭﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﻲ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺎ ً ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻫﺮ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺍﺳﻴﺪﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﺍﻟ ﹺ ﻣﻨﻈﻢ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ( .٤ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ→ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ → → RNAﺭﻭﻧﻮﻳﺴﻲ →DNA ﺫﮐﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ : .١ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي DNAﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. DNA .٢ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﮕﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ،ﺳﺎﺧ ِ : protein synthesize ١ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﻣﺘﻨﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﻭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭي ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩي ﺑﺪﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﺑﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻨﺪي ،ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻤﻨﻲ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﮔﻮﺍﺭﺵ ،ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺗﻠﻘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ ﺹ ( ٨٣ e Transcription ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٠ e Translation ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٠ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ، ٤ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ ﺹ ٨٣ﻭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٩٢
١٤١
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻫﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ؟ ﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺳﺎﺧﺖ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﺌﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺳﺖ Dﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺖ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭي ﺍﺯ DNA ي ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﮏ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻲ ﻣﺠﺰﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻂِ ﺑﺎﺱ " ( ١١٩٩٩) ١ﮊﻥ ﻫﻫﺎ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺘ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺱ ﺕ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻧﺨﻮﺭﺩﻩ ﺑﻪﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻩ ﺻﻮﻮﺭ ِ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﮑﻪ ﺷﮑﺴﺘﻪ ﻳﻳﺎ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ " .٢ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻫﻫﺮ ﮊﻥ ﺁﻧﮑ ﺖ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺮﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﻞ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺧ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻮﺭﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﮏ ﺨﺺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺳﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻣﺸﺨ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ، ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ،ﺣﺎﻭي ﮊﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻳﮑﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻨﺪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻮﺭﺍﻟﻌﻌﻤﻠﺸﺎﻥ ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺳﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻝ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻝ ﺑﺨﺸﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﻫﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻊ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻌﻌﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻝ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻦ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﻲ ﻲ ي ﻳﺎ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﮐﺒﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻝ ﺪ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﮐﺮﻭﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ".ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺟﺎﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ِ ٣ﻦ ﻲ ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﻫﺎﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺠ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻗﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
Busss ١ ٢ﺩﺩﺭ ﺧﻼ ﹺﻝ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﻴﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ،ﻳﺎ ﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻪ ﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻧﻴﺴﺘ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﺼ ﺪِ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﺟﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﻢ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﺴﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﮊﻥ ﻲ ﺪ ي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤٥ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ) ( locusﮔﻔﻔﺘﻪ : locuss ٣ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﺎﻩ :ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﭖ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﺮ ي ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺕ ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺯ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي( ٣٦٦ ﻡ
١٤٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺩﻭ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻳﮏ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺭﻭي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ. ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﭘﻴﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﮊﻥ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻧﮓ ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢِ ﺁﺑﻲ ﻭ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ،ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦﹺ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻧ ِ ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﮐﺪﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻦ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻧ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴ ﹺ ﻒ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺁﻟﻞ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ
ﺖ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺷﻐﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ) eﻫﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﻒ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ﻟﻮﮐﻮﺱ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ) ﻫﻤﻮﻟﻮﮒ ( ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸﺮﹺ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١
١٤٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺁﻟﻞ: ١ ﻞ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﺁﺑﻲ ﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻳﮏ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ،ﺁﻟﻞ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﮓ ﮔﹸﻞ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡﹺ ﻫﻤﺘﺎ ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻧ ِ ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺍي ) .ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﮓ ﺑﻨﻔﺶ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻣﺨﺼﻮ ﹺ ﺹ ﺭﻧﮓ ﺳﻔﻴﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ( . ﺹ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﺨﺼﻮ ﹺ ﻫﺮ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺻﻔﺖ ٢ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ .٣ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻞ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻞ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺗﻨﺨﺎﺏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ. ﺑﺎ ﺁﻟ ﹺ
ﻲ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﺍﺷﻐﺎﻝ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻒ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻣ ﹺ : allele ١ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺖ ﻫﻤﺘﺎ ) ﻫﻤﻮﻟﻮﮒ ( ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ،ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻔ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺑﺎﺯﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻴﹺﻨﺂﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﺎي ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٣ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٥ : trait ٢ﺻﻔﺖ ،ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ،ﺧﺼﻠﺖ ،ﺧﺼﻴﺼﻪ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١١ ٣ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻟﻮﮐﻮﺱ ) ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ( ﻲ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﻭ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﻭي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﺰﻭﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﻮﻟﻮﮒ ) ﻫﻤﺘﺎ ( ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﺎ ﮊﻧ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺟﻬﺶ ،ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺗﺌﻮﺭﻳﮏ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺁﻟﻞ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤٠
١٤٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ : ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ١ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺷﮑﺴﺖ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻩ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ٢ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻧ ِ ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﺁﺑﻲ ،ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ،ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺯﺩ .ﺁﻟﻞ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻞ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺮﻭﺯ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻞ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ.٣ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ،ﺭﻧ ِ ﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ) ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ( ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺁﻟﻞ ﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ،ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ : Aﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳ ﹺ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ) ﺁﺑﻲ ( ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺁﻟﻞ Rrﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ .ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﻲ Rﺑﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ rﭼﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .٤ﻓﺮﺩ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ( . ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ : Bﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﻟﺪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ) ( Rﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺁﻟﻞ RRﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ) ﻓﺮﺩ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ( . ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ : Cﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﻟﺪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ) ( rﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺁﻟﻞ rrﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ) ﻓﺮﺩ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ (.
: dominant ١ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ،ﺑﺎﺭﺯ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﭗ ﺁﻥ ،ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻟ ﹺ : recessive ٢ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ،ﻧﻬﻔﺘﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻟﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ،ﺳﺮﮐﻮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (٣٢١ ﺐ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺶ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﭘﺪﺭ ( ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺒﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﭘﺪﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﻞ ﻏﺎﻟ ﹺ ٣ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪي ،ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺩﻳﮕ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ – ﻡ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ٤ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ rﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺒﺮﺩ ﺷﮑﺴﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﻬﻔﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺣﺎﻣﻞ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ rﺳﺖ – ﻡ
١٤٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
eﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ: ﮓ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ Aﻭ Bﺭﻧ ِ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ،ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ Cﺭﻧ ِ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ.
ﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺮﻑ ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻣﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻑ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﻭ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺁﻟﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺮ ِ ﻞ ﺭﻧﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ Rﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺭﻧﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ rﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ،ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ،١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ) ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ( ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺳﻪ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺖ ﺖ » RRﻫﻤﻮﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ِ٣ﻏﺎﻟﺐ « ،ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺖ Rrﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً » ﻫﺘﺮﻭﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ،« ٢ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺕ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ « ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. » rrﻫﻤﻮﺯﻳﮕﻮ ِ
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٢ ﻞ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﻫﺘﺮﻭﺯﻳﮕﻮﺱ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ : heterozygous ٢ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٢ : homozygous ٣ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﻫﻤﻮﺯﻳﮕﻮﺱ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ. ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٢
١٤٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺖ ﻧﺎﺗﻤﺎﻡ : ١ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﻴ ِ .١ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺨﻠﻮﻁ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﮓ ﻗﺮﻣﺰ ﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺭﻧﮓ ﺳﻔﻴﺪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻞ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻞ ،ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺵ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻲ ﻞ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻣﻴﺰ ﹺ ﻧﺎﻗﺺ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ.
ﺖ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ : ٢ﺩﺭﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﻴ ِ .٢ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﺸﺨﻴﺺ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻤﺖ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﻭ ﺷﺪ ).ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺳﻂ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ( .
.٣ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﭼﻨﺪﮔﺎﻧﻪ : ٣ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮏ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ،ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ Aﻭ Bﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ iﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ٤ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ O ،AB ،B،A : ﺖ ﻧﺎﻗﺺ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. : incomplete dominance ١ﻏﺎﻟﺒﻴ ِ : co-dominance ٢ﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﺭﺯي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. : multiple alleles ٣ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺖ Oﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ،ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ iﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ٤ﺣﺎﻟ ِ
٤
١٤٧
١٤٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻭ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ : ﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻔﺮ ،ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳ ﹺ ﺐ ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ( ﺗﺮﮐﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺭﻧ ِ ﺧﻮﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺐ RRﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ Rrﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺗﺮﮐﻴ ﹺ ي ﻫﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ،ﺟﻠﻮﻩ ي ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﹺ ﺐ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻔﺮ ،ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ( .ﺳﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ١؟ ٣
ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ِ ٢ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ِ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ﺶ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺑﻪ ﺁﺭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ( ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺕ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﻓﺮﺩ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ (. ) ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺭﻧ ِ
ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺩﻭ ﻋﻀﻮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﻨﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ١ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (٥٢ : genotype ٢ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ي ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ– ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭗ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي e ( ٢٧ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٣ : phenotype ٣ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺸﻬﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٤
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
eﺯﺍﻝ ﺗﻨﻲ ) : ( allbinism ﺩ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩﺩ ،ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ِ ﺭﻧﮕ ﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً » ﺯﺍﻝ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ » .ﺯﺍﻟﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﺺ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ،ﻭ ﺍﺻ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻭﻳﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺮ ﺑﺒﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺩﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﺭ ﺱ ﺯﺍﻝ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﺯﺍﻝ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ. ﻞ ﺯﺯﺍﻝ ،ﻃﺎﻭﻭ ﹺ ﺯﺍﺍﻝ ،ﮔﻮﺭﻳ ﹺ ( ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ .ي ﺯﺍﺍﻟﻲ ،ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺁﻟﻞﹺ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﺘﻲ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻞ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺪ ﺖ ﻪ ﻧﻬﻔﺘﻪ ﺭﻧﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻋﺪ ﹺﻡ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺭﺭﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ي ﻏﻴﺮ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺯﺍﻟﻲ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ) ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ Aﻭ aي ﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺳﻪ ﮊﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻭ ﻭ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻬﻔﺘﻪ ) ﺯﺍﻟﻲ ( ﻪ ﻞ ﻪ ﺗﻮﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺭﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ( ﻭ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻒ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻒ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻟﻲ ﭗ ﻓﻨﻨﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ
ﮊﻧﻮﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻫﺎ
ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻫﻫﺎ
ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ( ) AAﻫﻤﻤﻮﺯﻳﮕﻮﺱﹺ ﺐ
ﺭﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﺭ ﺩﺍﺭ
) Aaﻫﺘﺮﻭﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ (
ﺭﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﺭ ﺩﺍﺭ
ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ( ) aaﻫﻤﻮﺯﺯﻳﮕﻮﺱﹺ ﺏ
ﺯﺯﺍﻝ ) ﺑﺪﻭﻥِ ﺭﻧﮕﮕﻴﺰﻩ (
ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸﺮﹺ ، ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﻣﻨﺒﺒﻊ :ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﻤﻪ ﺁﻳﻴﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩
١٤٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
eﺟﻬﺶ: ١ ﻲ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﻲ ) ﺗﺼﺎﺩﻓﻲ ( ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺍﻟ ﹺ DNAﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ DNAﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﭗ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﭼﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺑﺮ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﺳﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ : ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ .١ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻀﺮ ) : ( detrimentalﺑﻪ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴ ِﻪ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻀﺮ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺣﺬﻑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻭﺍﺟﺪِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﮏ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻧﻪ ﺕ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻴ ِ .٢ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻨﺜﻲ ) : ( neutralﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻨﺜﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺳﻮﺩﻣﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﻣﻀﺮ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻑ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﻭﻧﺪ. ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻳﮏ ﺷﮑﺎ ِ .٣ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ) : ( beneficalﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻮﺩﻣﻨﺪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻞ ﺟﻬﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ .ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺘﺎ ً ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ي ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺣﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻣﻲ ﻦ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺗﺜﺒﻴﺖ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﺗﺜﺒﻴﺖ ،ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺰﻳ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺟﻬﺶ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ : Mutation ١ﻣﻮﺗﺎﺳﻴﻮﻥ ،ﺟﻬﺶ :ﺩﺭ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﻭﺳﻴﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻧﺎﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗ ﹺﺮ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ » ﻣﻮﺗﺎﺳﻴﻮ ِﻥ ﻧﻘﻄﻪ ﺍي « ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺳﻴﺪﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﮐﻠﺌﻴﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٥ ﺗﻮﺍﻟ ﹺ
١٥٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺭﺯﺵﹺ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺯﻳﺎﻥ ﺁﻭﺭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻲ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،١ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﺭﻓﺖ .٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﻢ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻞ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻦ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻋﻤﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻒ ﺩﻧﻴﺎ ﻁ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .٣ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺧﺰﻧﺪﮔﺎ ِﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺠﺜﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻥ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻭﻗﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺩ، ﺑﺎ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺎﻧﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺩﺭﺁﻣﺪ .ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻧﻘﺮﺍﺽ ﺩﺍﻳﻨﺎﺳﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺷﻬﺎﺏ ﺳﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻣﻴﻦ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .٤
ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖe . ﺶ ﮐﺎﺭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ١ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻀﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٦ ٢ﻭﻗﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺟﻬﺶ ،ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺟﻬ ﹺ ﺶ ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ) ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ ( ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﺚ ﺑﺮﻭ ﹺﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ) ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ( ﻳﮏ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺑﻼﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻞ ﺟﺎﻧﺸﻴﻦ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﻟﻠﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ،ﺟﻬﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﻗﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻣﻨﺒﻊﹺ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺧﺎﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٤ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ٣ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥٨ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﻂ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻭ ﮔﺰﻳﻨﺶ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻮﺗﺮﮐﻴﺒﻲ ،ﺗﻨﻮﻋﺎ ِ ﺢ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻟﻲ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺘﺎً ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ٤ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺒﺎ ِ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.
١٥١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
eﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ : ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺖ ﻃﺒﻴﻌ ﹺ ي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺕ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﻧﺎﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ؛ .١ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺮﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؛ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ .٢ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. .٣ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎ ،ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻣﺘﺎﺳﺘﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻬﺎﺟﻢ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺫﮐﺮ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺧﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ : ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﺩﻩ ي ﮐﻠﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻮﻣﻮﺭ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺗﻮﻣﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻟﺰﻭﻣﺎ ً ﮐﺸﻨﺪﻩ ﻞ ﺯﮔﻴﻞ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻃﺎﻭﻝ ( ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﻣﺒﺘﻼ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺯﺍ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻞ ﺟﻬﺶ ﺯﺍي ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺭﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ DNAﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﻫﻢ ﺱ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺑﺒﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻲ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺯﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻮﺩﺑﺨﻮﺩي ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﻳﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺯﺍ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺖ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺴﺮﻳﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲﹺ ﺟﻬﺶ ﺯﺍ ،ﺍﺷﻌﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻳﻮﻧﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻳﺮﻭﻭﺱ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺯﺍ ) ﮐﺎﺭﺳﻴﻨﻮﮊﻥ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎً ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻞ ﺳﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺯﺍ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﺱ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ .١ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ) : ( initiantionﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ،ﺣﺎﺻ ﹺ ﻞ ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ .٢ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ) : ( promotionﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺗﻤﺎﺱ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي، ﻣﻨﺒﻊ :ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸﺮﹺ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤١٤ -٤١٥
١٥٢
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﻣﻨﺪﺪﻝ :ﻣﮑﺎﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻭﺭﺭﺍﺛﺖ : ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬﻢﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻋﻠﻢ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ،ﮔﺮﻳﮕﻮﺭ ﻣﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ .ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ) ( ١٨٨٤٤ – ١٨٢٢ﻣﺴﺌﺌﻠﻪ ﻴﺖ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻧﺨﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺳﺒﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺮي ﻲ ي ﻭﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﻧﺨﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﺑﺮﺭﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺯﺭﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ : ﺑﺎ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺪﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺒﺰ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻣﺴﻠﻢ ﺖ ﺨﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺒﺒﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻢ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﺨﻮ ﺷﺪ. ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺪﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺯﺭﺩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻣﺴﻠﻢ ﺖ ﺨﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺯﺭﺭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻢ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﺨﻮ ﺷﺪ.
١٥٣
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺳﺒﺰ ﻭ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺯﺯﺭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻫﻢ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ .ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﻣﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻧﺨﻮﺩ ﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺰ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﺩ ﺳﺒﺰ ﻤﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺒ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﮕ ﻥ ﻞ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺳﺒﺰ ( .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺯﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺳﺒﺰ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ) ﻧﺴ ﹺ ٣/٤ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺒﺰ ﻭ ١/٤٤ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺯﺭﺭﺩ ﻋﺠﻴﺐ ﺑﻮﺩ٣ . ﮕﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﮐﺮﺩ ،ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺐ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﮕﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﮑﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕ ﹺﺮ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﻧﺨﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕ ﺷﺪﻧﻧﺪ ! ﺍﻭ ﻫﻤﻴﻴﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺧﺼﻮﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻭﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ي ﹺ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺭﺳﺳﻴﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﭼﻴﻴﺰي ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﻧﻧﻤﻴﺪﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﻴﺎﺭ ﺞ ﻋﺠﻴﻴﺐ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﻦ ﺭﻧﮓ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮔﻴﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﻫﺮ ﻭﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﺩﻭ ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﻣﺜﺜﻼ ً ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﺍﺭﺟﺤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺁﺁﻥ ﺖ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺮ ﻞ ﺳﺒﺰﺰ ﻭ ﺯﺭﺩ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ (.ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻞ ﺩﻭ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻧﺨﻮﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ،ﮊﻥ ) ﺁﻟﻞ ( ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻲ ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺧﺼ ﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻳﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺙ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩﻩ ي ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﺻ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻝ ﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻦ ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﻴﭗ ) ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺒﺎﺭﺯﻩ ﻃﻠﺒﻴﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕِ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﻌﻞ ﺷﺷﺪﻩ ( ﺕ ﮑﻲ ( ﻭ ﻓﻨﻮﻮﺗﻴﭗ ) ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻮﻮﻩ ي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻅ ﻓﻨﻮﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻣﺜﺜﻼً ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺭ ِﺩ ﮔﻴﺎﻩ ﻧﺨﻮﻮﺩﻓﺮﻧﮕﻲ ،ﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮊ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺳﺒﺰ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﮊ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺯﺭﺭﺩ ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮏ ﭗ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﺒﺰ ﺪ ﻪ ﻅ ﺤﺎ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘﻨﺪ.١ ﭘﺮﺳﺳﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺗﻔﮑﺮ : ﺪﻝ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺧﻮﻳﻳﺶ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩ ؟ ﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﻳﺎﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﺪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻤﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎﺎي ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻪ ﺭﻭ ي ﺑﺮﺍي
ﻲ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺳﺳﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻉ ي ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺪﺍي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺮﻥ ،ﺧﻴﻠﻲ ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻒ ﻣﺠﺪ ِﺩ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ١ﺑﻌﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺸ ِ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻴﺎﻫﻲ ﻭ ﺟﺎﺎﻧﻮﺭ ﹺ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﺸﻒ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻭي ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨﻮﺩ ﻒ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٥ ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﺸ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎ ﺰ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮏ
١٥٤
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﮓ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻁ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﮊﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻥ eﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﮔﮔﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﺎﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺑﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ( .ﺍﻣﺮﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﻧﻧﻮﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ي ﺑﺮﺍي ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻏﻴﺮﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﭼﻴﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺭ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺑﭙﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﻏﻴﺮﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺻ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻭﻡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮊﮊﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮏ ﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮊﻥ ﻫﻫﺎي ، ﺭﻭي ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﻮﺯﻣﻮﻡ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ،ﺍﮔﮔﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪﺪ ﮊﻥ ﺑﺮ ي ﻧﺎﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﻮﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﻧﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﻣﻨﺪﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺩِ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ﻧﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﻪ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﻴﺪﮔﺮ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﻮﺩﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﻡ ﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻳﮏ ﺩ ﻫﺎي ﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﻮﺩ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻻﺕ ﺧﻮﺩ ،ﻣ ﺕِ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮐﺮﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﻑ ﺑﺎﻭ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻨﺪﻝ ،ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﺎي ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻧﻤﻲ ﻳﺎﺎﺑﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﻬﺎ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﺭﻭي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻠﻒ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ. ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١ – ١٥ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﺮﹺ ﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺮ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ :ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺍﺳﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿ
١٥٥
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺐ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﭽﻪ ﻫﺎ % ٥٠ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ % ٥٠ﺩﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺑﭽ ﻣﺤﺎﺳﺒﻪ ي ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﻮﺳﻂ ﺩﺭ % ٥٠ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؟ ﻒ ﻭ ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪ .١ﻭ ﺍﻣﻣﺎ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ! ﺗﮑﻠﻴ ِ ﻳﮑﺪﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﮏ
ﺩﻭﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ: ٢ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺩﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﺁﻳﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺨ ﺗﺨﻢ ) ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ( ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺨ ﻥ : ٣ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺨﻢ ﺠﺪﺩﺍ ً ﺷﮑﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﺧﻼﻑ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻝ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺩﺍﺭ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻣﺠ ﺑﺮ ﻑِ ﮑﻲ ﺶ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﺁﺭﺭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﮎ ﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ % ١٠٠ﮊﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺪﻳﻬﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺮ ﺩﺩﻭ ﭘﺴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺧﺘﺮ. ﺗﺨ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺨ ﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺴﺎﻥ : ٤ﻦ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ) ﺧﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮ – ﺑﺮﺍﺍﺩﺭ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ( ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺷﺘﺮﺍﮎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻗﻊ ﺮ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ % ٥٠ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺕ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺮﺍﺩﺩﺭ – ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮﺮﻫﺎ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺩﻧﻴﺎ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎﺎي ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺯﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻴﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺧﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﻨﺪ. ﻳﮏ ﭘﺴﺮ ﻭ ﮏ ﺧﺘﺮ ،ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﭘﭘﺴﺮ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﮏ ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪﺪ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺧﺘ ﻥ ﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١١٧ ١ﺑﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬ : twins ٢ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮ ﻠﻮﻫﺎ ntical twinss ٣ e Idenﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١١٨ : Frateernal twinss ٤ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ،ﺩﻭﻗﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﺩﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﻤﮑﻲ ) ( dizyggoticﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
١٥٦
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺖ ،ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺮﺍﺍﺩﺭ – ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻫﺮي ،ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻮﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﻞ ،ﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻤﺖ ﭼﭼﭗ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻼﺣﻈﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ.١ ﻭ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻼ
ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮐﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻬﻲ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺩﻭ ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺟﺰ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ % ١٠٠ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺷﺷﺮﻳﮑﻨﺪ ،ﭻ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ.٢ ﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺯﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﻫﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ
ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ ][١٩ e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ ﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٠ e ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ
١٥٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﺎ ﺳﻌﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺻﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻢ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .١ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ : ﺕ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي -ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻫﻮﺵ ( ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ .٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭼﻨﺪﮊﻧﻲ ) ٣ﮐﻤﻲ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.٤ ﭗ ﻧﻮﺯﺍﺩ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ » ﺟﻤﻊ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻧﺪ ) « ٥ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻫﻲ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،( .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ » ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﺟﺰﺋﻲ « ٦ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻂ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﺤ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ.٧
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢١ e ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٢ : polygeny ٣ﺩﺭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭼﻨﺪﮊﻧﻲ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺻﺪﻫﺎ ﮊﻥ ﺑﺮ ﻫﻮﺵ ﻳﺎ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ – ﻡ pleiotropy ٤ : additive ٥ﺟﻤﻊ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ : partial penetrance ٦ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ي ﺟﺰﺋﻲ e ٧ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٣
١٥٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏِ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي:١ ﻦ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻋﻠﻢ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ
eﻫﻴﭻ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨ ِﺪ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻥ
ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﭙﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ
ﺑﺎﻭﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ
ﺑﻪ ﭼﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ؟ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ
ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﻏﺮﺍﻳ ﹺﺰ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﻭ
ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺟﺪﺍ ﹺﻝ ﺳﺮﺷﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺑﻴﺖ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ
ﻓﺎﺭﻍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺍﺧﻠﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ
) ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ
ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ (
ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ؟ ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺗﺤ ِ
ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺮي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ : ﺞ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ.٢
Behavioral genetic ١ ي ﺁﻟﺰﺍﻳﻤﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ٢ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ي ﺁﻟﺰﺍﻳﻤﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺧﻄﺮ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ٦٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﺷﻮﺩ، ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺧﻄ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ٣٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ي ﺁﻟﺰﺍﻳﻤﺮ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﭖ ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٦
١٥٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ١ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ. ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ
ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺸﺨﻴﺺ ﺳﻬﻢ ﻧﺴﺒﻲ ﻋﻮﻣﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ،ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﻣﺤﻘﻘﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪي ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻣﺤﻘﻘﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺘﻀﺎﺩ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺑﺸﻮﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻞ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﺟﺴﺎﺭﺕ ( ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺶ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ.٢ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴ ِ ﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ
ﺚ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ،ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﻣﺤﻴﻂ « ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ١ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ " ﺩﺭ ﻣﺒﺎﺣ ِ ي ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩ ﻣﻌﻤﻤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺳﻨﺘﻲﹺ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ،ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﭘﺮﻭﺭي ،ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﺪﺍﺩ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻏﻴﺮﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﻳﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٤٨ ٢ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺳﺒ ﹺ ﺐ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﺗﻔﮑ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻞ ﭘﺮﻭﺭﺵ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺑﻌﺎﺩ ﻭ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲﹺ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﺍﺩﺭ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ،ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺕ ﺐ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻫﻤﺸﻴﺮﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﮔﺮﭼﻪ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻭﻟﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺷﺒﺎﻫ ِ ﺐ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ،ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻝ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (١٩ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
١٦٠
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﻳﺮي: ١ ﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﻞ ﻣﺤ ﻲ ﺳﻬﻬﻢ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻣﺤﻘﻘﻘﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﻲ ﺡ » ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي « ﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﭘﺮﺩﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻ ﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺳﺘﻔﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺠﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﺎﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﺖ ﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺼﻮﺻ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ي ﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺎﻗﻲ ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﻳﺮي ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ.٢ ﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﭙﺮﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺭﺕ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﻣﻤﮑ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ : ﺫﮐﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﺮ
ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ : ﻲ ﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﺘﻪ ي ﺍﻭﻝ :ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﺗﻌﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ،ﻳﺎ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗ ﹺﺮ ﻖ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺴﺮﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺡ ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ : Heritabilityﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﺬﻳﺮي :ﺩﺭ ﺍﺻ H y١ ﺖ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺭﺙ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﺬﻳﺮي ﻧﻤﺮﻩ ي ١ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﺭﻳﺎﻧﺲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺁﻣﺎﺭﺭي ،ﮐﺴﺮي ﺯ ﻲ ﺁﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻧﻤﻤﺮﻩ ي ﺻﻔﺮ ﻧﻧﻴﺰ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣١٤ ﻲ ﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻗﺪ ( ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻲ ﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺼﻮﺻ ﺍﻧﺤﺮﺍﻑ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﮕﻴﻦ ﺭ ﻑ ي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ – .ﻡ ﺟﻤﻌﻌﻴﺖ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺠﺎﺭ ﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺑﻬﻨﺠ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ي ﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺯﻭﺍ ﹺﻝ ﻋﻘﻞ ،ﻋﻘﺐ ﻣﻣﺎﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ٢ﻭﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺕ ﺑﻬﻨﺠﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻗﻗﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻋﻤﻤﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﺛﻲ ﻧﺎﺷﺷﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﮔﮔﺮ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺒﺮﻳﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺶ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺍﻳﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺮﺍ ِ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺷﮕﻔﺖ ﺯﺩﻩ ﺷﻮﻳﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮏِ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺖ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻦ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﻗﺪ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺯ ِﻥ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻥ ﺤﻪ ي ( ١٨ ﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎﭖﹺ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤ ﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑ ﺕ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ
١٦١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻦ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻗﺎﺋﻞ ﺷﺪ.ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺫﮐ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺜﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﺑﻼﮎ ( ١٩٩٥ ) ١ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ : ﺖ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﭼﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺳ ِ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺳ ِ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺳ ِ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩ ﹺﺭ ﺷﻤﺎ ﭼﻪ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﺷﻤﺎ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻓﺎﺭﻍ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺳ ِ ﺖ ﺐ ٥ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳ ِ ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭼﻪ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ( .ﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳ ِ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﺖ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺧﻮﺩ ٥ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺖ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻳﺮﻳﻦ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺙ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺎﺭ ( ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﺗﺼﺎﺩﻑ ﻳﺎ ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳ ِ ﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﻦ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺎﻻ ( ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﺸﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺳ ِ ﻦ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﻌﻴﻴ ﹺ
Block ١
١٦٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ : ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻭﻡ :ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻓﺮﻕ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻳﮏ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻤﻌﻴ ِ ي » ﻫﻮﺵ « ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ : ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﮓ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺬﺑﻮﺭ ،ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ١٠ﺗﺎ ٢٠ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺗﺤﺼﻴﻼﺕ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺑﻴﺴﻮﺍﺩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ( . ﺩﺭﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ،ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻞ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺵ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ي ﻫﻮﺵ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ( . ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺵ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺤﺼﻴﻞ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﺴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺵ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ي ﻫﻮﺵ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺑﺎﻻﺳﺖ.١ ﮓ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺶ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻗﻔﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ ) ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٨٠ ١ﺣﺎﻝ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻣﻄﻠﻊ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻳﺪ ،ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ( ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺪﺍﺯﻳﺪ – ﻡ
١٦٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﹺ ي ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .١ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ،ﮐﻮﺭﻟﻲ ،ﺩي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻳﺲ ﻭ ﻓﻮﻟﺮ .( ١٩٩٠ ٢ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﮊ ِﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻳﻢ ! ﭘﺲ ﭼﻄﻮﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻕ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻓﺘﺪ ؟ ﭼﻴﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﻳﻬﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺐ ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﻅ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﭼﺎﻗﻲ ﻭ ﻋﺪ ﹺﻡ ﺗﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺤﺮﮎ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎي ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﻣﺪ ِ ﺕ ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ{ ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ( . ﻫﺎ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ } ﻣﺜ ﹺ
ﻞ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﺷﺎي ﺗﻠﻮﻳﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ١ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ – ﻡ Plomin , Corley , De Fries & Fuler ٢
١٦٤
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ي ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﭘﻨﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﻴﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﮔﻲ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺐ ﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .١ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻏﻴﺮﺮﹺ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ( PKUﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﻓﻨﻴﻞ ﮐﺘﻮﻧﻧﻮﺭﻳﺎ ) P ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﻓﻨﻨﻴﻞ ﮐﺘﻮﻧﻮﺭﺭﻳﺎ) ٢ ﻝ ( PKﻳﮏ ﺍﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ KU ﺖ ﮊﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﻣﺒﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻞ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ) ﺑﮑﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩﻥ (ِ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺁﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺍي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻓﻨﻴﻞ ﺁﻻﻻﻧﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﻧﺪ }.ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻴ ﻥ ﺑﻮﻟﻴﺰﻩ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮ ( PKﺩﺭ ﮐﺜ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ { .ﻓﻨﻴﻞ ﮐﺘﻮﻧﻮﻮﺭﻳﺎ ) KU ﻣﺎﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻲ ﺍﺯﺩﻳﺎ ِﺩ ﻓﻨﻴﻞ ﺁﻻﻻﻧﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻮﻥ ،ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻋﻋﻘﺐ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻲﹺ ي ﻳﻳﮏ ﺭﮊﻳ ﹺﻢ ﺳﺳﻔﺖ ﻭ ﺖ ﺳﺨﺖ ي ﺑﺴﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﻦ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺙ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.٣ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺗﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻘﺐ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺶ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺯ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﻨﻴﻞ ﺁﻻﻧﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﺑﺮﺮﺳﺎﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺶ ﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ( . ﺖ ﻣﺨ PKﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺩﻭ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺭﺙ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥِ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي KU ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻧﺤ ) ﺷﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺣﺜﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﮊﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ي ﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﮊﻧﺘﺘﻴ ِ ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺭي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺕِ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻﺕ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺪﺪﺍﻡ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺑﻬﻨﻨﺠﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻪ ﺼﻴﺖ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸ ﻞ ﮊﻧﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻮﻮﺵ ﻭ ﺷﺨﺼ ﻧﻘﺶ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺶﹺ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻉ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺖ ﺫﻫﻨﻨﻲ ﺳﻬﻢ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﻧﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎ ﺍﺭﺭﺯﺷﻲ ﺖ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ،ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﺤﺚ ﻭ ﺟﺟﺪﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ي ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﹺ ﮎِ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻳﮏ ﭼﭼﻴﺰ ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﺷﻮﺍﻫﻫﺪ ﻭ ﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﺖ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻩ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻨﻪ ي ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺖ ﮐﻨﻮﻮﻧﻲ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺴﺖ ﮐﻪﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٤ e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼ pheny ylketonuriaa ٢ ﺕ ﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) ﻫﻤﻤﺎﻧﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔ ﹺ ي ٣ﺍﮔﮔﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻴﻦ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻥ ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔﻲ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ١ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺎﺑﻞ ﮏ ﻣﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﻣﻣﺜ ﹺ ي ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ ( ،ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﻞ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﮔﺮﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ﺻ ﮐﻼﺳﺳﻴ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺮﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺖ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﺙ ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻣﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻲ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺮﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ٠.٥ﺍﺳﺳﺖ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻮﻉ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢٥ ﺪ
١٦٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
eﻻﻣﺎﺭﮐﺴﻴﻢ ) : ( Lamarckism ﻞ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ) ( ١٨٢٩– ١٧٤٤ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻭ ﻭ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻭي ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺗﺤﺖ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﻭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻃﺒﻴﻌ ِ ﺣﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮐﻴﺴﻢ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮐﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﻞ ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﻋﺎﺩﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺴﺐ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺑﮑﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ،ﺁﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ،ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﮔﺮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﭘﺎﻫﺎي ﺯﺭﺍﻓﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻓﻲ ،ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﺸﻮﺩ ،ﺁﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺗﺤﻠﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺗﺎ ﺟﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﻭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻦ ﻏﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺗﺎﺭﻳﮏ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﺒﻮ ِﺩ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ،ﻧﺒﻮ ِﺩ ﭼﺸﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺳﺎﮐ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﮐﺘﺴﺎﺏ ) ﺳﺎﺯﺵ ( ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺍﮐﺘﺴﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﻌﺘﻘﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﻭﺛﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻃﻲ ﺯﺍﺩﺁﻭﺭي ﺣﻔﻆ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ﺐ ﺑﺎﺯﻭﺍ ِﻥ ﻗﻮي ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﺯﻭﺍﻧﺶ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻞ ً ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺁﻫﻨﮕﺮ ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﺝ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮐﺴﻴﻢ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻣﻴﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼﻑ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ﻭ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻓﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻥ ﺕ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻭ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻧﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺍﮐﺘﺴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺭﺳﻨﺪ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻫﻤﻔﮑﺮﺍﻧﺶ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺁﻥ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭ .ﻓﻘﻂ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺁﻥ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي » ﺟﻨﺴﻲ « ) ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ ( ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﻥ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻧﺒﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ،ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪي ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ .ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﺯﻣﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻋﺪ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ،ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﻲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻣﮕﺲ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ٦٩ﻧﺴﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﮑﻲ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻞ ﻧﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺶ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺁﺳﻴﺒﻲ ﻧﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺒﻴﻴ ﹺ ي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ ،ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ،ﺗﺤﻮﻝ ﻭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺢ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻧﻴﺎﻣﺪ .ﮐﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺮﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﮔﺸﻮﺩ ،ﮐﺴﻲ ﻧﺒﻮﺩ ﺟﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ) .ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ( – ﻡ ﺻﺤﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ : ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭼﺎﭖﹺ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٤ -٢٣ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳﺖِ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌﺖِ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸﺮﹺ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎﭖﹺ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٧
١٦٦
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﮕﺮ ﭼﭗ ( ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﺖ ﭗ ﺖ ( ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻳﻦ ) ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﮎ ) ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺳﺳﻤ ِ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ،ﺩﻳﺪﮔﮔﺎﻩ ﻻﻣﺎﺭﮎ Wﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻞﹺ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﻳﺴﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ :
١٦٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
eﺁﻳﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ ؟ ﻞ ﻳﮏ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ،ﻧﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﭘﻴﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﮔﺎﺭي ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﺗﻨﺨﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺑﻲ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭي ،ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ ،ﺑﻮﻡ ﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻧﻤﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻃ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ .ﭘﺲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ) ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ ( ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ.
eﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
eﭼﻪ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ) ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ( ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ، ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﻮﻳﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﮐ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻧﻮﻋﺎ ً ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﺀ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐ ﹺ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧ ﹺ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ،ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ. ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ،ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﺶ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐ ﹺ ﺣﺎﻝ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺮﺳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻧﻴﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﺩ ﹺﻝ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺖ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ " :ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴ ِ ﻞ ﺁﺑﻲ، ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﺳﻪ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ .ﺫﮐ ﹺﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻲ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ :ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﻪ ي ﮊﻧﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻧ ِ ﻞ ﺭﻧﮓِﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺖ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻣﺸﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ﺍي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺎ ﮔﺬﺷ ِ ﺖ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻨﺒﻊ : ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺟﻤﻌﻴ ِ
ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ) ٤٨ -٤٦ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ( ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ – ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴﮏ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ
ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٥ ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ ،ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ ،ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ،ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ
١٦٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦﹺ ] [١ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻫﺮ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺩﺳﺘﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺐ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻟﺬﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ، ﻭﺍﺣﺪي ﺭﺍ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ٢٥
ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻬﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺘﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻮﺭﺍ ِ ﻲ ﻣﻨﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺩﻧﺒﺎﻝ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ.ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﺍﻟﮕﻮي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺩﺳﺘﻮﺭﺍ ِ ﺚ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﻗﺖ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩﺷﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺪﻧ ﹺ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺭﺍ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ، ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ي ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﻪ ي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺑﮑﺎﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﻪ ﺍي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥ -٦
١٦٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
] [٢ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ي » ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ « ﻳﺎ ﺳﺎﺯﻭﺍﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻭﺍﺣ ِﺪ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﻻﻟﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﻮﻳﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺟﺰﺍي ي ﺑﺎﺯ ﻭ ﭘﻮﻳﺎ ﻁ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ،ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻧﺮﮊ ﹺ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎ ِ ﻂ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻼ ً ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ً ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻭ ﻧﻔﻮ ِﺫ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺭﻭي ﺁﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ. ﭖ ﻫﻔﺪﻫﻢ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٤ -٣٥ ﻲ ﺭﺷﺪ -ﺍﺛﺮ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺍﮐﺒ ﹺﺮ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
] [٣ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧ ِﺪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺷﺎﻣﭙﺎﻧﺰﻩ ،ﮔﻮﺭﻳﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻭﺭﺍﻧﮕﻮﺗﺎﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻞ ﻫﻤﺴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺳﻘﻒ ﻭﻭﺳﺘﺮ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﺪ " :ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻣﻴﻤﻮﻥ ؟ ﺁﻩ ! ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺁﮔﺎﻩ ﻧﺸﻮﻧﺪ! " ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﺎﻧﻢ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﻞ ﻣﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﭘﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻴﺎﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻣﻨﺸﺎﺀ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻧﮑﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. DNAﺩﺭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﻧﺨﺴﺘﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺷﺎﻣﭙﺎﻧﺰﻩ % ٩٨ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﺖ ﺑﺎ DNAﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﭗ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﺎﻣﭙﺎﻧﺰﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﭗ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣ ﹺ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﻳﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ
] [٤ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﻥ ،ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺩﻡ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ).ﮔﺮﮐﻮ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ، ١٩٩٦ﭘﺮﻳﻨﻮﺱ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ، ٢٠٠١ﺷﻮﺑﺮﺕ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ، ٢٠٠١ﺷﺎﻡ ﻭ
١٧٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ، ١٩٩٩ﺗﺎﮐﺎﺩﺍ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ (١ ١٩٩٤ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻧﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﮐﺎﺗﻮ ، ٢٠٠٤ﺭﻭﻟﻴﻨﮏ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ .( ٢ ١٩٩٣ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻭ ﹺﻝ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻦ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻭ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ( ﺑﻪ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺞ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﺣﺬﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻡ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺷﺪﻥ ) ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻓﺎﻟﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺳﻴﻤﺎﻧﺪﻝ ، ١٩٧٨ﻣﻮﺭ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺳﺎﻭﺩ ، ١٩٩٨ﻧﻴﻮﻟﺴﺘﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ( ٣١٩٩٣ ﻞ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﺑﻪ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺳﺘﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻳﺮ ،ﺟﻨﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺭﻭﻳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﺪ ﮐﺪﺍﻡ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﻣﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻨﻴ ﹺ
ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺭ ِﺩ ،ﺩﻡ ﺣﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟ ِﺪ ﻧﻮﺯﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ! ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ : http://www.thefetus.net/images/article-images/Musculoskeletal/tail_fernando_files/Tailman.jpg www.talkorigins.org/faqs/comdesc/images/tail.jpg http://www.creation-vs-evolution.us/visual-evolution/human-tails/human_tails_١٠.jpg ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٣٨ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﭖ ﺑﻴﺴﺘﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٥٨ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻴﺪﻧﺰ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺻﺒﻮﺭي – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
] [٥ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺮﻡ ،ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﺍﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪﻥ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ٢٣ﺟﻔﺖ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ٢٣ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ١٩٩٤; Takada et al. ١٩٩٩; Shum et al. ٢٠٠١; Schubert et al. ٢٠٠١;Prinos et al. ١٩٩٦Greco et al. ١ ٢٠٠٢ Katoh ٢ﻭ ١٩٩٣ Roelink et al. ١٩٩٣; Nievelstein et al. ١٩٩٨ ; Moore and Persaud ١٩٧٨ Fallon and Simandl ٣
١٧١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﻭ ٢٣ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻫﺮ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺮﻡ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭﺍﻳﻞ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫﺎ ) ﻏﺪﺩ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻠﻮﻍ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ – .ﻡ
ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ] [٦ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﺯﻳﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺗﺎً ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻞ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ،ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥِ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ﻭ ﺗﺒﺪﻳ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﭼﻴﺪﻩ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ،ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ٢ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺍ ِﻥ ٢٣ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩ -٣١
١٧٢
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻫﻠﻲ ) ﻈﻴ ﻲ :ﻣﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻮﻻً ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﻳﺎ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﺜﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨﺴﻲ ] [٧ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻞﹺ [ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﻢ .ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥ ﻢ ﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﮔﻮﺳﻔﻨﺪ ( ﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖ ﺪ ﮔﺎﻭ ﻭ ﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺟﻨﺴﺴﻴﺖ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﻪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻞ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺍي ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺖ ، ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻩ ي ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭﻭ ﺟﻨﺲ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻳﻦ ﺍﺷﮑﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺪ ي ﻣﮋﮐﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ » ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺍﻣﺴﻲ « ،ﻫﺸﺸﺖ ﺟﻨﺲ ﺗﮏ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﮏ ﮏ ﻞ ﭗ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮﺮي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻫﺸﺖ ﺗﻴ ﹺ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻨﺪ. ﺪ ﻇﺎﻫﻫﺮي ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﭽ ، ﺍﺯ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﺲ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﻨﺲ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺟﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺩﺩﻭ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ. ﻼﺣﺎً ﻫﺮﻣﺎﻓﺮﺮﻭﺩﻳﺖ ) ﻭ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﻲ ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﺴ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﻠ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﺗﺮ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻏﻴﺮﺮﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎ ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺩﻩ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺮ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻣﻴﺰﺵ ﻧﺮ ﻭ ﻩ ﺵﹺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺘﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻟﺰﺰﻭﻣﺎً ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﺧﺰﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺍﺷﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺣﺸﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻲ ﺕ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﮐﺘﺮي ﻫﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻝ ﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨﻨﺴﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﻧﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻞ ﻲ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪِ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺕ ﻖ ﻞ ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺰﻳﻳﺖ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺑﭙﺮﺳﻴﺪ :ﭼﺮﺍ ؟ ﺪ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻴ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﻲ ﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﺴﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ،ﺗﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺗﻮﻟﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺍﻓﺰﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺩﻫﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮﺮ، ﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩي ﻳﮕﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺯﻳﻳﺮﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻮ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﮐﻪﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻲ، ﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﺍﺯ ﻃﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺗﺼﺎﺎﺩﻓﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﻬﻬﺎي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺖ
١٧٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺶ ﻂ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻏﻴﺮﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٨٣ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي -ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٥ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٤٧
] [٨ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ : ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﺮ ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ) ﮔﺎﻣﺖ ﻫﺎ (، ﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﻃ ﹺ ﻣﻴﻮﺯ ،ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪي ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻣﻮﻗﺘﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪي ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺗﺤﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻟﻘﺎﺡ ،ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ) ﺗﺨ ﹺﻢ ﺑﺎﺭﻭﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ( ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺖ ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺎﻣ ِ ﺖ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯﻣﻲ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ،ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻳﮏ ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻭ ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ .ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﻧﺰ – ﮐﺎﺭﭖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﺎﺭي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻨﻔﺸﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٣ -٤٢
١٧٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﭻ ﺩﻭﺗﺎﻳﻲ DNAﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮕﻮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ] [٩ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﺯي ) : ( Replicationﻫﺮ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي ﻣﺎﺭﭘﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺵ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻘﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺍﺳﺖ. ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻴﺪﺭﻭﮊﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺯي ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺿﻌﻴﻔﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ي ،DNAﺩﻭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي DNAﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺯﻳﭗ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻃﻲ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٩١ – ٩٨ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
١٧٥
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
RN ﺩﻭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻮﻟﻲ ﺗﮏ ﺭﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﺍي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪNA . DNAﮐﻪ ﻣﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻟﻲ ﻭ ﻑA ] RNA [١١٠ﺑﺮﺧﻼ ِ ﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺍﻭﻭﺭﺍﺳﻴﻞ ) ( Uﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﺪ ﻭ Uﺑﺎ A ﺑﻪ ﺟﺟﺎي ﺗﻴﻤﻴﻦ ) ( Tﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻳﻳﮏ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺩﻳﮕ RNAﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻃﻃﻲ R ﻲ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ DNAﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣ RNAﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮ ﹺﻝ A ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﺖ ﻳﮏ ﻭﺍﺣﺪِ ﺭﻭﻧﻮﻮﻳﺴﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻳﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺭﻭﻧﻮﻳﺴﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي DNAﺳﺎﺧ ،RNﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺣﺎ ً ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﻧﻮﻳﺴﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ NA ﺖ RNAﻋﻤﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮕﮕﻮي ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ي DNAﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. RNAﺳﺎﺧﺘﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺳﺳﭙﺲ ،ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ﻃﻲ ﻓﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮕﻮي A ﻝ ﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٩١ – ٨٤ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
١٧٦
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻥ ﺑﺤﺚ ،ﺻﻔﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺖ ، ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﮐﻴﻔﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻤﻲ :ﺭ ] [١١١ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺻﻔﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﺜﻼً ﺭﻧ ِ ﭼﺸﻢ ،ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺭﻓﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﻭﻳﮋﮋﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺖ ﮓ ﭼﺸ ﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼ ﻒ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﮑ ﺻﻴ ِ ﺗﻮﺻ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ يﹺ ﮏ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ : : ( qualitativﺑﻪ ﺻ q ﺕ ﮐﻴﻔﻲ ) ve traitss ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺻﻔﺎﺗﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺠﺰﺍي ﻓﻨﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﺻﻔﺖ ﺭﺍ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﺁﻥ ﺻ ﻨﺪي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺕِ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻳﺎ ﺭﻧ ِ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﭼﺸ ﹺﻢ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻲ ﮓﭼ ﺖ ﺕ، ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺖ ﮐﻴﻴﻔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﺭﺍﺛ ِ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺭﻧﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ﮏ ﻳﺎ ﺖ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮓِ ﭻ ،ﻳﺎ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻂ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻋﻼ ﮑﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﭼﻨﺪ ﮊﻥ ﺭ ﺗﺤﺖ ﮐﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺩﻭ ﮊﮊﻥ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻂ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮊﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺒﻬﻢ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻ ﺁﻥ ﺖ ﺕ ﮐﻴﻔﻔﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺑﺮﺍي ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ي ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ﺪ ﻩ ﻧﺒﻮﺩﻥ ﻣﻮ، ﮓ ﺑﺬﺭ ،ﺑﻮﻮﺩﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻥِ ﮓ ﮔﻞ ،ﺭﻧ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺭﺭﻧ ِ :( quﺑﻪ ﺻﻔﺎﺗﻲ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ) uantitativve traitss ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺣﺪي ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺣ يﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﻣﺠﺰﺍ ﻗﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ. ﻲ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﻮﺍﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻧﻤﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﻔﺖ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻔﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻫﺴﺖ ﺎﻳﺎ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ. ي ﮔﮔﺴﺴﺘﻪ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﮐﻤﻲ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻮ ، ﺕ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺡ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ،ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺻ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻴﭗ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻴ ﹺ ﮕﺮ ﭗ ﺩﻳﮕ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺎﻣﺤﺴﻮﺱ ﺯ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ،ﻃﻴﻔﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﻥ ، ي ﻣﺴﺘﻤﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺘﻨﺪ. ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺻ ﻲ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺗﻨﻨﻮﻉ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ
١٧٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ي ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ،ﺟﺰﺀ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ :ﻫﻴﭻ ﻣﺮﺯي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﺗﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺮﺯ ،ﻓﺮﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺮﺯ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻗ ِﺪ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﺎﻥ ،ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻠﻮﻍ ،ﻫﻮﺵ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻴﻔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻦ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ -١ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ. -٢ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭي ﮐﻪ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻂ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ) ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻ ً ١٠ﺗﺎ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ١٠٠٠ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ( ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ،ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺑﻪ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺕ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮊﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ. ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٧٧ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ] [١٢ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﮊﻧﻲ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺁﻥ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻗﺮﻳﻨﻪ ﺍي ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﺬﺷ ِ ﺖ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻧﻈﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺖ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺐ ﺻﻔ ِ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺁﻥ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺖ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺗﻠﻘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺁﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺁﻟﻞ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺣﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩ ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٧
١٧٨
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻌﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﺴﻞ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺳﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺗﺪﺑﻴﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺪ ي ﺏ ﻃﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻫﺮ ﺍﺑﺰﺰﺍﺭ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺪِ ] [١١٣ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤ ﹺﺮ ﺕ ﻣﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ي ﮔﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺁﻣﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﻪ ﺗﺪﺍﺑﻴﺮ ﻤ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﺗﺤﻤﻤﻴﻞ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻪﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ي ﮕﺮ ،ﻣﺮﺍﻗﺒﺖ ﺍﺯ ﮕﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺍﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻔﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﺩﻳﮕ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﺩﻳﮕ ، ﻖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺭﺍﺯﺗﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻓﻨﻮﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻟﺬﺍ ﻣﻮﻮﻓﻖ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﮊﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻳﻲ ﺏﹺ ﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻄﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺯﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠ ﺠﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠ ﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍﻧﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺛﺮﺮﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻩ ﺶ ﻣﺜﻠﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ﺖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻃﻮﺭﺭي ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﮊﻥ ﺍﺭﺗﺗﻘﺎﺀ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺖ ﺪ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ :
ﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٥ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬ
ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٥
١٧٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
] : phenotype [١٤ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻬﺘ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻤﺴﺖ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻳﻢ :
ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺸﻬﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ .١ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.
ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻧﻪ .٢ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻻ ِ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺖ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺕ ﻭ ﮐﻴﻔﻴ ِ ﻞ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١١٩ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
ﺺ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺖ ﻣﺸﺨ ﹺ .٣ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﮓ ﮔﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ِﺭﻭﻳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭗ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻻ ِ ﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺑﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﮊﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٧ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
] [١٥ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﺎﺩﺭ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﹺ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺨﻮﺩي ﺩﺭ ﻗﺴﻤﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ DNAﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﮐﻪ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦﹺ ﻧﺎﻗﺺ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺺ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺧﺎﻟﺺ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻇﺎﻫ ﹺﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺎﺧ ﹺ ﻞ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ،ﺑﻨﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﻃﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺟﻬﺶ ،ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺁﻟﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ. ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١ – ٣٣٧ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
١٨٠
ﻡ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻣﺒ
ﻲ ﮐﺎﺭﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻳ ﺶ ﺖ ﮐﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ] [١١٦ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻀﺮ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﻌﻨﻨﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺳﻲ ﺩﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻫﺴﺘﻴﻢ : ﻢ ﺏ ﻃﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻝﹺ ﺕ ﺯﻧﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻮﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻋﻠﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺎ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﻮ ِﺩ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻧﺰ ﻣﺠﻤﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻥ ﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺟﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺁﻥ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻳﻢ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻞﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺮ ﺖ ﺐ ﻣﺘﺘﻮﺍﺯﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪﺪ ﺗﺮﮐﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺑﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺴ ﺟﻬﺶ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺟ ﺗﻮﺍﺯ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﮎ ﺩ ﺯ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻨﺪﺪﺭﺕ ،ﺶ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺯ ﺚ ﺟﻬﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻥﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻧﺪ. ﺠﺎ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌﻌ ِ ﺗﺮﺟﻤ ﺤﻪ ي ٣٩ ﭼﺎﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺻﻔﺤ ﭖﹺ
١٨١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
] [١٧ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : .١
ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﮊﻥ ،ﺩﻭ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺴﺮ ،ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﺪ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﺍﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﺪ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﭘﺴﺮ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮﺵ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ،ﻳﮏ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ٢٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ٥٠ ) .ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺿﺮﺑﺪﺭ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ = ٢٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ (
.٢
ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﭘﺴﺮ ،ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﺪ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﺍﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﮊﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﺪ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﭘﺴﺮ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮﺵ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ،ﻳﮏ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ٢٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ٥٠ ) . ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺿﺮﺑﺪﺭ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ = ٢٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ (
ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ٢٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ٢٥ +ﺩﺭﺻﺪ = ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ .ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺩﺭ ﮒ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭ ٥٠ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﺎ ﭘﺪﺭ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﺰﺭ ِ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ % ٢٥ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻮﻫﺎ ،ﻋﻤﻪ ﻫﺎ ،ﺧﺎﻟﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﺍﻳﻲ ﻫﺎ % ١٢.٥ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ – ﻡ
ﺕ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺩﺭ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ] [١٨ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎ ،ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﺗﮏ ﺗﺨﻤﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ← .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺸﮑﻼ ِ ﺖ ﺧﺎﺹ ،ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻗﺪ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﻭ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺖ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ ﮐﺴﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺟﺰ ﺩﻭ ﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ. ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻓﺮﺻ ِ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٠
١٨٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻦ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻭ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ] [١٩ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺎ ﭘﺪﺭ .ﻭﻟﻲ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺶ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻭ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﻋﻠ ِ ﮐﺪﺍﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ٢٣ﺗﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ،ﻫﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺖ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ،ﺳﻬﻤﻲ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ » ﺑﻄﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ « ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺖ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ ،ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺷﺒﺎﻫ ِ ﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺟﻬﺖ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ،ﭼﻴﺰي ﻏﻴﺮﻋﺎﺩي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻠ ِ ﺕ ﻗﺮﻳﻨﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﻴﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﻟ ِﺪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺑﭙﻮﺷﺎﻧﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻠﺸﺎﻥ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٩ – ٧
ﺖ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎي ] [٢٠ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﻭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ ،ﻓﺮﺩﻳ ِ ﺶ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻳﮕﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﺎﻩ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺷﺪ. ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ،ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺱ ﺁﻥ ﻓﻠﺴﻔﻪ ﺍي ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺷﺄﻥ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻃﺮﺡ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﺍي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﺭﻳﺰي ﺷﻮﺩ ! ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﻋﺪ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻗﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ،ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﻭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺑﻮﺩ، ﺱ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺳﺖ. ﺐ ﭘﺪﻳﺪ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺁﺭﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ .ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ ﺹ ١٥٠
١٨٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻞ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ] [٢١ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺘﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺗﮏ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ) ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺭﻧﮓ ﭼﺸﻢ ( ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ) ﮐﻤﻲ ( ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ً ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺩﻭﻗﻠﻮﻫﺎي ﻫﻤﺴﺎﻥ ،ﻓﻘﻂ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺑﻬﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺷﻮﺍﻫ ِﺪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ! ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٤٩ – ١٤٨
] [٢٢ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺖ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺻﻲ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺕ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﮐﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺖ ﺕ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺗﻮﺍﻣﺎ ً ﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻋﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻴﮏ ﺗﺸﺒﻴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻓﻘﺮﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺨﺘ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﮐﻴﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﺰﻩ ي ﮐﻴﮏ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﻫﺪ.ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﻴﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻗﻠﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .( ١٩٧٨ Dawkins ) .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﻫﺮ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﺍﺯ » ﮊ ِﻥ ﺐ ﺖ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ « ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺧﻮﺍﻩ ﻳﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮊﻥ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٨
١٨٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﺕ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻧﺒﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺭﭼﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻋﻤﺪﺗﺎ ً ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻣﺰﻫﺎي ] [٢٣ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺸﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﻧﻴﺎﺯي ﺶ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋ ﹺ ي ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺘﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺧﺎﻃﺮ ﻣﻮﺭﭼﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺒﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻻﺑﻼي ﺗﺎﺭ ﻭ ﭘﻮ ِﺩ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺹ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋ ﹺ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ ؛ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺨﺼﻮ ﹺ ﺗﻨﻴﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺸﺮﺍﺕ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﻭ ﻧﻘﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺟﺮﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺁﺩﻣﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺁﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﻗﻮﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﻌﻄﺎﻑ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻖ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻟﺬﺍ ،ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻪ ي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ي ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ي ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﺧﻠ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﻖ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ،ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻂ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥِ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺕ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎي ﺑﻘﺎ ﻭ ﺣﻴﺎ ِ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺟﺮﺡ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٧٠
] [٢٤ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﻻﻟﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺟﺒﺮﮔﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ » ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي « ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ .ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٤٧
ﻑ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪ ﮊﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﺑﻪ " ﻓﻘﻂ ﺑﻪ ﺻﺮ ِ ﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻨﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ .ﺣﺘﻲ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻋﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻧﻤﻮﺩ" . ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ٢٨
١٨٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭼﻬﺎﺭﻡ
ﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) ] [٢٥ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﮏ ﻣﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﻣﺜﻞ ِﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﮔﺮﻭ ِﻩ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺍﺳﺖ ( ،ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺕ ﮐﻼﺳﻴ ِ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺎ ِ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻥ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ١ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲﹺ ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻲ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻭﻳﮋﮔ ﹺ ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ٠.٥ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻓﻨﻮﺗﻴﭙﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ي ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺣﺘﻤﺎ ً ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﭼﻮﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔ ِ ﺖ ﮔﻴﺎﻫﻲ ( ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ٠.٥ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ % ٥٠ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴ ِ ﺖ ﮐﻤﻲ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻴﺎﻩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﮏ ﺕ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻴﺎﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﭗ ﺑﺮﺗﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺕ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻞ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻂ ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﻭ ﻓﻘﻴﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) ﻣﻘ ﹺ ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻳﻪ ،ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ،ﺯﻳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺸﺮﻩ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ( ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻂ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﭗ ﻣﺘﻮﺳ ِ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﮊﻧﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﻂ ﻏﻨﻲ ﻭ ﻗﻮي ﺭﺷﺪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﺼﺎﺩﻓﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻣﺪﻓﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﻠﻘﻴﺢ ﺷﺪﻩ ( ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺍي ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ،ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺖ ي ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔﺖ ،ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻤﻌﻴ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻤﻌﻴﺖ ﺑﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺻﻔﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺖ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ) ﺩﺭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ( ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﮏ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻧﺴﻔﻴﻠﺪ – ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺭﺿﺎ ﭘﻴﻠﻪ ﭼﻴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ،ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪي – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻳﻴﮋ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢٩٠ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ
ﺶ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﻔﺲ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕ ( ) ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ
١٨٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﺠﻢ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠ ﻞ ﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸ ﻲ
١٨٧
١٨٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
١٨٨
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ :
ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ١٨٧ .......................................................................................................... ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ١٨٨ ..................................................................................................................... : ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻠﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻥِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ١٩٥ .......................................................................................... : ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶﹺ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ ٢٠٣ .......................................................................................................................... : ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ٢٠٧ .................................................................................................... ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ٢٠٧ .....................................................................................................................:
١٨٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩي ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ،ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﺗﺤﻠﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺵ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ،ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻲ ﺍﺭﺯ ﹺ ﻖ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.١ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﻲ ي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺷﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﹺ ﻁ ﺗﻨﮕﺎﺗﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎ ِ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺶ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﭘﺮﺳ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺱ ) " : ( ١٩٩٩ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﭼﺮﺍ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻃﺮﺍﺣﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻦ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﭼﻄﻮﺭ ﻃﺮﺍﺣﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺁﻥ ﭼﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ؟ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ ؟ ﺕ ﺩﮔﻴﺮ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ؟ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﭼﻪ ﮐﺎﺭي ﻃﺮﺍﺣﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﻦ ﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﻂ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻃﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺎ ،ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻂ ﺍﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺗﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ؟ " ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ
٢
ﺦ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﭼﻪ ﺳﻮﺩي ١ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ،ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﺶ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ – ﻡ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﻭ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ e ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١ ١٨٩
١٨٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺳﻴﻊ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻒ ﺑﺎﺱ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ ﻲ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ )١ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺪ ﮐﺮي .( ٢ﭘﻴﻨﮑﺮ (١٩٩٧ ) ٣ﺧﺎﺳﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺨ ﹺ ﺏ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻫﻢ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ : ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﻭ ﺍﻧﻘﻼ ﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ " :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺏ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ٤ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ١٩٥٠ﻭ ١٩٦٠ﮐﻪ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﺍﻧﻘﻼ ﹺ ﻣﺤﺎﺳﺒﺎﺕ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺕ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻲ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ١٩٦٠ﻭ ١٩٧٠ﮐﻪ ﻃﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠ ﹺ ﺏ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻧﻘﻼ ﹺ ﺐ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ٥ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺑﺎ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺗﻤﺮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻋﻤﻼً ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ " :ﻣﻐﺰﻫﺎ ...ﺧﺪﻣﺘﮕﺰﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ) ٦ﻏﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ( ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) " .ﮐﻨﺮﻳﮏ( ٢٠٠١ ٧
ﺕ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮ ،ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ : ١ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻲ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﺏ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ
ﻞ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ ﻭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮏ ﺑﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕﻲ ﻋﻤ ﹺ
ﻲ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﻫﺪﻑ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭼﺮﺍﻳ ﹺ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١١ David Carey ٢ Pinker ٣ e ٤ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢ ﺡ ﻖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ : replicator ٥ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ ) replicationﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ( ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺎﻋﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ) replicatorﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ : gonads ٦ﻣﻨﻈﺮﻭ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ،ﺑﻴﻀﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ – .ﻡ Kenrick ٧ ١٩٠
١٩٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﻲ ﺗﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ي ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ١ﻫﺎﺎي ﮐﻠﻴﺪ ﹺ ﺶ : (inclu ﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﮔﻴﺮﺮusive fittness) ٢ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﮕ .١ ﻖ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻳ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﺍ ﭼﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺴﺘ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ،ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻪ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺳﺳﻬﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻗﻮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻭ ﭼﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﻮﺭ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻘﻴﻢ ﺑﺎ ﮏ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.٣ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻴﻌﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ( ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ي
: ( Kin ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﻧﺪ ) K selecction ﺏﹺ .٢ ي ﺱ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺮﺽ ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻧﻮﺯﺍﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺳﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﻅِ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺎﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪﺪ ( ،ﺑﺮ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ) ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎﻅ ﺿﻴﻪ ) ( hypotthesisﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﻓﺮﺿ ﺽ ،ﻓﺮﺽ ← ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺯ : assumptionﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ a n١ ﺩﺍﺭﺩe .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣ ﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ – ﻡ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻲ ي : inclussive fitnesss ٢ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺮﺵ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺍﺷﺨﺎﺹ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﮔﻔﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﺭ ﻲ ﺏ ﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ٣ﻣﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﭙﺮﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﻄ ﹺﺮ ﺐ ،ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ﻭ ﻄ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ي ﺑﻴﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺩ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺜﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻨﻨﻮﻉ ﺗﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ، ﻴ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺳﺮﺑﻠﻠﻨﺪ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ. ﻝﹺ ﺍﻧﻘﺮﺍﺍﺽ ،ﺑﻪ ١٩١
١٩١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ): ( differential parental investment ي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭ ِ .٣ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺱ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ،ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻭ ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻦ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ، ﺭﻭي ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺳﺨ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ، ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﺎﻩ ﺁﺑﺴﺘﻨﻲ (
١
ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺑﻌﺪ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻳﺎ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺮ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ،ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺺ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺷﺨ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻒ ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺖ ) ٢ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺸ ِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ( ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺢ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺩ .ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺩ ِ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﺎﻧﻲ ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭي ) ٣ﻣﺜﻼ ﺗﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ، ﻂ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻣﺤﺎﻓﻈﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺧﻄﺮﺍﺕ ( ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻲ ﻭﻓﺎ ﻭ ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺘﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺵ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ : e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ : cuckoldry ٢ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ » ،ﺯﻥ ﻗﺤﺒﮕﻲ « ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ -.ﻡ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪ ي ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﺲ ﺑﻘﺎ ﹺ : Parental investment ٣ﻫﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺵ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺖ ﭘﺮﻭﺭ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣١٨ ١٩٢
١٩٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﻣﻄﻤﺌﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﻴﺎ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ،ﻓﺮﺯﻧ ِﺪ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻓﺮﺯﻧ ِﺪ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻔﺖ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ١؛ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ، ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﺣﺘ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.٢ ﺖ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي : ﻣﺮﺍﻗﺒ ِ ﻞ ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﮐﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ،ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻨﮕﻴﻨﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﻑ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺟﻬ ِ ﻞ ﺭﺣﻢ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺷﻴﺮ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ،ﺻﺮ ِ ي ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺗﺨﻢ ،ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻦ ﻻﻧﻪ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻞ ﺧﻄﺮﺍﺕ ﻭ ...ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﭘﺮﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺍﻗﺒﺖ ﻭ ﺩﻓﺎﻉ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺳﻮ ِﺩ ﺗﺨﻢ ،ﺭﻭي ﺗﺨﻢ ﻧﺸﻴﻨﻲ ،ﻏﺬﺍ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﻭ ..ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺟﺰﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ) .ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻋﻀﺎي ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ) ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ﻫﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺯﺍ ﹺﻍ ﮐﺒﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺳﻬﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ( ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺎﻡ ) ( ١٩٩٢ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻓﻠﻮﺭﻳﺪﺍ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ،ﺟﻮﺟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺗﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻮﺟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﺗﺮ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ، ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻘﺎي ﺟﻮﺟﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺘﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.
ﻑ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ١ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﺸﮑﻠﻲ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﻩ ﻳﻘﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺑﭽﻪ ي ﺩﻟﺨﻮﺍﻩ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ .ﺻﺮ ِ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲﹺ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺘﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ – .ﻡ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻞ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺗﺨﺎﺫ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﺳﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻔ ﹺﻊ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ٢ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺨﺰ ِﻥ ﮊﻧﻲ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺑﺮﺳﺎﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣٦ ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ١٩٣
١٩٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻂ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ .ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ي ﺍﺗﺨﺎﺫ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ،ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﹺ ﻦ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ) . ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻي ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺻﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺮﻳﮏ( ٢٠٠١ ،
ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﮔﻴﺮ
ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي
ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪ
ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ
ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ
ﺖ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴ ِ
ﮔﺬﺷﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي
ﻣﺮﺍﻗﺒﺖ ﺍﺯ
ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍﻥ
ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺮ
) ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ
ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ
ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ (
ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﺧﺸﻮﻧﺖ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ
ﺏ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ
ﺳﺮﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﮔﺬﺍﺭي
ﻗﺒﻠﻲ
ﻂ ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ
ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎً ﺩﺭ
ﻂ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﺑ ِ
ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺳﺨﺖ
ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ،ﺳﺨﺘﮕﻴﺮﺍﻧﻪ
ﮔﻴﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ
ﺗﺮ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ.
ﺗﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
ﺕ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺩ ِ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﺑﻪ
ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﺯﻧﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ
ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ
ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ
ﺖ ﻫﻤﺴﺮﺷﺎﻥ ﺧﻴﺎﻧ ِ
ي ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ
ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ
ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ،ﺑﻪ
.ﺍﺳﺖ
ﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ
ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ
ﺷﺪﺕ ﺳﺨﺖ ﮔﻴﺮﺍﻧﻪ
ﺑﺎﺭﻭﺭي ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.
ﺑﺮﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ.
ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ،ﺭﻗﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺳﺮ
ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺮﺗﺮي ﻭ
ﺕ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺯﻳﺒﺎﻳﻲ ﻭ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ
ﺖ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ
ﺯﺍﺩﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.
ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
١٩٤
ﻦ ﺧﺸﻮﻧﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺷﺎﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ.
١٩٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ : ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻠﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺗﮑﻴﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻂ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻨﻮﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ي ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﺴﻞ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ،ﺑﺎﺱ ) ( ١٩٩٩ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﺪ " : ﺵ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﻂ ﻣﺪﺭﻥ ،ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻭ ﺣﻮ ﹺ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻞ ﻲ ﻣﺎ ،ﻣﻴ ﹺ ﺦ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠ ﹺ ﭘﺎﺭﻳﻨﻪ ﺳﻨﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺣﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﭼﺮﺏ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭي ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﻏﺬﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺪﺭﺕ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻏﺬﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﻗﻠﺒﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ" . ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻫﻢ ﺍﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺳﺮﺧﺮﮒ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻠﺐ ﻭ ﺣﻤﻼ ِ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﮎ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﺩﻋﺎﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺭﺩ ،ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻞ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻏﺬﺍﻫﺎي ﭼﺮﺏ ( ﻞ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭي ﻧﺎﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﻭ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﻧﻴﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﻣﻴ ﹺ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .١ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ . ﻖ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥ ١٩٥
١٩٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﺑﺮﺳﺎﻧﻨﺪ. ﺪ ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻫﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﮊﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺖ ﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺁﮔﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﮔﮔﻮﻳﻲ ﺩ ) ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺎﺭ ِ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﺎﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺴﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻧﺴﺴﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺘﺘﻘﻞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ (.ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻖ ﮔﻔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭘﻴﻨﮑﺮﺮ ) " : ( ١٩٩٧ﮊﻥ ﺎ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ي
ﺕ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻦ ،ﺳﻼﻣﺘﻲ ،ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ، ﻟﺬ ِ ﺬ
ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺧﻮﻮﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻩ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻲ ﻫﺎ ،ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺪﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺘﻴﺎﺯ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻄﻲ ﺧﺮﻳﺪﺍﺭي ﻲ ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﺮ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﺖ ﻫﺮ ﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺨﺖ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﻲ ﻂ ﺑﺨ ﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻫﺪ ِ ﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺍﻳﻢ .ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻫﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﻑ ﻓﺮﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻑِ ﻫﺪﻑ ﻑ ﻣﺎ ﮏ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺗﮑ ﺭ ﻑ ﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻢ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺮﺮﺍ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﺍﻣﻣﺎ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺎ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻭﺟﺟﻪ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺩﻭﻭﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ،ﺳﻼﻣﺘﻲ ،ﻓﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺩﺩﻭﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ" .١ ﻑ ﺧﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺩﺭ ﺯﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻃﻮﺭ ﻏﻴﺮﻣﺴﺘﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻳﻤﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺵ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻧﺒﺎﻝ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﻑ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺎﻳﻤﺎﻥ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﭘﻴﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﻲ ﻥ ﺵ ﮊﻥ ﺩﻫﻴﻴﻢ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴﻴﺖ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺴﺘﺮ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﺪﺍ ِ ﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺻﻮﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﻴﺮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺗﮑﺮﺍ ﹺﺭ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ . ﻢ
(٢٠٠٨ ) moral instincﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ -م i ١ﺑﺮاﯼ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺎﻟﻪ ﯼ ﭘﻴﻨﮑﺮﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎم ِ
١٩٦
١٩٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ : ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ؟ ﮏ ﺏ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﮎ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺱ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺕ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٩٣ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﻔﺼﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ي ﮔﺬﺭﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ :
ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ : ﺏ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ -١ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ : ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺏ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻦ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺑﺮﺳﺎﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺏ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﺳﻦ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎﺱ ) ( ١٩٨٩ﺑﺎ ﻒ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﻁ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻲ ٣٧ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻲ ٣٧ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓِ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺍﻋﻼﻡ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺟﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻅ ﺳﻨﻲ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ٣٦ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ) ﺍﺳﭙﺎﻧﻴﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﺀ ﺑﻮﺩ ( ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.
١٩٧
١٩٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ : ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺟﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﭽﻪ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻅ ﺳﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﺟﺎﺕِ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻦ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊِ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺗﺎﻣﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺩﺍ ِﻥ ﭘﺮ ﺳﻦ ﻭﺳﺎﻝ ﺗﺮ ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﮏ ﺏ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﮎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺣﺴﺎﺑﮕﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﺳﺨﺖ ﮔﻴﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﺗﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﻞ ( ١٣ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻓﺼ ﹺ ﻂ ﮐﻼﺭﮎ ﻭ ﻫﺎﺗﻔﻴﻠﺪ ( ١٩٨٩ ) ١ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺷﺪ، ﺩﺧﺘﺮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﭘﺴﺮﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨﺲﹺ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺒﺎ ﻭ ﺟﺬﺍﺏ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎ ِﺩ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ % ٧٥ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﺴﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ي ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻧﺸﺪﻧﺪ ! ﺩﺧﺘﺮﺍﻥ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ :ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻋﻼﻡ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﺱ ﻭ ﺍﺷﻤﻴﺖ ،( ١٩٩٣ ) ٢ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺤﻘﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻘﻄﻌﻲ ﻭ ﺯﻭﺩﮔﺬﺭ ،ﺷﺮﻳﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ؟ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻑ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺕ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪِ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻞ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ،ﺁﻣﺎﺩﮔﻲﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﻂ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ،ﻓﺎﻗ ِﺪ ﺷﻮﺥ ﻃﺒﻌﻲ ،ﺧﺸﻦ ،ﺑﻲ ﺳﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺩﺍﻥ. ﻃﺮﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ
Clark & Hatfield ١ Buss & Schmidt ٢ ١٩٨
١٩٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
-٢ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﻧﻪ : ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ١ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻞ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ﻣﺸﮑ ﹺ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺧﻮﺩﺧﻮﺍﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻖ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻼﺋ ﹺ ﺦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺏ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺷﺨﺼﺎ ً ﻦ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴﻤﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﮔﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻃﻤﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ،ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﮑﻨﻨﺪ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍﻥ ِ ٢ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻘﺎي ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺍﻃﻤﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
ﺍﮔﺮ ﺗﻔﺴﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪِ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﺍﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﻪ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﺮﻧﺸﺘﺎﻳﻦ ﻭ ﮐﺮﺍﻧﺪﻝ ﻭ ﻂ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺸﮑﻞ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻴﺘﺎﻳﺎﻣﺎ ،( ١٩٩٤ ) ٣ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﺞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ،ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﺿﺮﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ .ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻦ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﺑﻴ ﹺ
: altruism ١ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ،ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻲ .ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻧﮕﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻔ ﹺﻊ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي – (٣٠٧ﻡ ٢ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍﻥ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺳﻬﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ – ﻡ Burnstein & Crandall & Kitayama ٣ ١٩٩
١٩٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﮏ ﺧﻮﺩ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻮﺭي ﻭ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﺰﺩﻳ ِ ﻞ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻮﺧﺘﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ٣ﻧﻔﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﻣﺤﺒﻮﺱ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﻧﺠﺎﺕ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ(. ﺖ ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶﹺ ﺑﺮﻧﺸﺘﺎﻳﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ( ١٩٩٤ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ، ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﭘﺴﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﻮﮎ -ﻭﻳﺘﺎﻝ ﻭ ﻣﮏ ﮔﻮﺍﻳﺮ) ١ ،( ١٩٨٥ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻲ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻬﻲ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ .ﺯﻧﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻒ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺩﻓﻌﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍﻥ ( ٥ﻳﺎ ٦ﺑﺮﺍﺑ ﹺﺮ ﺩﻓﻌﺎﺗﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺑﺮﺍﺩﺭ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻞ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ( .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻤﻨﺪ ﺗﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺮﻫﺎ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﻤﮏ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻤﻨﺪ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ
Essock-Vitale ١ﻭ McGuire ٢٠٠
٢٠٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻭ ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻟﻤﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .١ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ، ﻣﺸﮑﻼﺗﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺮﺍﺩﺭﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺮﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟ ِﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﺯﻧﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻧﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻢ ﺁﻣﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻁ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻦ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ،ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪي ﻭ ﺁﺷﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺩﺍﮔﻲ ٢ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
-٣ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ : ﺗﺎ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ي ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ، ﺖ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻪ " ﺧﻴﺎﻧ ِ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺩ " ﺩﺭﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺩ ِ ﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺼﻞ ( ١٣ ﭘﺸﺘﻴﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ
ﻂ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﻲ ﺧﻴﺎﻧﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎ ،ﻫﺮﻳﺲ ،( ٢٠٠٢) ٣ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺁﺷﻔﺘﻪ ﻭ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ.
ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ؟ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﺎ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ١ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ﺑﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﺯ ﺷﺎﻳﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺎﻫﺪ ،ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻃ ﹺ ﻞ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ي ﻳﮏ ﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻞ ﻧﻴﺎي ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ،ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺎﻭﻧﺪي ﺍﺳﺖ :ﺍﮔﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻧﺴﻞ ﺳﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺷﺘﺮﺍﮎِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﻣﺨﺰ ِﻥ ﮊﻧﻲ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺵ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺭﺥ ﻲ ﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﺩﺭ ﻣﺨﺰ ِﻥ ﮊﻧﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﻞ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﺵ ،ﺳﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺷﺨﺼ ﹺ ﻞ ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪ ي ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺩﺍﺩ ،ﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭ ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٥ Familiarity ٢ Harris ٣ ٢٠١
٢٠١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
-٤ﺗﺮﺱ : ﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺢ ﺗﺮﺱ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ي ﺩﻳﺪﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑ ﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺰﻳﻨﻪﻪ ي ﺑﻲ ﺧﻄﻄﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﭼﻴ ﹺﺰ ﻦ ﮏ ﻋﻨﻮﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﻨﺪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻬﺎي ﺧ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺮ ﮎ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻌﺎ ً ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻖ ﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻲ ﺧﻄﻄﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﺟ ﮔﺮﻓﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺱ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻴﺰﻫﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺎﺭﻫﺎﺎ ( ﮐﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺯﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺗﺮﺱ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﻢ. ﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺴﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺪ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ي ﺗﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠ ﹺ ﮎ ﻣﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻲ ﻓﻄﺮي « ١ﻣﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ .ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ » ﺁﻣﺎﺩﮔ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺭﻭﺍ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ، ﺶ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺯﻧﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﺮﮐﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻂ ﺗﻮﻣﺎﺭﮐﻦ ،،ﻣﻴﻨﮑﺎ ﻭ ﮐﮐﻮﮎ ( ١٩٨٨٩ ) ٢ﻪ ﺿﻮﻉ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣﻮﺿ ﻲﺀ ) ...ﻼ ﻼﻳﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺷﻲ ﺀ ﺗﺮﺳﻨﺎﮎ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺎﺭ ،ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺕ ( ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺷﻲ ﺍﺳﻼ ﻣﺜﻼً ﻳﮏ ﮔﻞ ،ﻗﺎﺭﭺ ( ﻧﺸﺎﺎﻥ ﺻﺪﺍ ﭘﺨﺶ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮎ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ ،ﮔﺎﺎﻫﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺻ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺍﺳﻼﻳﺪ ،ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺷﻮ ِ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻮﺩ (.ﺷﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﺭﮎ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻥ ﺷﺪ ﻭ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﭼﻴﻴﺰي ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻧﻤﻤﻲ ﺷﺪ ) .ﻓﻓﺮﮐﺎﻧﺲ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﺗﺮﺳﻨﻨﺎﮎ ﺑﺎ ﮎ ﺷﻮﮎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﻳﮏ ﺳﻮﻡ ) ( % ٣٣ﺗﺼ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺎ ﻦ ﻗﻀﺎﻭﺕ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮﺍﻧﻪ «٣ﺑﻮﺩ :ﺭ ﺕِ ﻳﮏ » ﮏ ﮎ ﺗﺮﺳﻨﺎﮎ ﮔﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺑﻴﻦ ٤٢ﺗﺎ % ٥٢٢ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻊ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺼﺎﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻫﻤﺮﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺷﺮﮐﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺗﺗﺮﺳﻨﺎﮎ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺗﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮﺮي ﻲ ﻼﻑ ﺑﻴﻦ % ٤٢ﻭ % ٥٢ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺷﻮﮎ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ! ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﺖ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ .( % ٣٣ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ) ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ
ﺧﺎﺹ. ﺻﻔﺖ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺹ ﺁﻣﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﻮﻮﺭﻭﺛﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻳﺎ ﺖ ﻲ ي" : : predﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ،ﺁﺁﻣﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﻓﻄﺮي dispositionn ١ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ " ﻞ Tomarkken , Minek ka & Cook ٢ Covarriation biass ٣ ٢٠٢
٢٠٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ،( ١٩٨٩ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺶ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺗﻮﻣﺎﺭﮐﻦ ﻭ ﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺪ ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ﺖ ﺐ ﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ِ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺟﺮﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮑﻞﹺ ﺶ ﺍﺳﻼﻳﺪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﭘﺮﺮﻳ ﹺﺰ ﻧﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﺭ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻲ ﺑﺮﻕ ﻲﹺ ﻳ ﺻﺪ ﺷﻮﮎ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ ،ﺩﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭﺻ ﺷﻮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺩ ﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﮎ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺳﻮﮔﻴﺮي covariattion biassﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺭﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﭼﻴﺰﺰﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﮑﻲ ﮎ ﺷﻮﮎ ﺗﺮﺱ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺱ ﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻧﺘﻴﺠ ِ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪﺪﻩ ﺧﻄﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻴﻴﻦ ﺍﻭﺍﺧﺮ ﻪ ﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻄﺮﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺭﺑﻂ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪ ١ﺗﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻄ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻣﻠ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻫﻤﺨﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺎ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﺳ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺮ ﻕ ( .ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﺖ ﺑﺮﻕ ﺍﻧﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﭘﺮﻳﻳﺰ ﻟﺨ ِ ﺩﺍﻧﺪ. ﺕ ﺯﻧﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺭﻭﺯﻣﻣﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﺢ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﮔﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﺎﻣﻲ ﺗﺮﺱ ﻫﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺻﺮﻓﺎً ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺿ
ﺶ ﻭﺍﺍﺳﻮﻥ : ﺁﺯﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﻨﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﺘﻲ ﻲ ﺗﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﻳﮏ ﻞ ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺣﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﻭ ﺁﻣﺎﺩﺩﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻏﻠﺒﺒﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻮﻧﻪ ﺵ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻣﻲ ﭘﻨﺪﺍﺭﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ – ﭘﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﻗﺎﺕ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺎﻣﭙﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺗﺸﺒﺒﻴﻪ ﻲ ﮑﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻮﻧﻪ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﺸﮑ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺖ ﮐﺎﻣﭙﻴﻮﺗﺮﻫﺎ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻲ ﺮ ﺵ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﺷﺒﻴ ِﻪ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺳﻴ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﺘ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎ ﻞ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺣ ﹺ ﺦ ﺗﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ي ﻦ ﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺯﮔﺎﺭﺭي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺣﺣﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻬ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺧﺧﺘﺼﺎﺹ ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ.٢ ﺖ : associationﺗﺪﺍﻋﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﺪ a n١ ﺖ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳ ِ ﻳ ﺴﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﻌﻄﺎﻑ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺗﺮ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘ ﻑ ﻲ ،ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩي ٢ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ؛ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻭ ﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ،ﻋﻘﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﺗﮑ ﺎ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﺋﻠﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻤﺘﺮﺮي ﺑﺮﺍي ﻥ ﻞ ﺩﻟﺨﻮﺍﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺴﺖ. ﻗﺎﺑﻞﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺷﺷﮑ ﹺ ٢٠٣
٢٠٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﺶ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ ،١ﺑﻪ ﻭﺿﻮﺡ ﻣﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ. ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﻥ ﺕ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺧ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻭ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻔﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻲ ﻣﺪ ﹺﻝ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻢ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ .(١٩٦٨ﺍﺑﺘﺘﺪﺍ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺗﻔﺴﺴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﮐﺎﺭﺭﺕ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻥ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ،ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﮐﮐﺖ ﺶ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ A ،K ،٦ ،٩ .ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻑ ﺕ ي ﻑ ﮐﺎﺭﺕ ﺣﺮ ِ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ :ﺍﮔﺮ ﻳﮏ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺩﻳﮕ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺎﺎﺭﺕ ﻋﺪﺩ ٦ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺳﭙﭙﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺷﺮﮐﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺎﺑﺎ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻦ ﺩﺩﻭ Kﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻑِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ .ﺍﮐﮐﺜﺮ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺑﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻮﻉ ﮐﺎﺭﺭﺕ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺖ ﺏ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺟﻮﺍﺏ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ % ١٠ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺁﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺏ ﮐﺎﺭﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ٦ﻭ Kﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺮﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﹺ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻴﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ي Kﻭ ٩ﺑﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻥ ﻦ ﮐﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮐﺮﺩﺩﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻗﻊ ﺖ ﺍﺑﻄﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻮﻥ ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕِ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺴﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺑﻄﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻠﻠﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻤﻤﺮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺕ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺭﻧﺪ. ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﻔﺴﺴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ : ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺷﻮﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﻳﺎﻓﺘﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻻ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺗﻔﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺐ ﺍﺑﻄﻄﺎﻝ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺷﮑﮑﺴﺘ ﹺ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺑﻴﺎﻧﺪﻳﺸﻨﺪ. ﻦ ﻥ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﮑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﮐﻮﺯﺯﻣﺎﻳﺪﺯ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻮﺑﻲ ( ١٩٩٢ ٢ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻋﻠﺖ ﺍﻳﻨﮑ ﻥِ ﻲ ) ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ % ١٠ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﺪﻩ ﻣﻮﻓﻖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺳﺳﺦ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻨﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻃﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ١ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻣﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻨﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻻﻝ ﻞ ﺧﻮﻳﻳﺶ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﻪ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻳﮏ ﺣﻘﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺮﺍﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺁﻧﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺩﺭﺻ ِﺪ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﻼ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﮏ ﺶ ﻣﺸﻬﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻭ The Wason Sellection Tasskﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ :Wasonn ١ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ Cosmidees , Tooby ٢ ٢٠٤
٢٠٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﺗﻘﻠﺐ ﻭ ﺣﻘﻘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺖِ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻲ ﺦ ﻲ ﺗﺗﺎﺭﻳ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻃ ﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺧ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺽ ﻧﻔﻊ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺖ ﭼﻴﻴﺰﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭ ﻔﻊ ﺖ .ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ي ﻋﻮﺽ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺳﻮﺩي ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭي ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ. ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ ﻪ ﻲﹺ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﮐﻮﺯﻣﺎﻳﺪﺯ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺑﻲ ﺶ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺪ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻘﻠﺐ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﺪ ﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺍﻓﺮﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﻧ ﻲ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺷﻨﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﺐ ﻒ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺭﺳﺘ ﹺ ﺁﻥ ﮐﺸ ِ ﺶ ﺍﺑﺪﺍﻋﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﻬﺎ، ﺶ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﻥ ﻣﺤ ﺗﻐﻴﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻴ ﺣﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﺮﺁﻳﻳﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻨﻲ ﻞ ﺤﮏ ﺯﺩﻧﺪ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺖ ﭘﻴﺸﺨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮏ ﺖ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﻲ ﺷﺮﮐﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﮔﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺖ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻗﺎﻧﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﺑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺸ ِ ﺺ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ٢١ﺳﺎﺎﻝ ﻦ ﺷﺷﺨ ﹺ ﮑﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺁﺁﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺳ ﹺ ﺨﺼﻲ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻧﻧﻮﺷﺎﺑﻪ ي ﺍﻟﮑ ﺭﺍ ﺁﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ :ﺍﮔﺮ ﺷﺨ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﻧﻔﺮ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺷﺷﺎﺑﻪ ي ﻲ ﺪ ﻀﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ٤ " .ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﺣﻀ ﻭ ﺎﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺖ ﹺ ﺺ ٢٥ﺳﺎﻟﻟﻪ. ﺷﺨﺺ ﺺ ١٦ﺳﺎﻟﻪ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻝ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻳﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺷﺎﺑﻪ ي ﻏﻴﺮﺍﻟﮑﻠﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻳﻳﮏ ﺷﺨ ﹺ ﹺﻝ ﻧﻔﺮ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺗﻘﺮﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﺭﺳﺖ ﺣﻞ ﮐﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺍﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﺩﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻮﻥ ،ﺩﻭ ﺖِ ﻓﺮﺩِ ١٦ﺳﺎﻟﻪ ،ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ١٦ﺳﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻧﺘﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﻧﺪ .ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻪ ﻧﻮﺷﺷﺎﺑﻪ ي ﻲ ﺗﺤ ِ ﻼﺵ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻣﺤﺘﻤﻤﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻼ ﻦ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﺭ ﺖ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺷﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺤ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﻠﺐ ﮐﻨﺪﺪ. ﻲ ﻲ ﻧﻮﺷﺷﻴﺪﻧ ﹺ
٢٠٥
٢٠٥
٢٠٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﺍﺭﺯﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ : ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻲ 9ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻳﺪﻩ ي ﭼﺘﺮ ﻣﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻠﻠﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺳﺨﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ).ﺩي ﻭﺍﻝ ﻩ
١
(٢٠٠٢ ي ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻧﻈﺮ ِﹺ ﺎ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﭼﻨﻨﺪﻳﻦ 9ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻓﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻳ ﮎ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ 9ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪ ﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺮ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮﺮي ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺎ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺢ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺍﻣﺎﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻴ 8ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﻫﺮ ﭼﻴﺰﺰي ﺭﺍ ﻞ ﭼﻨﺪﺍﺍﻥ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﺪﻩ ﺍي. ﺏﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺩﺭ ﻨﻪ ﻒ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻫﺎي ﮓ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻲ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺶ ﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺑﻴ ﹺ 8ﻫﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻦ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﺗﻮﺟ ِﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﺪﺍﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻴﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻉﹺ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺟﻨﻨﺲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺎ ﮏ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﻳ ﺕ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺒﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻦ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺱ ) ( ١٩٨٩٩ﻧﺸﺎﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ي ﺩ ﻓﺮﻫﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﻓﺮﻫﻫﻨﮓ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﺷﺶ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺟﻨﺴﻴﺖ ﺖ ﮏﺟ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﺷﺮﻳ ِ ﺏﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺭ ﺑﺎﻧﺪ ( ١٩٩٨ ) ﺍﺳﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺪ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺿﺎﻓﻪ ﻗﺪﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻪ ﻭ ﮐﻤ ﺕ ﺧﻮﻮﻳﺶ ي ﺿﻴﺤﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿ 8ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺭﺩ. ﺕ ﺩﻳﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭﺭﻩ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻣﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﻲ ﻦﹺ ﻭﺍﻝ ( ٢٠٠٢ﺑﻪﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﺩي ﻝ ﺪ
de Waal ١ ٢٠٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺏ ﺟﻔﺖ، ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻓﺪﺍﮐﺎﺭﺍﻧﻪ ) ﻧﻮﻉ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﻲ ( ،ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ ﻭ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻳﺐ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺣﻘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ، ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺣﺪﺱ ﻭ ﮔﻤﺎﻧﻪ ﺯﻧﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ.
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ: ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺎﺯﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻫﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺳﺎﺯ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ] [١ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺽ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺏ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻓﺮ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺎﺯ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﺒﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺘﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻧﻴﺎﮐﺎﻥِ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﺗﺮ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻣﻴﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﺷﻴﺮﻳﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺳﺎﺯ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﻭﺭﺍﺛﺘﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﻠﻘﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ،ﻭﺍﻧﮕﻬﻲ ﺑﺸﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺖ ﻧﻴﺎﮐﺎﻥِ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﻴﻮﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻣﺰﻩ ي ﺷﻴﺮﻳﻦ ﻞ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭ ﺑﺨ ِ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺯﺵﹺ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮي ﻫﻢ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻟﺬﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺍ ﹺﻡ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺳﻴﻤﻮﻧﺰ ( ١٩٩٢ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻫﻴﻠﮕﺎﺭﺩ – ﺟﻠﺪ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢
٢٠٧
٢٠٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
] [٢ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮔِﺸﺘﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ١٩٢٠ﻣﻄﺮﺡ ﺷﺪ .ﻭﺟﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ي ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﺍﻧﺪﮎ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺮﮎ –ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻖ ﺷﻬﻮﺩ ،ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ،ﺣﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﻤﺎ ِﻣﺎﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ،ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ،ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ،ﻭ ﻗﻀﺎﻭﺕ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺍﺷﮑﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﻭ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﻞ ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺒﺎﺣﺚ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺏ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﻧﻘﻼ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٤
] : assumption [٣ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ،ﻓﺮﺽ ← ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ) ( hypothesisﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ: ي ﻳﮏ ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ :ﻓﺮﺽ ﻳﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﺩﺭ ﺣﮑ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺻﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﺩ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ :ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﻲ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺿﻴﻪ ،ﻧﺨﺴﺘﻴﻦ ﮔﺎﻡ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺸﮑﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ – .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ﻒ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻑ ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﺪ " ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ " ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﮑﺮي ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ، ﻓﺮﺽ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻴﻔﻴﺖ ﻭ ﮐﻤﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ – .ﻡ
٢٠٨
٢٠٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
] [٤ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎ ،ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ " ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻞ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ " .ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﺴﻠﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻫﺎ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺧﺎﻃﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺯﻳﻢ ،ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻗﺼﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻔﺎﻫﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻧﮕﺎ ِﻫﺨﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ٢٠ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻘﺐ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﻳﺪ .ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺮﻩ ي ﺧﺎﮐﻲ ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﺎﻥ ﻓﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ٩٩.٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﻴﺎ ِ ﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺳﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﻌﻤﻴﻢ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ – ﻡ ] [٥ﺑﺪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺷﻨﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺁﺷﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ، ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﺘﻘﺪﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺍﻥ ﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ » ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺮﻧﻮﺷﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺭﻗﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻨﺪ « .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺗﻌﺒﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﻣﻮﮐﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﺍﺑﺮﺍﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ » ﻋﺮﻭﺳﮏ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻫﺎي « ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺣﺎﻝ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻲ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭼﻴ ﹺﺰ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺶ ﻭﺍﻗﻌ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﻮﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺴ ﹺ ي ﺐ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ،ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻫﺎﻣﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﭘﻠﻨﺪ ( ١٩٩٤ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﭖ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٤٢ ﭼﺎ ﹺ
ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺐ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮐﺪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﮐﻪ
٢٠٩
٢٠٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ
ﻲ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ،ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻳ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ﻭ ﺗﮑﻮﻳ ﹺ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﭖ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ – ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺮﺑﺰ ﻭ ﺩﻳﻮﻳﺲ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﻮﻟﻮﮊ ﹺ ي ٢٨٤
eﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺖ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻋﻤﺪﻩ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ : ﺡ ﺑﻲ ﻫﻤﺘﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ. .١ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩي ﺑﻲ ﻫﻤﺘﺎﺳﺖ .ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺵ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﻲ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ :ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻌﻨ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻭ ﻭ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺁﻧﻘﺪﺭ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺁﻧﻘﺪﺭ ﺗﻔﺎﻭِﺗﺎﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﭼﻴﺰي ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﭘﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﮐﺎﻣﻼ ً ﺑﻲ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻴﻬﻮﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺪ ،ﻏﺮﻭ ﹺﺭ ﮐﺎﺫﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺞ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ي ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺭﻭي ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﮐﺸﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﻲ ﺭﻭﻳﻪ ي ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﮔﻦ ( ١٩٧٣ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﭘﻴﺮﻭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻏﺎﻓﻠﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﮐﻴﻔﻲ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺍﺕ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺁﻧﻬﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ﻧﻴﺎﺯﻣﻨ ِﺪ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ.
) ﺍﻗﺘﺒﺎﺱ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏِ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﻴﺎﺑﺎﻧﮕﺮﺩ –
ﻧﺸﺮ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻩ ﺷﺎﻫﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٨
ﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ .٢ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﻳﮑﻲ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻟﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻧﻌﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻌﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﻏﺎﻓﻠﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯي ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻪ ي
٢١٠
٢١٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﭘﻨﺠﻢ ﻣﺒ
ﻞ ﻓﺮﻫﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎﻳﻳﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻫﻫﻤﻪ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻪ ي ﺍﻭ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﺍﺍﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ. ﺧﺎﺳﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺯﻳﺴﺴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻠﻲ ﺍﺵ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺴﺘﻲ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺧ ﺖ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ﮐﻨﻮﻧﻲ ﻣﻣﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﮐﺸﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺸﮑﻲ ﺭﺍﻧﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓ ِ ﹺ ﺶ ﺑﺸﺮ ،ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺶ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﻭﺯ ﺪ ﺑﻌﺪي ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻃﻲ ﻭ ﺗﮏ ي ﺩﻳﺪﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﻓﺮﺍﻃﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺮ ﮑﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺪﺍً ﺖ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻟﻲ ﻣﻴﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ ﻭ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﮑﺮ ﮐﻤﺘﺘﺮ ﻣﺤﻘﻘﻲ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﺍﺟﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺮﻭي ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺁﻥ ﻓﺮﺮﺍ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﺯﻳﺴﺴﺖ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻫﻲ ي ﻝ ي ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺗﮏ ﺑﻌﺪي ،ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺍﻓﻓﺮﺍﻃﻲ ﻭ ﮏ ﺏ ﮏ ﺑﺮﮔﮔﺰﻳﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺁﺁﺳﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺩﻭ ﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ -ﻡ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻢ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮﺣﻲ ﻭﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻧﻪ ﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺮﺍ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ ﻭ ﺑﺪ
٢١١
٢١١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ( ١
٢١٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
٢١٣
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ :
ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ٢١٢ ..................................................................................... ( ١ ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ ٢١٣ .................................................................................................. : ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ :ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢١٦ ...................................................................... ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ٢٢٠ ....................................................... ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝﹺ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ٢٢٨ ....................................................................................................... : ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢٣٢ ............................................................................................ : ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢٤٠ ........................................................... ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ٢٤١ .................................................................................................:
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﻳﺴﺘﻲ ،ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﮓ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮓ ﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪ. ﻫﺎي ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑ ﻲ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ،ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎﺕ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺶ ي ﺱ ﺗﻤﺎﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻭﻥ ﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺘ ﻂ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺳ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺳﺎﺯﺯي ﻭ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺑﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺭﻳﺰﺰ .ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻲ
ﻋﺼﺒﻲ : ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ } ﺷﺷﻤﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻠﺴﺴﻪ ي ﺭﺳﻤﻲﹺ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺲ ﺷﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﻮ ﺖ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭ ﻧﺸﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﺪ ﻭ ﺭﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺷﺮﮐ ِ ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﮐ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﻟ ِﺪ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﺘﺎﻥ ﭼﭼﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻫﺴﺘﻴﺪ ﻪ ﻉ ﮑﺮ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﻓﮑ ﹺﺮ ﺷﻤﻤﺎ ﺟﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺮﻳﺴﺖ .ﺷﻤﺎ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻓﮑ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻼﻥ ﻫﺪﻳﻳﻪ ﺍي ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﻳﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺯ ﺼﻮﺻﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻓﻲ ﺁﺭﺯﺯﻭ ﻣﻲ ﻣﻮﺳﺳﺴﻪ ي ﺧﺼ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻬﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻧﺪﻫﻴﻴﺪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﻴﺪ ﺷﮑﻤﺘﺎﻥ ﻫﺮ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺁﺯﺍﺭﺭﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻥ ﺻﺪﺪﺍي ﺲ ﺷﺮﮐﺖ ﺭﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺻﺪﺍي ﻣﻣﺒﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﻥ ﺷﻨﻮﻮﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺷﺷﻤﺎ ﺳﻮﺍﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺳﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﺐ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺻﺪﺪﺍي ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠ ﹺ ﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻴﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻮﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻋﺎﺩي ﻣﻲ ﺗﭙﺪ .ﺗﻼ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ي ﺭ ﻑ ﭼﻨﺪﺪ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﻣﻮﻮﻓﻖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﻳﺪ ﺑﺮ ﺗﻤﺮﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻭ ﻇﺮ ِ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺿﺎﻉ ﻣﺴﻠﻂ ﺷﺷﻮﻳﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻋﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺲ ﺍﻭﺿ ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻣﻴﺪﻭﺍﺭﻳﺪ ﮐﮐﺴﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺣﻮﺍﺱ ﭘﺮﺗ ﹺ ﺧﺒﺮ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺷﺪ... ﻣﺨﺘﺘﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺑﺎﺧ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺍﺩﺍﺭﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻂ ﺳﻴﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣ
٢١٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻮﻑ ١ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﺴﺖ ﺭﻭﺱ ،ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻒ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﭼﺎﺭﻟﺰ ﺷﺮﻳﻨﮕﺘﻮﻥ ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺭﺍ » ﻋﻤﻞ ﻭﺣﺪﺕ ﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺑﺨﺸﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي « ﻣﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻮﻑ ﺑﺮ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺴﻤﺘﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎﻩ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺗﺎﮐﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻮﻑ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ،ﻧﻪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻔﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺑﺤﺎﻝ ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﺪﺗﺎً ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻦ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﺶ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ. ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﻴ ﹺ
ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻒ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﻃﺮ ﹺﺯ ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢﹺ ﻃﺮﺯﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩِ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺵ ،ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻂ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻂ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﮔﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﻧﻴﺎﺯﻣﻨﺪي ﻫﺎﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻂ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻲ ﺧﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﺪ{ .٣ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ (١٩٣٦ -١٨٤٩ ) Ivan Pavlov ١ ٢ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ » ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ« ﺍﺛﺮ ﻡ .ﮎ .ﻓﻮﺭﺕ ) ،( M. K. Forthﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻓﺮﻫﺎﺩ ﻧﻌﻤﺎﻧﻲ ،ﻣﻨﻮﭼﻬﺮ ﺳﻨﺎﺟﻴﺎﻥ – ﺳﻬﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻴﺒﻲ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٢١ Charles Sherrington ٣
٢١٥
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺼﺒﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ :ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻴﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺷﻤﺎ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺎﻥ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺪ ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍي ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ « ٢ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻥ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً » ﺎ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻝ ﻲ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ١٥ﺗﺎ ٢٠ﺑﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ١ﺳﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﺒﻲ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ { .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﮐﺎﺭ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻮﺩ }.ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻔﻪ ي ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻡ ﺩ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ (. ﮑﻲ ٣ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) ﺷﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑ ﻖ ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ
١ﺑﻴﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ :ﺑﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﺎﺩ ﹺﻝ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﺎﺭﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ ←.ﺑﻴﻠﻴﻮﻮﻥ = ﻣﻴﻠﻴﺎﺭﺩ = ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ : neuronn ٢ﻧﻮﺭﺭﻭﻥ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺳﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺳﺳﺖ .ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻳﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ. : electricall impulsess ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻃﻃﻮﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﻣﻔﻔﺼﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ « ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻲ ﻫﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺑﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ » ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺗﻲ ﻭ ﮐﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺩﻫﻴ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﮑﻪ ﺖ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﻳﮑ ﹺ ﺠﺎ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻧﻮﻮﺭﻭﻥ. ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ « ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺟﺎﺑﺠ ﻲ ﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻭ » ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻧﺎﮔﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻭﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺮﹺ
٢١٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺕ ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺷﺘﺮﺍﮎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :
ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ١ﻳﺎ ﺗﻨﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ : ٢ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﮑﻲ ِ ٣ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ. ﻦ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ : ٤ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺖ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.٥ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﺖ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﹺ ﻦ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ : ٦ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
cell body ١ soma ٢ ﺏ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ،ﺩﻓ ﹺﻊ : metabolic ٣ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﮑﻲ ،ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺬ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﺍﺋﺪ ﻭ.... ﺡ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ي ﻳﻮﻧﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺩﺭﺧﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺩﺭﺧﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : dendrite ٤ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﺹ ( ٤٢ ﺕ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺢ ﭘﺬﻳﺮﺍي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ٥ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺎ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻖ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١١١ ﻑ ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. : axon ٦ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻟﻮﻟﻪ ي ﺑﺎﺭﻳﮏ ﻭ ﺑﻠﻨﺪي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻨﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮ ِ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺎﻗ ِﺪ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭﺵ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﮏ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (٢٧ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳ ِ
٢١٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺰﺍﺭ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻓﺮﺳﺘﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﻗﺎﺑِﻠﺘﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺻﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﺗﺮ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﻣﺴﺎﻓ ِ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.١
ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : .١ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ : ٢ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ٣ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻧﻮﺭ ،ﺍﻣﻮﺍﺝ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ ،ﻟﻤﺲ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ( ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺖ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﺍي ﻭ ﻳﺎ .٢ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ : ٤ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻏﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ .٣ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺭﺍﺑﻂ : ٥ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺣﺪﺱ ﺯﺩ ،ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻂ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺭﻭﺩي ٦ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﺑ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﺑﻔﺮﺳﺘﻨﺪ. ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺜﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ )ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ( ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﻣﻲ ﻓﺮﺳﺘﺪ ﻭ ﺁﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
: e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١ :sensory neurons ٢ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ : e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ][٢ : e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣ motor neurons ٤ interneurons neurons ٥ input ٦
٢١٨
٢١٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻠﻴﺎ
١
ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ٢ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ١/١٠ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﺕ ﺖ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻫﺮ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﻧﻘﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﻒ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻇﺎﻳ ِ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ : ﮒ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. .١ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺯﺍﺋﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺮ ِ ﻂ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺟﺬﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. .٢ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺖ : Glia ١ Size ٢ Shors Reeves Tanapat Beylin Gould ٢ Gage Kempermann & Van Praag ٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﻮﻳﺪ : ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﺝ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ،ﺫﺭﺍﺕ ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺍﺭي ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻳﻮﻥ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻳﻮﻥ ١ﻫﺎ :ﻫﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .٢ﻣﺜﻼً ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ) ( Naﻳﮏ ﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﮐﻠﺮ ) ( Clﻳﮏ ﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﻅ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺗﺮ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ : ٣ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ٤ﺍﺣﺎﻃﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﺭﻭ ِﺩ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺟﺎﺯﻩ ي ﻭﺭﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺟﺎﺯﻩ ي ﻭﺭﻭﺩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻭ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﺎﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺗﻮﺯﻳﻊ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﺑﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻭ ﺧﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺝ ﻧﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺑﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻭ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.١
Ions ١ : e ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ membrane potential ٣ membrance ٤
٢٢٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺖ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ٢ﺑﻪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ » ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ « ٣ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻞ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ -٧٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ ٤ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ٧٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﺮﻭ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ.٥
◄ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻻﻳﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻟﻴﭙﻴﺪي ) ﭼﺮﺑﻲ ( ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻨﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻻﺑﻼي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﻻﻳﻪ ﺟﺎﺳﺎﺯي ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺪﺍﺭﻩ ي ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ،ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻳﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﭽﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏِ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٤١
ﻦ ﺝ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺎﻳ ﹺﻊ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺩ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﺭ ﹺ ١ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺩ ،ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ .ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺖ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ. ٢ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ : resting potential ٣ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﺶ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻞ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ .ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺣﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﺁﺭﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﺖ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺭﺁﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺁﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺰﻭﺩي ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺻ ِ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺗﻴﺮ ﻭ ﮐﻤﺎﻥ ﺗﺸﺒﻴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ :ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮐﻤﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﮐﻨﺪ.ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺗﮋي ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ،ﺹ ( ٦٠ ٤ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ = ﻳﮏ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﻡ ﻭﻟﺖ : e ٥ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥
٢٢١
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﺧﺒﺮ ﺷﺪ. ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺎﺕ ،ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﻬﻬﺘﺮ ﻣﻲ ﻥ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺮ ﻞ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻫﻴﭻ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﻲ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻴ ﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺗﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺿ ﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻭﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) ﺷﻠﻴﻴﮏ ١ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ ( ،ﻪ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺤ ﻘﺎ
ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮔﮔﺮﺩﺩ ؟ ﭼﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺑﺎﻋﻋﺚ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺟﺴﻢ ﺩﺍﻍ ﺖ ﺷﻤﺎ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻢﹺ ﮕﺸ ِ ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺍﻧﮕ ﺽ ﺑﺮﺧﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﻧﻮﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻄﺢ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺣﺴﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻨﮑ ﮑﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻠﻴﻴ ِ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻴﻒ ﺗﺮ ﺪ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﺪ ﺢ ﻭﻭﻟﺘﺎﮊي ﮐﻪ ﻻﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﮏِ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﮔﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﺮ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳﮏ، ﭽﻪ ﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻭﻥ ﭼﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ؟ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽ ﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .٢ﻣﻤﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺁﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤ ﺁﺳﺘﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻳﮏ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ -٧٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﻟﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﻭﻭﺩ -٦٥ﻲ ﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻧﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺗﺤ ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ ﻭ ﻳﻳﺎ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﻴﻴﺮ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﺴﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺪ
ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ،ﺗﺨﻠﻴﻴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ : firingg ١ﮏ ﺢ ﻗﻞ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻪ ﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺭﺍﻩ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯي ﻳﮏ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺍﺻ ﻭﻟﺘﺎﮊي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻩ ي ٢ﺁﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻳﮏ :ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﻳﻨﺪ : e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٦٦
٢٢٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻞ ﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺷﻠﻴ ِ ﻋﻤﻞ ١ﺩﺭ ﻗﻠﻪ ي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ .٢ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ١ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﺯ -٦٥ mVﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ + ٥٠ mVﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ – ٧٠ mVﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺵ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
ﺣﻴﻦ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﭼﻪ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ؟ ﺣﻴﻦ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ،ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻟﻬﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺷﺪﻥ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎ ،ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﺯ -٦٥ mVﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ + ٥٠ mVﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ،ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻋﺎﺩي ﺑﺮﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﺒﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﺯ +٥٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍ ً ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ -٧٠ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﻭ ﻭﺿﻌﻴﺖ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ .ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺝ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺟﺎﺑﺠﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
ﻞ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ : action potential ١ﺑﻪ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ،ﺑﻪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﻫﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻝ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺖ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.ﺑﻪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (١٥٢ : axon hillock ٢ﻗﻠﻪ ي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ،ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ :ﺑﻪ ﻧﻘﻄﻪ ﺍي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ) . ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١١١
٢٢٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﻢ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻴﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺑﺎ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ. ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﺍﺻﻮﻻً ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎ ﹺﺭ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ – ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﺴﻴﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﻢ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ – ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﺎي ﺿﻌﻴﻔﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻘﻄﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻏﺸﺎ ،ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍ ً ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻠﻲ ﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .١ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻠﻪ ي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻳﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﺸﻮﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ،ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻏﺸﺎي ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺯﺩﻩ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻳﻮﻧﻲ ﻏﺸﺎي ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﺸﻮﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺒﺎﺩ ﹺﻝ ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ( ؛ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻳﻮﻧﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ) ٢ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﺝ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ،ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ » ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻗﺪﺭ ﻧﻴﺮﻭﻣﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻏﺎﺯ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.٣
١ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﺹ ٦٧ﻭ ٦٩ ٢ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ – ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ ﺹ ٤٢ ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﺷﺒﻴ ِﻪ ﺣﺎﻟﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺘﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻨﻔﺠﺮﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮐﺒﺮﻳﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﺘﻌﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺷﻌﻠﻪ ﻭﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٥٢
٢٢٤
٢٢٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺑﻲ ﭘﺎﺳﺨﻲ ﻣﻄﻠﻖ : ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻧﺎﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍ ً ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺷﺮﻭ ﹺﻉ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً » ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺑﻲ ﭘﺎﺳﺨﻲ ﻣﻄﻠﻖ « ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ }.ﻣﻲ ﮏ ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ﻣﻘﺎﻭﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺯﻣﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﻞ ﻓﻮﺕ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺗﺸﺒﻴﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﺑﺎﺭ ﻓﻮﺕ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻧﻔﺲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻦ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻓﻮﺕ ﻳﮏ ﻭﻗﻔﻪ ي ﺗﻨﻔﺴﻲ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺑﮑﺸﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﻓﻮﺕ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻓﻮﺕ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ{.
ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﺁﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻟﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻘﺎﻁ ﭘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﭘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻣﺘﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﮐﺴﻮﻥ ،ﻣﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻲ ) ﺳﺮﻋﺖِ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ( ،ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻂ ﭘﻮﺷﺸﻲ ) ﻏﻼﻓﻲ ( ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺲ ﻳﮏ ﭼﺮﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﭘﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ. ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨ ﹺ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﻦ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺮﻩ ي ﺭﺍﻧﻮﻳﻪ ﻑ ﻣﻴﻠﻴ ﹺ ﭘﻮﺷﺸﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺩﺭ ﻏﻼ ِ
١
ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺮﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﻩ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻬﺶ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺣﺮﮐ ِ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺑﺎ ٨٠ﺗﺎ ١٠٠ﻣﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ٢ﺗﺎ ٣ﻣﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.
nodes of ranvier ١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﻳﺪ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﭼﻪ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻓﺘﺪ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺍﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ١ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﻗﺒﻞ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ( ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ( ﺑﻪ ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ).ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ،ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.
ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭﺵ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ٣ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ(
terminal buttons ١ :neurotransmitter ٢ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ .ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺭﺍ ﻋﺼﺐ –ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ–. ﻡ : synaps ٣ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺹ ( ٤٣
٢٢٦
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺁﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﻴﺮ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ي ﻲ ﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻨﮕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻲ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﺯ ﮏ ﻂ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﺑﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﮏ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ٢ﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ١ﻭ ﺑﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ،ﻭ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﺎﭘﺲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻧﻮﺭﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴ ﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ. ﺪ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺻ
pre synap ptic neuronn ١ post synap ptic neuronn ٢
٢٢٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ : ﻖ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ ،ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﭘﻴﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺐ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ) ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﺳﺎﺯي ( ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ. .١ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺐ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ) ﻣﻬﺎ ﹺﺭ( ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ. .٢ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ
ﻖ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ي ﺁﻥ ،ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭﺵ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺐ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ،ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺶ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻳﺎ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ: ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻞ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻑ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ِ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ( ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ) ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﺲ ﺳﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ( ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻑ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻞ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ِ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ ( ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺷﻠﻴ ِ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ) ﻣﻬﺎﺭ( ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .١ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ(
١ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏِ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٤ -٢٦-٢٥ -٣٢
٢٢٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻳﮏ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ،ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺁﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺮﺁﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻖ ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﺳﺪ ،ﻃﺒﻴﻌﺘﺎً ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺷﻠﻴﮑﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ.١
ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺭﺳﺎﻝ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻼً ﭘﻴﺎﻣﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻑ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻃﻮﺭي ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻮﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻝ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻲ ﻞ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﮐﺜﺮﺍًﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﺤ ﹺ ﻞ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﹺ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤ ﹺ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺒﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﻭ ﹺﻉ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.٢
١ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ) ( Excitatory post synaptic potential =Epspﻭ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ) = Ipsp ( Inhibitory post synaptic potentialﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ : e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٧ ﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎً ﺖ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎً ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ٢ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٧٢
٢٢٩
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﻣﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻴﻦ ﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺍ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﻣﺨ ﺮﹺ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺶ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻴﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ( .ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ١٠ﻧﻮﻉ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﺩ ﻞ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻭ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺩﺳﺖ ﮐﻢ ٥ﻮﻉ ﺖ ِ ِ ﮎ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﻣﻮﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺭﮎ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻧﻴﻢ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻠﻴﺪ ﻭ ﮔﻴﺮﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻠﻴﺪ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻗﻗﻔﻞ ﺗﺸﺒﻴﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻗﻔﻞ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﻗﻗﻔﻞ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ، ﻞ ﮏ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﺍﻧﺪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻦ ﻝ ﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﻳﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﺒﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﮐﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ : ﻞ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻧﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻳﻮﻮﻧﻲ ) ١ﺗﺼﻮﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ .١ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ( :ﻳﻦ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ٢
ﻞ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎي G .٢ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺼﻞ
:ﺍﻳﻦ
ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﻴﺮ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺩﻭﻡ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺕ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻮ ﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﻣﺘﻔﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺧﺼﻮﺻ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺷﺎﻥ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ).ﭘﻴﻨﻴﻨﻞ (١٩٩٧ ي ﺑﻴﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻭ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺮ ﻡ ﺩﻭﻡ ،ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎ ﹺﺭ ﮔﺴﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺍﻣﺎﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺮﻋﺘﻲ ﺁﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﺗﺮ ،ﻣﺎﻧﺪﮔﺎﺭ ﹺ
Ion –chaannel linked d receptorss ١ G – prootein linked d receptorss ٢
٢٣٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﭙﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﭼﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ؟ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺩﻭ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﻣﺪ ِ ي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ : ١ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ .١ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ ﻞ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ .٢ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ي ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻤﻲ : ٢ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎ ﺗﮑﻪ ﺗﮑﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ. ﻂ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ
: re –uptake ١ﺑﺎﺯ ﺟﺬﺏ ٢ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺎﺗﺎﻟﻴﺰﻭﺭ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﻲ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺼﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ، ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺴﻬﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮏ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﭼﺴﺒﺎﻧﻨﺪ ،ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺷﮑﺴﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﻧﺪ ).ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ( ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳ ِ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٢٦-٢٥
٢٣١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ: ١ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ٦ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : .١ﻧﻮﺭﻭﭘﭙﺘﻴﺪ ﻫﺎ : ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺰﺭﮔﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ: ﺖ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ : ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺳﻴ ِ ﻫﺎ ٤ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺧﻮ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﻓﺮﺳﺘﻨﺪ. ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﻭﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ : ٥ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﭘﭙﺘﻴﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺏ ﺩﺭﺩ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺧﻴﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻟﺬﺕ ﻭ ﺳﺮﮐﻮ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ،ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﻭﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ي ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﹺ .٢ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻫﺎ :ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺁﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ GABA ،ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ٧ﺩﺭ ﮔﺎﺑﺎ ) : ( ٦GABAﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ CNSﻣﺤﺼﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣﺎﺕ : ٨ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. neurotransmitters ١ neuropeptides ٢ neuromodulators ٣ signals ٤ endorphins ٥ gamma – aminobutyric acid ٦ : inhibitor ٧ﻣﻬﺎﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ،ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ glutamate ٨
٢٣٢
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺁﻣﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ :ﻣﻮﻧﻮﻮﺁﻣﻴﻦ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : .٣ﻣﻮﻧﻮ ﻦ ﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺻﻮﻻ ً ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻣﻴﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮏ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ : ١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻪ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﭘﺎﺭﮐﻴﻨﺴﻮﻮﻥ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺴﻢ ﺳﺳﻴﺎﻩ ٢ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺯﻭﺍﻝﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺁﺯﺍﺩﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻒ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺎﺭي ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻴﻦ : ٣ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺩﺭ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﺒﻲ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﺮ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺕ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻒ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﻭ ﺱ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﻋﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻞ(٥ ﻓﺼ ﹺ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﺼ ﺶ ﻲ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ : ٤ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕ ﮕﻲ ،ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﻭ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﺧﻮ ٥ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻴﻦ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻴﻦ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺪ ﻲ يﺍ ﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ dopaminee ١ substtantia nigraa ٢ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ،ﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ﻦ ٣ﻪ serotoninn ٤ ﺧﻠﻖ ،ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ،ﻭﺿ ﹺﻊ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻔﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺋﻢ ﻳﺎ ﻣﻮﻗﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺎﻳﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺷﺎﺩي ﻳﺎ ﻏﻢ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ– ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : moodd ٥ﻖ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ (
٢٣٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
.٤ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻞ ﮐﻮﻟﻴﻦ : ١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ : ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي :ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻞ ﮐﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺩﺭﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺗﻬﻴﻴﺞ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻬﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻠﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻞ ﮐﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ :ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻞ ﮐﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺭﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺶ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘ ﹺ
.٥ﭘﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ : ٢ﺩﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﭘﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﺖ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﺁﺩﻧﻮﺯﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺁﺩﻧﻮﺯﻳﻦ : ٣ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻞ ﮐﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺁﺩﻧﻮﺯﻳﻦ ﺗﺮي ﻓﺴﻔﺎﺕ ATP : (ATP ) ٤ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺭﺳﺎﻧﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺑﻪ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ .٦ﮔﺎﺯﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻠﻮﻝ : ٥ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ﺩﻳﺮﺗﺮ ﮐﺸﻒ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ،ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻧﻮﮐﺴﻴ ِﺪ ﮐﺮﺑﻦ ﻭ ﺍﮐﺴﻴ ِﺪ ﻧﻴﺘﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﺎﺯﻫﺎ ﻣﺪ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺭﺳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺛﺎﻧﻮﻳﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. acetylcholine ١ purines ٢ adenosine ٣ adenosine triphosphate ٤ soluble gases ٥
٢٣٤
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺖ ﺗﻨﻮﻉ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭ ﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻉﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﻳﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ ﻫﻤﻪ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲ ﻭ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻪ ﺻﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺪ ﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻮﻉ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ي ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺻ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﭙﺮﺮﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻟﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﻪ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺁﺩﺩﻣﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔ ﹺ ﮔ ﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺩﻟﻴﻞﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ﭘﻴﭽ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔ ﹺ ﮔ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻨﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎﺎﻳﺪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﺟﻮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻊ ﺤﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺫﻫﻦ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻘﺎﺀ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻣﻨﺤ
٢٣٥
٢٣٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭼﻪ ﮐﺎﺑﺮﺩي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺕ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺳﻌﻪ ي ﻋﻠ ﹺﻢ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﺳﺎﺯي ﻭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ١ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺗﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ،ﺑﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ : ﻲ ﺩﻟﺨﻮﺍﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ، ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ٢ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ،ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ
٣
ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
: drugs ١ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮﺍً ﻏﻴﺮﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﻣﻮﺍﺩ « ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺩﺍﺭﻭ « ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻟﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » « drugﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻒ ﻣﺘﻦ ﺑﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﻢ. agonists ٢ : antagonists ٣ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺧﻮ ِﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ : ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ .١ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎً ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ( .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﮏ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎ ﹺﺯ ﮐﻠﺮﻭﭘﺮﻭﻣﺎﺯﻳﻦ (
.٢ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺷﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﮎ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ١ PCPA .ﻧﻴﺰ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪPCPA . ي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﺎﺧﺖ ِ ٢ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﻖ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺩﻫﺪ.
ﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺷﺪ.
Para-Chlorophenylalanine ١ : synthesize ٢ﺳﻨﺘﺰ
٢٣٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻞ ٧ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻃﺒﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ) ( ١٩٩٧ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ) ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ: ( . ﺖ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻤﻲ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. .١ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗﺤ ِ .٢ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺯﻳﮑﻮﻝ ١ﻫﺎ ) ﺣﻔﺮﻩ ﻫﺎ ( ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. .٣ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺯﻳﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻂ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ٢ﻫﺎ .٤ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻭﺯﻳﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ي .٥ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺎ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺟﻔﺖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﺿﺎﻓﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ .٦ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻖ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ .٧ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺐ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻤﻲ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ. ﺗﺨﺮﻳ ﹺ
ﻞ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻃﻲ ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺣﺪﺱ ﺯﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎ ،ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ) ٦ ،(١٩٩٧ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ٥ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :
Vesicles ١ ٢ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎ :ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﻔﻌﺎﻻﺕ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
٢٣٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
» ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ « ﺖ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي .١ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ
» ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ« -١ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺎﻧﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ( ١
ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) .ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ي ١ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﮕﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺑﺎﻻ (
ﺢ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي -٢ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺯﻳﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎ )
.٢ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ
ﺣﻔﺮﻩ ﻫﺎ ( ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ( ٣
ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺎﺑﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ( ٣ -٣ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ .٣ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻤﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ
ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺷﺪﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ) ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ( ٥
ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ( ٥ -٤ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ .٤ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ي ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﹺ ﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ( ٧
ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺲ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺎﻧﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ) ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي (٦
٢٣٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻏﺸﺎي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺠﺎﻭﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ) ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩ ( ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺐ ﺁﻥ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ،ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻏﺎ ﹺﺯ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ٦ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻞ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ي ﻫﺎي ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻤﻲ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺩﺍﻧﺶ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺟﻬﺖِ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ
٢٤٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ] [١ﻗﺒﻼً ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ،ﻋﻤﺪﻩ ي ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﮑﺜﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻭﺍﻳﻞ ﺭﺷﺪ ﺟﻨﻴﻨﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺣﻢ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ،ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﻋﻤﺮ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﮐﻨﺪ : .١ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ .٢ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺸﻌﺎﺑﺎﺕِ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺘﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﻗﺪﻳﻤﻲ ﺑﺎ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ،ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﺯﻳﺮ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﺭﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻝ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ،ﺳﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﮐﻨﺪ ! ) ﮔﻮﻟﺪ ،ﺑﻠﻴﻦ ،ﺗﺎﻧﺎﭘﺎﺕ ،ﺭﻳﻮﺯ ﻭ ﺷﻮﺭﺯ )١٩٩٥ﻭ ( ٢٠٠١ﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﺍﮒ ،ﮐﻤﭙﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﻭ ﮔﻴﺞ ) ١٩٩٩ﻭ ( ٢٠٠٢ -ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻴﻠﮕﺎﺭﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٦٢
ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﭘﺮﻳﻨﺴﺘﻮﻥ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﺵ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺪﺍﻭﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻝ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﭘﺪﻳﺪﺁﻳﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ( neurogenesisﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﺮﮔﺎﻩ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺯﺍ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻬﺎﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺑﻴﺎﻣﻮﺯﻧﺪ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺁﺩﻣﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﻣﻲ ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪﺩ ) .ﻫﺎﻟﺲ ﻭ ﻫﺎﻟﺲ .( ١٩٩٩ﻟﻴﮑﻦ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻄﻠﺐ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺑﻪ ﺶ ﺍﻋﻈ ﹺﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟ ِﺪ ﻧﻮﺯﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺨ ﹺ
٢٤١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻞ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ،ﺣﺠ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺜﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺑﺎﻟﻎ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺸﮑﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺍي ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻲ ﺫﻫ ﹺ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻳﺴﺘ ﹺ ﺏ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺧﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ) ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﮐﻮﺩﮐﻲ ( ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺠﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﻦ ﭘﻴﻮﻧﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺗﺤﮑﻴﻢ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﮐﺪﺍﻣﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﻭﻧﺪ. ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي١٢١ – ١٢٠
ﮏ ] [٢ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ) ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ( ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮﺭ ،ﺩﻣﺎ ،ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﮑﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺷﮑﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥِ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ي ﺑﺼﺮي ) ﻣﻴﻠﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺨﺮﻭﻃﻲ ( ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺮﮊ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭي ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﮑﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﻓﺸﺎﺭ ﺑﺮ ﮐﺮﻩ ي ﭼﺸﻢ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻣﺤﺮﮐﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﮎ ﺑﺴﻨﺪﻩ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺣﺴﺎﺳﻴﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﮎ ﺑﺴﻨﺪﻩ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﺍي ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺣﺪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٩٢
٢٤٢
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﺷﺸﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴ
eﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺴﺎﻥ ) ﭼﭼﺸﺎﻳﻲ ،ﻻﻣﺴﺴﻪ ،ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻭ( ... ﺑﺑﻪ ﺍﻭ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺭﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﻮ ﻂ ﻣﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ، ﺑﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﭘﻞ ﻂ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻣﻮﻧﺶ ﺍﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻭ ﺎﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺭﻭﻧﺪ.
ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ. ﻲ ﺑﺪﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮ ] [٣ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﮐﻠﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺣﺴ ﹺ [ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﺑﺮﺩ ﺑﻴﻨﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺩﻭﺭﺑﺮﺩ ﺭﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻣﻬﻤﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻲ .١ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻂِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﺭﺑﺮﺩﺩِ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻨﻮﻮﺍﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻮﻳﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﮐﺮﺩ. ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ .٢ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺎ ﺱ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﺭﺗﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺣﺣﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﺪﻧﻲ ) ﺗﻨﻲ ( ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻫﻠﻴﺰي ) ي ﻋﻀﻼﺕ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺕ ﻞ، ﺣﺲ ﻫﺎﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﺑﻪ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ) ﺑﺴﺎﻭﺍﻳﻲ ،ﻓﺸﺸﺎﺭ ،ﺩﻣﺎ ،ﺩﺭﺭﺩ ( ،ﻣﻔﺎﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ( ﺍﺷﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﮐﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻤﻮﻋﺎً ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻘﻘﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﻲ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﻋﺼﺐ ﺤﻪ ي ١٩٥ - ٢٣٦ ﺻﻔﺤ
٢٤٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻲ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ .ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ،ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑ ﹺ ] [٤ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮ ﹺ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺩﻓﻊ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺭﺍ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻫﻤﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺟﺬﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ،ﻧﻴﺮﻭي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮي ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﻨﺎﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻁ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ي ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ﻧﺨﺴﺘﻴﻦ ﺷﺮ ِ ﺖ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﺩ ﹺ ﺳﻮي ﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺧﺎﺻﻴ ِ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﺴﻴﺘﻪ ،ﻣﺠﺰﺍ ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺑﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻑ ﻅ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻴﺮﻭ ِﻥ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻠﻲ ﭘﺪﻳﺪ ﺁﻳﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٤٩
ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺍﻳﻨﻄﻮﺭ ﺶ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ -٧٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻭﻟﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﺭﺍﻣ ﹺ ] [٥ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﭼﺮﺍ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﭗ ﺳﺪﻳﻢ – ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ « ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺨﺶ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﺑﻪ » ﭘﻤ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻤﭗ ،ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﺮﻭ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﺭﺍ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .".ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻤﭗ ٣ ،ﻳﻮ ِﻥ ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﺭﺍ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻭ ٢ﻳﻮ ِﻥ ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﺭﺍ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺪﻳﻢ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻤﭗ ﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻳﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻲ ﻏﺸﺎﺀ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺟﺮﺍ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑ ﹺ ﭗ ﺳﺪﻳﻢ – ﭘﺘﺎﺳﻴﻢ ،ﻧﻔﻮﺫﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﭘﻤ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻩ ﺷﺎﻫﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي - ٥٨ﻡ
٢٤٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﺷﺸﻢ
ﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﺢ ﻭﻟﺘﺎﮊي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﺍﻩ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯي ﻳﮏ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ] [٦ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ :ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ، ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺗﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﺗﺮي ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ،ﻣﺤﺮﮐﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﻳﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٥٧
] [٧ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺍﻧﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ) ( Excitatory post synaptic potential =Epspﻭ ﺑﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ) ( Inhibitory post synaptic potential = Ipspﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ Epspﻫﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺷﻠﻴﮏِ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ Ipspﻫﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺷﻠﻴﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺵ ﻫﻤﻪ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻣﺠﻤﻮ ﹺﻉ Epspﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺮﺳﺪ ،ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴﻞﹺ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺍﺳ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎ ﺭﻭ ﹺ ﺖ ﻂ Ipspﻫﺎ ﺧﻨﺜﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺕ Epspﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ،ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ Ipspﻫﺎ ﻭ Epspﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ،ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺁﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٧٢ -١٦٦
٢٤٥
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﺼﻞ ﻫﻫﻔﺘﻢ ﻓﺼ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ( ٢ ﻲ ﺳﻴﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ
٢٤٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
٢٤٧
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ :
ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ) ٢٤٦ ...................................................................................... ( ٢ ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ ٢٤٧ ................................................................................................. : ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢٤٨ ........................................................................................................ : ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) ٢٤٩ ................................................................................... : ( CNS ﻣﻐﺰ ٢٤٩ .................................................................................................................... : ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ٢٥٩ ......................................................................................................... : ﻧﺨﺎﻉﹺ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ٢٦٥ .......................................................................................................... : ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲﹺ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ) ٢٦٨ .................................................................................. : ( PNS ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٢٧٣ ..................................................................................... ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ٢٧٤ .................................................................................................:
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻲ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻴﻢ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻢ ﺩﺭﮎ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻭﺭﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﮐ ﹺ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ :
ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ : ﺶ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) : ( ١CNSﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ( ﺶ ﻗﺮﻣﺰ ﺭﻧﮓ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ٢ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ) : ( ٣PNSﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ : ي ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ) ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺕ ﺍﺭﺍﺩ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ : ٤ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ .١ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ( ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺕ ﻏﻴﺮﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ : ١ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ .٢ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻗﻠﺐ ( ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي :ﺁﻥ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺸﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ : Central nerveus system ١ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﻥ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣٠٩ : spinal cord ٢ﺁﻥ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﺘﻮ ِﻥ ﻓﻘﺮﺍﺕ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﺹ .( ٧٨٥ﺩﺭ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻣﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ -ﻡ : peripheral nervous system ٣ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ) ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ( PNS :somatic ٤ﭘﻴﮑﺮي ،ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ – ﻡ
٢٤٨
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﻋﺼﺒﻲِ ﻲ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻢ
ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ
ﺧﻮﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ
ﻋﺼﺒﻲِ ﻲ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي
ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ي ﻲ ﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼ ﻲﹺ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺪﺍ ﺑﻪ
ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) : ( CNS ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﻤﺎﻫﻨﮓ ﻭ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻫﻤﺎ ﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺗﻤﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻞ ﺨﺶ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﮐﺰي ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺨ ﻳﮑﭙﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ .ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ .ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻉﹺ
ﻣﻐﺰ : ﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻣﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺗﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﮔﻲﹺ ﺑﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺖ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻴﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ : ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﺧ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻐﺰﺰ. .١ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻒ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﺘﻠ ِ ﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺶ ﺖ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ .٢ﺷﻨﺎﺧ ِ ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﺮﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺰ ﺗﺎ ﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲﹺ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻐﻐﺰ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺁﺳﺎﺎﻥ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﭼﮕﻮﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﺧﻴﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺪ ِﺩ ﭘﻴﺸﺮﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺗﮑﻨﻮﻟﻮﮊﮊي ﺍﻣﮑﺎ ِﻥ ﻬ ﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺁﻥ ﺖ ﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ﻮ ﻲ ﻖ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﻫﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺣﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻣﻴﺴﺮ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻒ ﺰ ﻖ ﻣﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻨﺎﻃ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑ ﭼﮕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ (. ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻓﻌ : autonomicc ١ﻏﻴﺮﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﻧﻴﺰﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ.
٢٤٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺖ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺧﻴﻠﻲ ﻋﺠﻴﺐ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻧﺎﺕِ ﺣﻔﺎﻇﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺍﺧﺘﺼﺎﺹ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮐﻪ : ﻂ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺣﺎﻃﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. .١ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ .٢ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﻏﺸﺎي ﺣﻔﺎﻇﺘﻲ ﺳﻪ ﻻﻳﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻨﻨﮋ ١ﭘﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻻﻳﻪ ﺳﺨﺖ ﺷﺎﻣﻪ ٢ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻻﻳﻪ ي ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺗﻴﻪ ٣ﻭ ﺳﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻻﻳﻪ ي ﻧﺮﻡ ﺷﺎﻣﻪ ٤ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻓﻀﺎي ﺑﻴﻦ ﻋﻨﮑﺒﻮﺗﻴﻪ ﻭ ﻧﺮﻡ ﺷﺎﻣﻪ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺎﻳﻊ ﻣﻐﺰي -ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ) ٥( CSFﭘﺮ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. .٣ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺪ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ – ﻣﻐﺰي ٦ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺳﺪ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ – ﻣﻐﺰي ﻳﮏ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺣﻔﺎﻇﺘﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺍﺟﺎﺯﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍﻩ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻓ ِ
ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﺑﺨﺶ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ :ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ،ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ) .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﻡ ﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﺑﺮ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻲ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻥ ١ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﺒﻨﺎي ﻣﺤ ﹺ ﻲ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﻎ ﻣﻄﺎﺑﻘﺖ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ (.ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ meninges ١ dura matter ٢ arachnoid membrance ٣ mater pia ٤ ﮎ ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﻤﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻡ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﺳﺮ ،ﻣﺤﺎﻓﻈﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ : cerebrospinal fluid ٥ﻣﺎﻳ ﹺﻊ ﻣﻐﺰي – ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ،ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﺑﺮ ﺷﻮ ِ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺯﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺏ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺸﮑﻲ ،ﻣﺎﻳﻊ ﻣﻐﺰي – ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺷﻨﺎﻭﺭ ﮐﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﻣﻐﺰ ،ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺩﻳﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٤٠ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ – ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳ ِ e blood- brain barrier ٦ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١
٢٥٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ: ( hindbrain ) ٢ ﺖ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳﻤﺶ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺴﻤ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻪ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﭘﺸﺘ ﹺ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :
ﭘﻴﺎ ﹺﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ) ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ( :٣ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺎﺭﻳﮑﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﻻي ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺢ ﺑﺰﺍﻕ}، ﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺗﻨﻔﺲ ،ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺮﺍﻍ ،ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ،ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺣﻴﺎﺗ ﹺ ﺳﺮﻓﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ،ﻋﻄﺴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ{ ٤ﻭ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻠﺒﻲ ﻋﺮﻭﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ﺍي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺑﺮﻋﮑﺲ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳ ِ ﭗ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺶﭼ ﹺ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺁﻥ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي : ٥ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻي ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ي ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺑﻂ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .١ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ي ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍ ً ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ( . : embryo ١ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ) «( fetusﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮيِ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻭﻡ ﺗﺎ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ي ﺭﺷﺪ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻧﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ ِﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺭﺷﺪ ،ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞ ﺟﻨﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﮐﻴﺖ ﺍﻝ .ﻣﻮﺭ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﺮﺿﺎ ﻓﺎﺿﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﺳﻔﻨﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٦ ٢ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ،ﭘﺲ ﻣﻐﺰ : medulla ٣ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ Medulla oblongataﻳﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﻴﺮﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ٤ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺹ ١٣٢ : pons ٥ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي ﺑﺎ » ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي ) ( pontine regionﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﺑﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺭﺟﺎﻳﻲ ﻭ ﺍﮐﺒﺮ ﺻﺎﺭﻣﻲ – ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﻗﺪﺱ ﺭﺿﻮي – ﺹ ( ١٠١
٢٥١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻣﺨﭽﻪ : ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ) ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ( .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﺖ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﻳﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﻫﺪﺍﻳ ِ ي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﺑﭙﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺑﮑﺎﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ،ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻭﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ١٩٩٤ ) ٣ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ٤ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﺪﺍﺭي ﺑﻪ ﺷﻨﻴﺪﺍﺭي ﻭ ﺑﺮ ﻋﮑﺲ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺸﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.
ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي ﻭ ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻫﻢ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ٥ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ،ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ،ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺗﻨﻔﺲ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻗﻠﺒﻲ -ﻋﺮﻭﻗﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ٦ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﮔﺬﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ.
١ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﺑﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١٠٣ cerebellum ٢ Canavan et al ٣ e : Attention ٤ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﻧﻘﺸﻲ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ : reticular formation ٥ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ﺗﺮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﺐ ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ،ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ،ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٢١٨ : consciousness ٦ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ،ﺁﮔﺎﻫﻲ e .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣
٢٥٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ): ( midbrain ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ) ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ( ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﭘﺮﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﺧﺰﻧﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﺩﻭ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻫﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :
ﻲ ﻓﻮﻗﺎﻧﻲ ١ﻭ ﺑﺎﻡ ) : ( tectumﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﻤﺴﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﺤﺘﺎﻧﻲ ٢ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻋﺒﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺕ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﮐﻼﻫﮏ ) : ( tegmentumﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ( .ﺩﺭ )ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻧﺮﻡ ،ﺳﻠﻴﺲ ﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ٣ﻧﻴﺰ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ ﮐﻼﻫﮏ ﻗﺴﻤ ِ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻥ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺤﻠﻴﻞ ) ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ( ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ي ﭘﺎﺭﮐﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ٤ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻨﺮﮊﻳﮏ ﻭ ﺷﺮﻭ ﹺﻉ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ
: superior colliculus ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﮐﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻮﻟﻲ ﻓﻮﻗﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ : inferior colliculus ٢ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﮐﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻮﻟﻲ ﺗﺤﺘﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ substantia nigra ٣ ﺕ ﻲ ﺟﺴﻢ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ ﺐ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠ ﹺ : parkinson ٤ﻳﮏ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺨﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ -ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ – ﻡ
٢٥٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺫﮐ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻥ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ﻭ ﭘﻞ ﻣﻐﺰي ﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ( .ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻨﻔﺲ، ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ » ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻣﻐﺰ « ١ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ) ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﻭ ﮔﻔﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
brainstem ١
٢٥٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ: ( forebrain ) ١ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻲ ﺶ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺳﻄﺢ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻮﺷﺸﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ
٢
ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺣﺎﻃﻪ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ: ﻲ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻻﻳﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻨﮕﺮﻳﺪ ،ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﺪ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﮓ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺧﺎﮐﺴﺘﺮي ﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻻﻳﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ٢ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻤﺘﺮ ﺿﺨﺎﻣﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺭﻧ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺧﺎﮐﺴﺘﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.٣ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﻇﺎﻫﺮي ﻧﺎﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭ ﻭ ﭘﺮﭼﻴﻦ ﻭ ﭼﺮﻭﮎ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﭼﻴﻦ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﮔﻲ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺠ ﹺﻢ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎ ﺢ ﺻﺎﻑ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺣﺪ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﭼﻴﻦ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﺭﻭي ﻳﮏ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﭘﻬﻦ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺑﺎ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺮﺑ ﹺﻊ ٥٠ﺳﺎﻧﺘﻴﻤﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ٥٠ﺳﺎﻧﺘﻴﻤﺘﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﭙﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪ .ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺩﺭ ي ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ،٤ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ،ﺑﮑﺎﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺵ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮ ﹺ ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. e : cerebral cortex ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ ﺖ ﺧﺎﮐﺴﺘﺮي ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻓﺎﻗﺪِ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻓﺎﻗﺪ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ٣ﻋﻠ ِ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﻼ ِ ﻑ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻧﮕﻲ ﺳﻔﻴﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ – ﻡ ﺖ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ -ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ٤ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٢١١
٢٥٥
٢٥٦
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﮕﻲ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﻣﺦ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺎﻫﻫﻤﻮﺍﺭ ﻭ ﭘﺮﭼﻴﻦ ﻭ ﭼﺮﻭﻭﮎ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺮﺁﺁﻣﺪﮔﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻓﺮﻭﺭﻓﺘﮕ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺁﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﻮﻳﺪ : ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻴﻘﻲ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ،ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺎ ﺪ ي
ﮑﻨﺞ ١ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺷﮑ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻴﻦ ﻭ ﭼﺮﻭﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺻ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺑﺮﺟﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ٢ﮔﻔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﻣﺪﮔﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺷﺷﮑﻨﺞ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ،ﺍﺻ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺁﻣﺪ ﮕﺮ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺷﻴﺎﺭ ٣ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ. ﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﻳﮕ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻭﺭﺭﻓﺘﮕﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻳﻳﮏ ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺘﮕ ﮕﺮ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻑ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕ ﻄﻘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﻣﺦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻨﻄ ﮒ ﻭ ﻋﻤﻴﻖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻨﻄﻘ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﺎﺭﺭﻫﺎي ﺑﺰﺭﮒ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻃﻘﻘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻫﺎ ﻗﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺮﻧﺪ ،ﻟﻮﺏ ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ.٥ longitu ﻑ ﻃﻮﻟﻲ ) udinal ﻑ ﻣﻐﺰ ،ﺷﮑﮑﺎ ِ ﺷﮑﺎ ِ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﺎ ( fissuureﺍﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻭﻭ ﻧﻤﻴﮑﺮﻩ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻦ ( .ﺑﺎ ﻪ ﻞ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﭘﻴﻨﻪ ﻖ ﭘﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺟ ﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺪﺍ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻳﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺟﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺍﻧﺪ. ﺍي ٦ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﻪ
:convolutionﺷﮑﻨﺞ c n١ : gyruss ٢ﺑﺮﺟﺴﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺷﻴﺎﺭ : sulcuss ٣ﺭ : fissuree ٤ﺷﮑﺎﺎﻑ ٥ﻧﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ ﮕﺮي ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕ ﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩﻫﻫﺎي ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﭘﻴﻨﻪ ﺍي ،ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻃﻼ : corpus callousumﻳﮑﻲ m٦
٤
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﻫﻢ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻃﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﺮﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻢ ﻑ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﮑﺎﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺯ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺩﻭ ﺷﮑ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺏ ي ﻫﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﺮﻩ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺖ ﭼﭗ ( ﻭ ﻞ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) ١ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻑ ﺷﻮﻧﻧﺪ : ﺖِ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ (. ﺳﻤﺖ ﻞ ﻤ ﮑﺎﻑ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻲ ) ٢ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺷﮑﺎ ﮑﺎﻑ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺳﻄﺢ ﻫﻫﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ٤ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻴﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻟﻮﺏ ٣ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ ) ﺷﮑﻞ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻤﮏ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﻪ ﮏ ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮﺮي. ﻟﻮﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻟﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ ،ﺏﹺ ﺏ ﮔﻴﺠ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﻦ ( :ﻟﻮ ﹺ
( Relando R ﺭﻻﻧﺪﻭ ) ﻭ :centtral fissure ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ centtral sulcusﻳﺎ ﺷﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺁﻥ ﺷﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ. : lateeral fissuree ٢ﺷﻴﺎﺭ ﺟﺎﻧﻧﺒﻲ ← ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺷﮑﺎ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺳﻴﻠﻮﻳﻮﺱ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﺱ ﻑ ﺳﻴﻠﻮﻳﺎﻥ ) ( Silvianﻳﺎ : lobee ٣ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻃﻃﻘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺷﮑﮑﺎﻑ ﻫﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ،ﻟﻮﺏ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮔﺮﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ – ﺹ ١٢١ (
٢٥٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺶ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺪ ِﺩ ﺗﮑﻨﻴﮏ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥِ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﻐﺰي ﺑﻴﺸﺘ ﹺﺮ ﺩﺍﻧ ﹺ ﻂ ﺁﻧﺎﺗﻮﻣﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﻃ ﹺﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺵ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻً ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﺪﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﺻﺪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ » ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ « ١ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺘﺤﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ٤ﻟﻮﺏ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺟﺪﺍﮔﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ : ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﭘﺴﺖ ﺗﺮ ﻣﺘﻤﺎﻳﺰ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺟﻠﻮي ﺳﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻗﺸﺮ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) ﺑﺨﺶ ﻧﺎﺭﻧﺠﻲ ﺭﻧﮓ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ( .ﻗﺸﺮ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻝ ﻋﺎﻟﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺣﻞ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ،ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺪﻻﻝ ﻭ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﻪ ﺭﻳﺰي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺐ ﻗﺸﺮﹺ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺘﺮي ﺳﺖ .ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ % ٩٠ﻗﺸﺮﹺ ﻣﺦ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ،ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﺶ ﻻﻳﻪ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺸﺮﹺ ﻧﻮ ) neocortex ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﻣﮕﺬﺍﺭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮﹺ ﻣﺦ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻋﻠ ِ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺩﻳﺮﺗﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ) ﻧﻮﺭ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺮﮊ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ : information processing ١ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺵ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻳﺎ ﺻﺪﺍ ،ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﮑﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ( ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻮﻥ ﻣﺤﺮﮐﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻖ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺐ ﮐﺪﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻲ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ) ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ( ﻳﮑﭙﺎﺭﭼﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ﻓﺮﺳﺘﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ً ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺵ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺵ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻀﻼﺕ ﻭ ﻏﺪﺩ ﻓﺮﺳﺘﺎﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٨٨
٢٥٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ : ﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ) :( frontal lobe ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﻫﺎي ﺶ ﺟﻠﻮﻳﻲ ﻫﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻟﻮﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ، ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻟﻮﺏ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻟﻮﺏ ﻫﺎ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺧﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻭ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺩ. ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ١ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ،ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ ﻲ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﺟﻠﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ،ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﺑﺰﺭﮔﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﻡ » ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﭘﻴﺶ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ « ٢ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺑﺤﺚ ﻭ ﺟﺪﻝ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺗﺎ ﺁﻧﺠﺎ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩ ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﻪ ﺭﻳﺰي ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ) ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﺳﺎﺯي ﻭ ﺵ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻫﻤﺰﻣﺎﻥ( ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ
motor cortex ١ prefrontal cortex ٢
٢٥٩
٢٦٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ) : ( parietal lobe ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ» ، ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻي ﻫﺮ ﻧﻴﻤﮑﺮﻩ ،ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺖ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﭘﺸ ِ ﻞ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺑﻌﺪ (. ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺣﺴﻲ _ ﺗﻨﻲ « ( somatosensory cortex ) ١ﺍﺳﺖ) ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﺮ ،ﭼﺸﻢ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻧﻈﺎﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺳﭙﺲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴ ِ ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ٢
ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﮔﺮﺍﺱ ﻭ ﮔﺮﺍﺯﻳﻨﻮ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻮﺍﺣ ﹺ .( ١٩٩٥
ﺱ ﺣﺴﻲ -ﺗﻨﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ) ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ( : somatosensory cortex ١ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺣﻮﺍ ﹺ ﻒ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺱ ﺣﺴﻲ-ﺗﻨﻲ ،ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺣﻮﺍ ﹺ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ -ﺗﻨﻲ ،ﮐﺎﻟﺒﺪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ،ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻘﻮﻟﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﮏ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ٤ ،ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻮﺳﺘﻲ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑ ﹺ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ :ﺑﺴﺎﻭﺍﻳﻲ – ﻓﺸﺎﺭ ،ﮔﺮﻣﺎ ،ﺳﺮﻣﺎ ،ﺩﺭﺩ. ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻘﻲ :ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮ ﹺﻉ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺯﺭﺩﭘﻲ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻔﺎﺻﻞ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺩﻫﻠﻴﺰي ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﻤﻘﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺕ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﮔﺮﻭﻩ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ،ﻣﺴﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﻃﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﻲ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻨﺪ ).ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮ ِﻥ ﺯﻳﺮ ﻗﺸﺮي ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻲ -ﺣﺮﮐﺘ ﹺ ﺑﻌﺪ ،ﻗﺸﺮ ﺣﺴﻲ -ﺗﻨﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮏ ﺗﺮ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ) ( .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣٣٣ Graziano & Gross ٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺏ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ ) :( Occipital lobe ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ﻧﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﻟﻮﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻟﻮﺏ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺸ ِ ﺏ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ » ،ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺷﻨﻮﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ) «( Primary Auditory Cortexﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺵ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻲ ﭼﭗ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺏ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ-ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺷ ﹺ ﺚ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ » ﮐﻠﻮﻭﺭ ﺑﻮﺳﻲ « ١ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ،ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺑﺪﻭﻥ ﻫﻴﭽﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﺮﺱ ﻭ ﺩﻟﻬﺮﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
Kluver _ Bucy ١
٢٦١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮي ) : ( Temporal lobe ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﻲ ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮي » ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺐ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮي ،ﺩﺭ ﻋﻘ ﹺ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺚ ﻧﺎﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﺰﺋﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ) « ( Primary Visual Cortexﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺕ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺵ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮي ﺩﺭ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﻒ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ
ﺢ ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺻﺤﺒﺖ ﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬﻢ ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ،ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻭ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ :
٢٦٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
.١ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ : ١ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻣﻴﮕﺪﺍﻝ ،٢ﺩﻳﻮﺍﺭﻩ ،٣ﻫﻴﭙﻮﮐﺎﻣﭗ،٤ ﻲ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ،ﻗﺸﺮ ﮐﻤﺮﺑﻨﺪي ،٥ﻓﻮﺭﻧﻴﮑﺲ ٦ﻭ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻧﮑﻲ ٧ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﻇﻴﻔﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ ،ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ،ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮي ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺑﻲ ٨ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺧﺸﻢ ﻭ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺧﺎﻟﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ.
:limbic system ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎﻩ ﮐﻨﺎﺭي ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ : amygdala ٢ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺎﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ septum ٣ : hippocampus ٤ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳﺐ ﺁﺑﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ cingulate cortex ٥ : fornix ٦ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻃﺎﻕ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ mammillary body ٧ : avoidance behaviour ٨ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺏ ) ﺩﻭﺭي ( ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺊ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺪﻑ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺕ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻭﻳﮕﺮﺩﺍﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ،ﻋﻘﺎﻳﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺑﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺹ ﻧﺎﻣﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻭ ﺁﺯﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻣﻌﺎﺻ ﹺﺮ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺊ ﺧﻮﺍ ﹺ ﻞ ﺁﺗﺶ ،ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺑﻲ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﮐﺸﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ
٢٦٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻲ ﭘﺎﻳﻪ : ١ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺴﻢ ﻣﺨﻄﻂ ،٢ﮔﻠﻮﺑﻮﺱ .٢ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘ ﹺ ﭘﺎﻟﻴﺪﻭﺱ ٣ﻭ ﺁﻣﻴﮕﺪﺍﻝ ) ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻋﻀﻮ ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﻭ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ( .ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘ ﹺ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
.٣ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻳﺴﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺑﺎﻻﺗ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﺖ ﻣﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ، ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻋﻤﻠﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ.
.٤ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ : ٤ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﭼﮑﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳﻤﺶ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ : ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻋﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺸﻨﮕﻲ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺍﻳﻔﺎي ﻧﻘﺶ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ) ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ( .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﺑﺎ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺍﺳﺖ.
basal ganglia motor system ١ striatum ٢ globus pallidus ٣ hypothalamus ٤
٢٦٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ: ١ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) ( CNSﮐﻪ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺁﻥ ﭼﻴﺰي ﻧﮕﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻢ ،ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺴﻤﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻦ ﮐﻤﺮ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ،ﻳﮏ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺎﺭﻳﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻧﺒﺎﻟﭽﻪ ٢ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﻴ ﹺ ﻂ ٢٤ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﻳﺎ ﻗﻄﻌﻪ ي ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﺤﺎﻓﻈﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﺮ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﺁﻥ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺳﻮﺭﺍﺧﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ
: spinal cord ١ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭﻋﺎﻣﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻡ coccyx ٢
٢٦٥
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻗﺮﺍ ﺐ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ِ ٣١ ١ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﻋﺼ ﹺ ﺴ ﮔﺮﻓﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺯ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﻋﺼﺐ ٢ﺩﻭ ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ﺟﺟﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) ﺷﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ( :
ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ي ﭘﺸﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺸﺖ ﻗﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﻫﺎ ،ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ. ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ي ﺷﮑﻤﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻠﻮ ﻗﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﺘﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ،ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰﺰ ﻭ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﻮﮐﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻫﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ﻭ ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. ﻞ ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻗﻠﺐ ( ﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ
ﺏ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻋﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻗﺮﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩﻧﺪﺭﻳﺖ ي ﺏ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨ ﻲ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ١ﺗﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﺳﻠﻮﻟ ﹺ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﻮﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲﹺ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺭ ﺻﻔﺤﺎ ِ ﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺻ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄ ﻞ ﮏ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩﺩ ،ﻋﺼﺐ ﮔﻔﺘﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺗﺸﮑﻴ ﹺ ﺟﺴﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺭ ﺼﺒﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻢ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ : nervee ٢ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠ CNﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ NS ﻳﮏ ﻋﺼﺐ ،ﺑﺮﺧﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﻫﺎ ،ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﺐ ،ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺭﺷﺷﺘﻪ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮔﺮ ِﺩ ﻢ ﻋﺼﺐ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻒ ﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﮑﺎﻧﻪﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ CNSﻪ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ي ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١١٨٨ ﻲ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﮔﺎ ِﻩ
٢٦٦
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
: ( Reflex eﺑﺎﺯﺗﺎﺏ ) x ﮑﻞ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ : ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﮎ ﺩﺩﺭﺩ ﻣﻌﺮﺽ ﻣﺤـﺮ ِ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻭﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺽ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻲ .١ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺳﺒﺒﺰ ﺭﻧﮓ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻲ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲِ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺣﺴﺴـﻲ ﻲ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺟﺴﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺣﺴﻲ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻑِ ﻥِ ﻖ ﺁﺁﮐﺴﻮ ِﻥ ﺁﻭﺭ ) ﺷﻌﻌﻠﻪ ي ﺷﻤﻊ ( ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺷﺪﻧﺪﺪ ،ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﺍﺭﺳﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺮﺩﺩ. ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺨ ﮐـﻪ ﻧـﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻗﺮﻣﻣـﺰ ﺭﻧـﮓ ) ﻧــﻮﺭ ِﻥ ﺭﺍﺑـﻂ ( ﺭﺍ ﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣــﻲ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪ ﻪ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻭ ِﻥ ﺣﺴﻲ ،ﺍ .٢ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ي ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺁﮐﮐﺴﻮ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﺎﻳﺎﺑﺪ. ﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻡ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪﻪ ،ﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﻧﻮﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺭﺍﺑﻂ ﺰ .٣ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ،ﺗﮑﻤﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺁﺯﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺗﺎ ﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺁﺑﻲ ﺭﻧﮓ ) ﻧـﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ. ﺖ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ( ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎﻳﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﺁﮐﺴﻮ ِﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮي ﻋﻀ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻳﮏ ﺐ ﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻖﹺ .٤ﺁﮐﺴﻮﻥ ﻧﻧﻮﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﻀﻠﻪ ﻣـﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ .ﻫﻨﮕـﺎﻣﻲ ﮐــﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻧـﻮﺭﻭﻥ ،ﻣـﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘــﺎﻝ ﺖ ﺩﺳـ ِ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻋﻀـﻼﻧﻲ ﻣﻣﻨﻘـﺒﺾ ﺷـﺪﻩﻩ ،ﻭ ﻓـﺮﺩ ـ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻀﻼﺕ ﺁﺯﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﺮﺩ ،ﻮ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺷﮑﺎﻑ ﺳﻴﻨﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺭ ﮎ ﺩﺭﺩﺩﺯﺍ ) ﺷﻌﻠﻪ ي ﺷﻤﻊ ( ﺩﻭﺭ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺯ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﺎً ﻳﮏ » ﺑﺎﺯﺗﺎﺏ « ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻦ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ :ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏِ ﮐﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٣
٢٦٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ. ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻴﻢ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﻧﻮﺑﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ: ( PNS ) ١ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺟﺰﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ }.ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ{. ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ
ﺐ ﺟﻤﺠﻤﻪ ﺍي ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺐ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ١٢ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ٣١ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ١ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥
٢٦٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻂ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻦ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻞ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ : ١ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺍﻥ : ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ) ﭼﺸﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﮔﻮﺵ .١ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ﻭ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ ( ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺏ ﻭﺍﺑﺮﺍﻥ : ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ .٢ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ )ﭼﺸﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﮔﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﮑﻠﺘﻲ ﻭ ﭘﻮﺳﺖ( ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. ﻂ ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻂ ﺩﺭﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺏ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻈﻴ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻞ ﻞ ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ،ﻏﺪ ِﺩ .....ﻭ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ( ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ،ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ﻫﺎ ،ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﻧﺎﻣﻨﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺭﺍ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﻫﻀﻢ ( .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻞ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻏﻴﺮﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﻭ ﺧﻮﺩﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺖ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺵ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻣﺎ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻧﻴﺎﺯي ﺑﻪ ﺗﻼ ﹺ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻭﺭﺍﻥ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ،ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ .١ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﺏ ﻭﺍﺑﺮﺍﻥ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﺼﺎﺏ ،ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ .٢ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. : somatic nervous system ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﭘﻴﮑﺮي ﻳﺎ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ : Afferent ٢ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ – ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺹ – ٤٥ﻡ : Efferent ٣ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﻻﺕ ﺹ – ٤٥ﻡ
٢٦٩
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻭ ي ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺼﺒ ﻋﻼﺭﻏ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺟﺪﺍ ﮐﮐﺮﺩﻳﻢ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺯ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﻋﺼﺐ ﻫﺎﺎي ﮕﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺜﺮﹺ ﻋﻤﻼ ً ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕ ﻼ ( CNﺑﺮﻧﺎﺎﻣﻪ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﻮﮐﻲ ) NS ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺭﻳﺰﺰي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﻧﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﺎﻃﺎﺗﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺒ ﻖ ١٢ﺟﻔﺖ ﺼﺐ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺯ ﻣﺮﮐﮐﺰي ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻋﺼﺐﹺ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﻠ ﹺ ي ﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺣﺎﻝ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺠﻤﻪ ﺍي ﻭﺟ ﺟﻤﺠ ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﹺ ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻧﻲ ﺁﺷﻨﺎ ﺷﺪﺪﻳﻢ ،ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺧﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺒ ﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻋﺼ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢﻢ. ﻑ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ
ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺗﻘﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﻲﺧ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺳﻤﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺟﺎﻧﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﺝ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻢﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ : ١ﺍﻫﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻣﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻭ ﺎﻳﺎ ﮔﺮﻳﺰ ( .ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺒ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻣﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻲ ﮏ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﺪﺪﻩ ،ﮔﺸﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺶ ﺖِ ﺶ ﺿﺮﺑﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﮐﺎﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺚ ﺍﻓﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ،ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮏ ﻁ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﮏ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺒﺴﺎ ِ ﻧﺎﻳﮋﻩ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺷﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻥ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ : ٢ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺣﻔﻆ ﻭ ﺶ ﺶ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ، ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺚ ﻫ ﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮏ ﻲ ﭘﺎ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻓﺘﺪ .ﺘ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ي ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺳﺳﺖ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻫﺎي ﺷﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻲ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻧﺎﻳﮋﻩ ي ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ،ﺗﻨﮓ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﮏ ﻭ ﻣﻨﻘﺒﺾ ﺪ
Sympathhetic nervo ous system m١ Paarasympathhetic nervo ous system m ٢
٢٧٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺏ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻫﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎ ً ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺧﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﮐﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ( ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ) ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻭ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺖ ﻫﺮ ﮐﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺧﻠ ﹺ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻭ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺣﺪﺱ ﺯﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ، ﻑ ﺟﻬ ِ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻼ ِ ﺁﺗﮑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ،ﺍﺳﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻢ ) ( ١٩٩٣ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ :
ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﺱ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﺳﻨﺎﮎ :ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﺳﻴﺪﻩ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺨﻠﻴﻪ ي ﻏﻴﺮﺍﺭﺍﺩي ﺩﺭ ﻣﺜﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻭﺩﻩ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ :ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻌﻮﻅ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺖ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺰﺍﻝ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ
ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ،ﺑﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﻫﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺑﮕﺬﺭﻳﻢ ،ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺢ ﺖ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟﻲ ﻭ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺖ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ ﻭ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻥِ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺟﻬ ِ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻧﺮﻣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
٢٧١
ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧ ﺖ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ
ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ
ﭘﻞِ ﻣﻣﻐﺰي
ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ
ﺨﭽﻪ ﻣﺨ
ﺑﺮﺟﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻓﻮﻗﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺎﻡ ﺑﺮﺟﺟﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺗﺤﺘﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻼﻫﮏ
ﻣﻐﺰ
ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﺘﻢِ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﮐﺎﻣﭗ
ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻣﻮﺱ
ﻓﻮﺭﻧﻴﮑﺲ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﻴﮏ
ﻋﺼﺒﻲِﻣﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻣﻐﺰِ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ
ﺟﺴﻢِ ﺳﻠﻮﻮﻟﻲِ ﺁﻣﻣﻴﮕﺪﺍﻝ ) ﺑﺎﺩﺍﻣﻪ (
ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻪ
ﺼﺐِ 31ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ
ﺨﺎﻉِ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﻧﺨ
ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ
ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺮ
ﻲ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ
ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﺗﻨﻲ ﮏ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢِ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﮏ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲِ 1ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼﺐ 12 ﺟﻤﺠﻪ ﺍي 3ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼﺐ 31 ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ
ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻮﻧﻲ
٢٧٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ) ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺶ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻴﺎﻫﺎ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﺨﺎ ﹺﻉ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ( ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﻧﺨﺎﻉ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ،ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻭ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ. ﻞ ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ) ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﻭ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ( ﻭ ﺑﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﺎﻉ ) ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻨﻔﺲ، ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﺑﺰﺍﻕ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻗﻠﺒﻲ ﻋﺮﻭﻗﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ( ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺎﻡ ﻭ ﮐﻼﻫﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺭﻳﺸﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ، ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ي ﭘﺎﺭﮐﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻞ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺎﻩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻗﺸﺮ ﻧﻮ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧ ﹺ ﺏ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ ) ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ٤ﻟﻮﺏ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ :ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺵ ﺣﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻻﻣﺴﻪ (، ﻞ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺏ ﺁﻫﻴﺎﻧﻪ ) ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻭ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ،ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺐ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺵ ﺯﺑﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺟﻮﺍﻧ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ﺏ ﮔﻴﺠﮕﺎﻫﻲ ) ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻟﻮ ﹺ ﺵ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ( . ﺏ ﭘﺲ ﺳﺮي ) ﺗﺨﺼﺺ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯ ﹺ ( ﻭ ﻟﻮ ﹺ
٢٧٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻞ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻭ ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ، ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺸﻨﮕﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻳﺴﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻣﻮﻗﺘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻂ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺕ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻨﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻗﺴﻤ ِ ﻂ ﺩﺭﻭﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺧﻮﺩﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﻭ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻭﻟﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﺩﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺯﺍ ( ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺩﻭﻣﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﺩﺭﮔﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ي ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.
٢٧٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ي ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﻋﺒﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ] [١ﺳﺪ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ – ﻣﻐﺰي ﻧﻔﻮﺫﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺪ ﻧﻔﻮﺫﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ .ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ،ﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﻣﺨﭽﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺟﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺮﺍﻍ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺳ ِﺪ ﺧﻮﻧﻲ – ﻣﻐﺰي ﺵ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺳﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﮔﺮﺩ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﻩ ،ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺮﺍﻍ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﮔﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺪﺍﺭ ﺧﻮﺵ ﺷﺎﻧﺲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺐ ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ،ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺳﻤﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﮑﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺁﺳﻴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏِ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﮋﻫﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻏﺰﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢
] [٢ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻫﺮ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺭﺍ ﺁﮔﺎﻫﺎﻧﻪ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺵ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺏ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻭ ﻞ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ،ﻗﺎﺑﻠﻴ ِ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻦ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺨﺺ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺱ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ،ﺑﻪ ﻧﺤ ﹺﻮ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺒﻮﻩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺣﻮﺍ ﹺ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺣﺴﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻤﺒﺎﺭﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺻﺮﻓﺎً ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩي ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﺗﻨﺨﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٩٤
ﺖ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻳﮏ ﺺ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻋ ِ ] [٣ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺷﺨ ﹺ ي ﺍﻭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻦ ﻳﮏ ﺿﺮﺑﻪ ي ﭘﻨﺎﻟﺘﻲ ( ،ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ي ﺍﻭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﺕ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺕ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺵ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﺪ ،ﺷﺪ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺻﻨﺪﻟﻲ ﻟﻢ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺡ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻬﻮﺷﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻤﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ،ﺳﻄﻮ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ -ﻡ
٢٧٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ٧
ﺡ » ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ « ،ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ » ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ « ﻭ » ﮐﺮﺗﮑﺲ ﻣﺦ « ﻧﻴﺰ ] [٤ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﺘﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﭼﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻣﺦ ﻭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﻣﺦ « ) ( cerebrumﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » ﻣﺨﭽﻪ « ) ( cerebellumﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﮔﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ :ﻣﺦ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻻي ﺳﻄﺢ ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺮﺍ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ ).ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺑﻲ ﮔﺮﺍﻫﺎﻡ -ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي .( ١١٩ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ » ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ « ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺧﺎﮐﺴﺘﺮي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻄﺢ ﻣﺦ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻮﺷﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻤﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ » ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﺦ « ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ » ﻗﺸﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ « ﺍﺳﺖ – .ﻡ ﺐ ﺐ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ١٢ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ٣١ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ] [٥ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻤﺠﻤﻪ ﺍي ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﻟ ﹺ ﺕ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ: ﺻﻔﺤﺎ ِ ﺐ ﺐ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ٣١ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ﻫﺮ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ﻧﺨﺎﻋﻲ ٨ ،ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺮﺩﻥ ١٢ ،ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻗﻔﺴﻪ ي ﺳﻴﻨﻪ ٥ ،ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ي ﮐﻤﺮ، ٥ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺧﺎﺟﻲ ﻭ ﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﺒﺎﻟﻴﭽﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺕ ﻦ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﻮﻳﮋﻩ ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻣﻐﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺐ ﺟﻤﺠﻤﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺍﮐ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺎﻳﻴ ﹺ ١٢ﺟﻔﺖ ﻋﺼ ﹺ ﺣﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺎﻡ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﭼﺸﻢ ﻫﺎ ،ﮔﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻫﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ١١٨ -١٢٠ -١٢١
٢٧٦
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺼﻞ ﻫﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻓﺼ ﺗﺎﺛﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ
٢٧٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
٢٧٨
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ :
ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ :ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ٢٧٧ ....................................................................... ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﻔﺘﻢ ٢٧٨ ................................................................................................: ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ٢٨٢ ........................................................................................... : ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ٢٨٧ ....................................................................................................... : ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ٢٩٢ ........................................................................................... : ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ٢٩٧ ................................................................................................... : ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ) ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ( ﻭ ﺣﺸﻴﺶ ٣٠٤ ............................................................................... : ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ٣١٠ .................................................................................................... : ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ٣١٥ ............................................................................................................... : ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ٣١٨ ....................................................................................... ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ٣١٩ .......................................................................................... : ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ ﺵ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ٣٢٣ ............................................................................................ : ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ ٣٣٠ ....................................................................................................:
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﺰﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﻧﻮﻮﻉ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﻭ ﻣﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻪ ﺻﺪﺪﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺪ ﻧﻮﻧ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻗﺎﻧﻮ ﺎ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻮﻧﻲ )ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﮐﮐﺴﺘﺎﺯي ،ﻫﺮﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ( ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﻨﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﻫـﺎ ﺷـﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧـﻲ ﺯ ﺍﺳـﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣـﻲ ﺩ ﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﺮﺩ ﹺﻡ ﺟﻬــﺎﻥ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻔـﺮ ﺯ ﻥ ﻂ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺗﻮ ﭼـﺎي، ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ي ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ( ،ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ ) ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪﻧﻲ ﻲ ﮑﻞ ،١ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻴﻦ ) ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﺖ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﺍﻟﮑ ﺍﺷـﮑﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺎ ﮐـﻪ ﺑـﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎﻳﻲ ﺧـﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﭘﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧـﺖ ﮐـ ﻲ ﺨﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﺳﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﻗﻬﻮﻮﻩ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺷﺎﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩﺩ ( ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨ ﺼـﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻣﺨﺮﺑـﻲ ﺑـﺮ ﺳﻴﺴـﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼ ﺍ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺘ ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐـﺰﺰي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﻐﺰ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﮐﺎﺎﺭﮐﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺮﺑﻨـﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﻧﻧﺘﻘـﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﺪﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻬﺘﺮ ﻣﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢِ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ. ﮎ ﺣﺣﺴﻲ ( ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻤﮏ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ( ﻭ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ) ﻼ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ .ﺑـﺮﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧـﻪ ﻣﻣـﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺑـﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺜﺒﺘﺘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺩ ﺍﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺪ ﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﻫـﺎ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻲ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﻫﺎي ﻲ ي ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻋﻼﺋ ﹺﻢ ﻲ ﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﺿﺪﺪ ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺿ ِﺪ ﺍﺿ ﻭ ﻣﻮ ﮔﻴﺮﺮﺩ(.
ﻧﻴﺴﺖ. ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﮑﻞ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﺖ ١ﺍﻟﻟﺒﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺸﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ
٢٧٩
٢٨٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﺑﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺗﺤ ِ ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ .١ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ .٢ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.
ﺕ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩي ﺑﺮ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﻭﺿـﻮﺡ ﺩﺭ ﻣـﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨـﻲ ) ﻧﻈﻴـﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎي ﺿـﺪ ﺍﺿـﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎي ﺿـﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺟﻬﺖِ ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﻒ ﻭﺳـﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ ( ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎ ﻭ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻃﻴـ ِ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻧﺘﻮﺍﻧﺴﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﻢ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﺑﺴﺎﺯﻳﻢ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻋﻤﻠﮑـﺮ ِﺩ ﺽ ﺟﺎﻧﺒ ﹺ ﻋﻮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﮐﺎﻣﻼً ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳـﺎﻥ ﺗﻮﺟـ ِﻪ ﻭﻳـﮋﻩ ﺍي ﺑـﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﮔـﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ
١
ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ٢ﺭﺍ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪ .ﺑـﻪ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺑﺎﺯ ﺖ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﻫﻢ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺷﺒﺎﻫ ِ
psychoactive drugs ١ : mental ٢ﻋﻘﻠﻲ ،ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺣﻲ :ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ ).ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ (
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
( ١٩٩٥ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥﻥ ﻣـﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﮔـﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﺳـﻪ ﺩﺳـﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠــﻲ ١ ي ﻫﺎﻣﻴﻠﺘﺘﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺗﻴﻤﻮﻧﺰ) ١ ﺱ ﻃﺒﻘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻘﺴﺴﻴﻢ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ : ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺎﻋــﺚ ﻑ ﻦ ﺼـﺮ ِ .١ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺳﺎﺯﻫﺎ : ٢ﻣﺼ ﺖ ﺁﺭﺭﺍﻣﺶ ﻭ ﺧـﻮﻮﺍﺏ ﺁﻟـﻮﺩﮔﮔﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺩ ﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺣﺎً ﮔﻔﺘـﻪ ﻣﻣـﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ٣
ﺑﺨـﺶ ﺍﺕ ﺁﺭﺍﻡ ﺶ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺛـﺮ ﺕِ
ﺳﺎﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﻦ ﻣﻮﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺪ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺭﺑﻴﺘﻮﺭﺍﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻩ ﻞ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺴـﺎﺱ ﺱﹺ ﺶ ﺑﺰﻧﮕﻲ ٥ﺭﺍ ﺖ ﻫﺸﻴﺎﺭي ﻭ ﮔﮔﻮﺵ ﻲ ﺼﺮ ِ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎ : ٤ﻣﺼ ﮎ ﻑ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ .٢ ﺁﻣﻔﺘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ، ﻦ ﻦ ﻣﻮﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑــﻪ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺍﻃﻤﻴﻨﻨﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻔﺲ ٦ﻓﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻴﻦ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺮﺩ. ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨـﻲ ﺷـﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧــﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳﻔﺎﺕ ِ ٢ﻭ ﺗﺗﻮﻫﻤـﺎ ِ ﻑ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﻪ ﺼﺮ ِ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍﻫﺎ : ١ﻣﺼ .٣ﻢ ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ،ﻣﻣـﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑــﻪ LSDﻭ PCPﺍﺷـﺎﺭﺭﻩ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ٣ﺭﻭﺍﻥﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﺎﻧﻪ ٤ﺍﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ.
T Timmons & Hamiltonn ١ Depressants D s٢ stimulantss ٣ sedativee ٤ ﻅ ﻟﺤﺎ ِ ﻲ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » «conssciousnessﻧﻴﺰ » ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي « ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺩﻭ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺎ : alertnesss ٥ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺎﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮﻧﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ) . ﺍﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﺙ ﭘﻴﺮ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﻧﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺀ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻳﻳﻲ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻫﻮﺷﺷﻴﺎﺭي ﺑﻪ ي ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩﺩ ( confidencee ٦
٢٨١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻟﻴﺴـﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎ ﻭ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻟﻴﺴ ِ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ) ٥ﻣﺜﻼً ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ،ﻣﺮﻓﻴﻦ ( ﻧﺎﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻧﺸﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮐﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ.
hallucinogens ١ ﻞ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲِ ﺁﻥ : distortions ٢ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻒ ،ﻣﺴﺦ ﺷﺪﮔﻲ ،ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﺯي .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﭘﻴﭽﺶ ﻭ ﮐﺸﺶ ﮐﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺷﺊ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ي ﻭﺭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺶ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( : symptoms ٣ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻪ ﻳﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﻳﺎ ﺍﺧﻼﻟﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( : psychotic ٤ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﺎﻧﻪ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺶ :ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺮﻳﺸﻲ ) ( psychosisﺍﺳﺖ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( :opiates ٥ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ) ( opiumﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ) ﻣﺸﺘﻖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ( .ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺕ ﻣﻔﺼﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺷﺪ. ﺑﻌﺪي ،ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎ ِ
٢٨٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ: ١ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ٢ﻭ ﺑﺎﺭﺑﻴﺘﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐـﺮﺩ. ﻂ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎ ﻧﻔـﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺗﻤﺮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﻌﻄﻮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺯﺍﻧﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﹺﺯ ﮏ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻻ ،ﺷﻠﻴ ِ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ) ( ١٩٩٧ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ : ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼـﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﮐـﺎﻫﺶ ﻖ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﮐﺎﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻠﺴﻴﻢ ،ﻭﺭﻭﺩ ﮐﻠﺴﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ .١ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺖ ﮔﺎﺑﺎ ) ( GABAﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻲ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ .٢ﮔﺎﺑﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻣﺠﻤﻮ ﹺﻉ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﮔﺎﺑﺎ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ } .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ) ﺑﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨـﻲ ( ﺍﻓـﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ{ . ﻲ ﺗﻬﻴﻴﺞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺼـﻞ ﺷـﻮﻧﺪﻩ ﺑـﻪ .٣ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ } .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺗﻬﻴﻴﺞ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ{ . ١ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ – .ﻡ ٢ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ) ﺍﺗﺎﻧﻮﻝ ( :ﺍﺗﺎﻧﻮﻝ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ،ﺧﻨﺜﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻠﻮﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﺝ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻀﻢ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﮔﻮﺍﺭﺵ ﻖ ﺭﻭﺩﻩ ي ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ﺟﺬﺏ ﻣﻲ ﮎ ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ٨٠ﺩﺭﺻ ِﺪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺼﺮﻓﻲ ﻓﻮﺭﺍ ً ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭ ﺟﺬﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮ ِ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﺬﺏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻓﻮﺭﺍ ً ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺍﺳﺮ ﻣﺎﻳﻌﺎ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺕ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺤﻠﻮﻝ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺏ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﻏﻠﻈ ِ ﻞ ﺟﺬﺏ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺖ ﺁﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻓﺘﻲ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻏﻠﻈ ِ ﺕ ﻖ ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ﻭ ﺭﻳﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﻓﻊ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﭼﺮﺏ ﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﻓ ﹺﻊ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻧﺎﭼﻴﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ % ٥ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺽ ﺍﺳﻴﺪﻫﺎي ﭼﺮﺏ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺰ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﺰﻩ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ،ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻼﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ،ﺑﺪﻥ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻮ ﹺ ﺁﺏ CO٢ ،ﻭ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ – ﻩ .ﺁ .ﮔﺘﺮي -ﻣﻴﻨﻮ ﻓﺮﻭﺯﺍﻧﻲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﭼﻬﺮ – ﭼﺎﭖ ﺷﺸﻢ – ١٣٨٠ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٤ - ٤٣
٢٨٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
.٤ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺯﻳﺮ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ١ﮔﻠﻮﺗﺎﻣـﺎﺕ ﮐـﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻞ ﻲ ﺛﺎﻧﻮﻳﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺧـ ﹺ .٥ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﺭﺳﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﭼﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺶ ﺑﻴﺸـﺘﺮ ﻭ ﺧﻮﻳﺸـﺘﻦ ﺩﺍﺭي ﺶ ﺍﺿـﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﺁﺭﺍﻣـ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻢ ،ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﮔﺮي .( ١٩٨٢ ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮔﺎﺑـﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .٣ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮐﻢ ،ﻣﺴﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻞ ﺶ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑـﻪ ﺩﻟﻴـ ﹺ ﺕ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺢ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺷـﺪ ) .ﺭﻭﺯﻧﺰﻭﻳـﮓ ،ﺑﺮﻳـﺪﻻﻭ ﻭ ﺶ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻟﻴﻤﻦ( ٢٠٠٢ ٤
subtype ١ Gray ٢ ي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺶ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺳﺎﺯي ﮔﺎﺑﺎ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﻧﺪﻳﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﻁ ﺁﻣﻴﺰ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘﻦ ﺩﺍﺭ ﹺ ٣ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﮐﺎﺳﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ. Rosenzweig , Breedlove , Leiman ٤
٢٨٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﺁﺭﺍﻡ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺮﺧـﻲ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮ ﻭ ﺟﻨﮕﺠﻮ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻦ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﻭ ﻫﻤـﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫـﺎي ﺿـﺪ ﺚ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ،ﻣﻘـﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻦ ﻫﺸﻴﺎﺭي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺯﻣﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﻭ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗ ﹺ ﮎ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ « ٢ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ﺐ ﺁﻥ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ » ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ِ ١ﺗﺮ ِ ﺳﻪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺕ ﺷﮑﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺣـﺪﻭ ِﺩ ٥ﺳـﺎﻋﺖ .١ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺳﺮﺩﺭﺩ ،ﺗﻬﻮﻉ ،ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻖ ﻭ ﺍﻧﻘﺒﺎﺽ ) ﮔﺮﻓﺘﮕﻲ ( ﻋﻀﻼ ِ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﻄﻊ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ. ﺖ ﺗﺸﻨﺞ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ١ﺭﻭﺯ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﻄ ﹺﻊ ﻧﻮﺷـﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﭼﻨـﺪﻳﻦ .٢ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻞ ﻣـﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﻧﻈﻴـ ﹺﺮ ﺗﻮﻫﻤـﺎﺕ ، ٣ﺑﻴﻘـﺮﺍﺭي ،ﻫـﺬﻳﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺷـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﮐـﻪ ﺷـﺎﻣ ﹺ .٣ﺁﺷﻔﺘﮕﻲ ﺫﻫﻨ ﹺ ﺶ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ
ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮ ﻭ ﻣﺘﺠﺎﻭﺯ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ، ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻂ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﺸﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﻣﺼـﺮﻑ ﮐـﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧـﺪ ) .ﺑﻮﺷـﻤﻦ ﻭ ﮐـﻮﭘﺮ.( ١٩٩٠ ٤ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻘﺘﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻭ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻗﻴﺪ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻً ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ : syndrome ١ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ،ﻧﺸﺎﻧﮕﺎﻥ ،ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﻋﻼﺋﻢ :ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻋﻼﺋﻢ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ) ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠـﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘـﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘـﺮ ﺷـﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( alcohol withdrawal syndrome ٢ ﻲ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻴﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﮎ ﺣﺴ ﹺ : Hallucination ٣ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﺷﻨﻴﺪﻥِ ﺻﺪﺍ ﻳﺎ ﺩﻳﺪﻥ ﺷﮑﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻃﺮﺍ ِ ﻑ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( Bushman , Cooper ٤
٢٨٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻭ ﺑﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩﻳﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻗﻴـﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻨـﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﻗـ ﹺﻊ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻣـﺎﻧﻊﹺ ﺑـﺮﻭ ﹺﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫـﺎي ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮﺍﻧﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.١
ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﺕ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭﻭ ،ﮐﻠﮑﻮﻫـﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﻑ ﺖ ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻻﻧﮓ ( ١٩٥٨ ) ٢ﺑﺎ ﻧﻬﺎﻳ ِ ﺶ ﺳــﺮﻋﺖِ ﻖ ﮐــﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻣﻘــﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺴــﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤــﻲ ﺍﻟﮑــﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳــ ﹺ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ،ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻣـﻮﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺗﻮﻣﺒﻴـﻞ ﻭ ﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺧﻮﺍﻧﺪ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻴﻠـﻮﻣﺘﺮ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺐ ﺞ ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺷﻤﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺳﺎﺑﻲ ﻭ ﮐﺪﻟﻴﻨﮓ ( ١٩٧٥ ) ٣ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﺘﺎﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺧـﻮﻥ ﺩﺳـﺖ ﺑـﻪ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘـﻲ ﺢ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﻗﺎﻧﻮ ِﻥ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﻳﺘﺎﻧﻴﺎ ﻣﺒﻨﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦﹺ ﻳﮏ ﺣ ِﺪ ﻣﺠﺎﺯ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺙ ﺟـﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﺩﺭ ﺳـﺎﻋﺎﺕِ ﺐ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗـﺎﻧﻮﻥ ،ﺗﻌـﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻴـﺎﻥِ ﺣـﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﺯﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺙ ﺟﺎﺩﻩ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ١٠ﺷﺐ ﺗﺎ ٤ﺻﺒﺢ % ٣٦ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺣﻮﺍﺩ ِ ﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺖ ٤ﺻﺒﺢ ﺗﺎ ١٠ﺷﺐ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ % ٧ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﺑﻮﺩ. ﻦ ﺳﺎﻋ ِ ﺍي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭي، ﺶ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ :ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﻨﻔ ﹺ ﻫﺎﮐﻲ ( ١٩٨٣ ) ٤ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺶ ﻇﺮﻓﻴ ِ ﺖ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ،ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺶ ﺩﻗ ِ ﺖ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ،ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺶ ﺳﺮﻋ ِ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﺨﺘﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.٥ e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١ Drew , Colquhoun & Long ٢ Codling & Sabey ٣ Hockey ٤ e ٥ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢
٢٨٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ : ﺚ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﺧﻮﺵ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺑﻲ ﺣﺪ ﻭ ﺣﺼﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮﺍﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻑ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻞ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﭘﺘﺎﻧﺴﻴ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ ،ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ، ﺍﮐﺴﺘﺎﺳﻲ ،ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻧﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻳﻢ :
ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ :ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻗﻬﻮﻩ ،ﭼﺎي ﻭ ﮐﺎﮐﺎﺋﻮ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻼﻳﻢ ﻭ ﺑﻲ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺩﻭﺯﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻻي ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﺑﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﺑﻲ ،ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺷﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ :ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻨﺒﺎﮐﻮ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﺮﭼﻪ ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭﺯ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.١
ﺖ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻲ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ :ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣
٢٨٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ: ١ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﮒ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭﺧﺘﭽﻪ ي ﮐﻮﮐﺎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﺸﻮﺭ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺮﻭ ،ﮐﻠﻤﺒﻴﺎ ﻭ ﺑﻮﻟﻴﻮي ﺭﺷﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ. ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ : ﮔﺮ ِﺩ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ :ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧـﺪ ﺑـﻪ ﺻـﻮﺭﺕِ ﮔـﺮﺩ ﺖ ﭼﭗ ( ﻞ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻩ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﺮﻳـﻖ ﺑـﻪ ﺳـﺮﻋﺖ ﻦ ﮐﺮﮎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻦ ﮐﺮﮎ : ٢ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ ( ﻞ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻦ ﮐﺮﮎ ﺍﺯ ﮔﺮ ِﺩ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻦ ﮐﺮﮎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺳﺮﻳﻊ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺯ ﮔﺮ ِﺩ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﺖ » ﺗﻘﻮﻳـﺖ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪﮔﻲ « ٣ﺑﺴـﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺨﺪﺭي ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴ ِ
ﺕ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﺑﻮﺯﺍﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻭﺍﻳﺰ١٩٨٥ ) ٤ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺳﺖ .ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻗﺪﺭ ِ ( ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﻲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ،ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺴـﺘﻨﺪ ﺑـﺎ ﻓﺸـﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﻳـﮏ ﭘﺪﺍﻝ ،ﺑﻪ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺗﺰﺭﻳﻖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﻌـﺪ ﺍﺯ ٢٥ﺭﻭﺯ ﮐـﻪ ﻣـﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﺑـﻪ ﻃـﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺎﻣﺤـﺪﻭﺩ ﺑـﻪ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ % ٩٠ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺟﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ. ﺶ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ % ٤٠ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﻨﺪ.٥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ
: Cocaine ١ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﮐﺮﮎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ Crack ٢ ﻲ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﻨ ﹺ ﻲ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ : reinforcement ٣ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ .ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧ ﹺ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ :ﭘﺪﻳﺪﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﺑﭙﻴﻮﻧﺪﺩ. Bozarth & Wise ٤ e ٥ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٥
٢٨٨
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻧﮕﺮﺮﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ : ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻧﮕﺮﺵ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺨﺪﺭ ﺭ ﻃﺮﺯﹺ ﺵ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺩﮔﺮﮔﻮﻥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻦ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﮐﮐﺮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﺷﻮﺭ ﻭ ﻑِ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ﺷﺮﺮﻭﻉ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﺩﺭﻣﺎﻧﻧﻲ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﺪﺍﺭي ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﻭ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﺯ ﺟﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻦ ﻭ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﻴﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻨﻬﺎﺩ ﻲ ﮏ ﻓﺮﻭﻳﺪ ،ﻓﻠﻴﺸﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﺳﺘﺎ ِﻥ ﻧﺰﺩﻳ ِ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﺗﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻲ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﻌﺘﺘﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺳﺮﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻋﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻴﻮﻧﺲ ( ١٩٨٩ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺮ ﺲ ﮒ ﺍﻭ ﺷﺪ) . ﻣﺮ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﺩﺩﺭﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﮕﺮﻳﺴﺴﺘﻪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫﻪ ي ١٩٦٠ﻭ ١٩٧٠ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﻮﺍﻥ ﺳﺮﮐﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺶ ﻭﻭﺯﻥ ﺗﺠﻮﻳﺰ ﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﺷﺘﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺮ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﮎ ﺁﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻲ ﻫﻮﻟﻨﺎ ِ ﺟﺎﻧﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﺒ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﭘﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺷﺪ .ﻫﻢ ﺍﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﺠﻮﻳﺰ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﻗﻠﻤﺪﺍﺩ ﻲ ﮎ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ
٢٨٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ:١ ﺕ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺁﻣﻔﺘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﻲ ) ﻏﻴﺮ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ( ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻫﻮﺷﻴﺎﺭ ،ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﻪ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﺕ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﺗﺮ ) ﺩﺭ ﺣﺪﻭ ِﺩ ٣٠ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻪ ( ﺕ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪﻩ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺑـﻴﻦ ﻣـﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ،ﻓـﺮﺩ ﺩﭼـﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺣـﺎﻟﺘﻲ ﻣﻌـﺮﻭﻑ ﺑـﻪ » ﺩﺭ ﻫـﻢ ﻑ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﺍﻳﺠـﺎﺩ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ .ﺍﺳـﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣـﺪﺍﻭﻡ ﺍﺯ ﺷﮑﺴﺘﮕﻲ « ٢ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ،ﺑﺮ ﺍﺛـﺮ ﻣﺼـﺮ ِ ي ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸـﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭﺟـﻪ ي ﺑـﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻋﺼـﺒﺎﻧﻴﺖ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷـﮕﺮي ﺚ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩِ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫـﺎ ﹺ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .
e Amphetamine ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٦ ﻑ ﺖ » ﺩﺭ ﻫﻢ ﺷﮑﺴﺘﮕﻲ « ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺸﺌﻪ ي ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻓﻘﻂ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺡ ﻋﺎﻣﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺣﺎﻟ ِ : crash ٢ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﺎ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﻟﺮﺯﺵ ،ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﭘﺬﻳﺮي ﻭ ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻃﻮﻻﻧ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ
٢٩٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩِ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻟﮑﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺳـﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭي ﻣﺸـﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺳـﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ﻋﺼـﺒﻲ ﻧﻈﻴـﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧـﺎﻟﻴﻦ، ﺶ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳـﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﻩ ﺚ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﻋـﺚ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ي ﺧـﻮﺩ ﻲ ﮐﺎﺗﻪ ﮐﻮﻻﻣﻴﻨﻲ ١ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻀﺎي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺑـﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﺎﻧـﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﮔـﺬﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻖ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﺯﺟﺬﺏ ) ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﺠﺪﺩ ( ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﻩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﻴﺶ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺴﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.
ﻂ ﻫﺎﮐﻲ ) (١٩٨٣ﺟﻤﻊ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﺕ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ .١ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﹺﺯ ) ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ( ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ،ﺳﺮﻋﺖِ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫـﺪ .ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺍﻣـﺮ ﻲ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ. ﺕ ﺟﺎﻧﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻗﻴﻤ ِ .٢ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻢ ﺍﻫﻤﻴـﺖ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺖ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ٢ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. .٣ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻇﺮﻓﻴ ِ
١ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ،ﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. : working memory ٢ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﺎﺭي .ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ) ( short term memoryﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ eﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٧
٢٩١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ: ١ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻳﺠـﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫ ﹺﻢ ﺩﻳﺪﺍﺭي ،ﺧﻄﺎﻫﺎي ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ٢ﻭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻒ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﻧـ ِﺪ ﺗﻔﮑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗـﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﺻـﻮﺭﺕِ ﻃﺒﻴﻌـﻲ ﺕ ﻣﻮﺟـــﻮﺩ ﻫﺴـــﺘﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑـــﻪ ﺑﺮﺧـــﻲ ﺩﻳﮕـــﺮ ﺑـــﻪ ﺻـــﻮﺭ ِ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ) ﺗﺮﮐﻴﺒﻲ ( ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ .ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : ﺳﻴﻠﻮﺳﻴﺒﻴﻦ : ٣ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﺭﭺ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺎﺩﻭﻳﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺱ ﻣﺴﮑﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ. ﻣﺴﮑﺎﻟﻴﻦ : ٤ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﮐﺘﻮ ﹺ
ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍي ﮐﺎﺭﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﺍي ) ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻲ ( ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩي ﻧﻈﻴـ ﹺﺮ ،٦ DMT ،٥ LSDﻓﻨﺴـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺳﻠﻴﺪﻳﻦ ٧ﻭ ٨PCPﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ.
Hallucinogens ١ -١: illusions ٢ﺗﻌﺒﻴﺮ ﻭ ﺗﻔﺴﻴﺮ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮐﺎﺕ ﺣﺴﻲ – ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – -٢ﺣﺎﻟﺘﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﺑﺎ ﺧﻮﺍﺹ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻣﻨﻄﺒﻖ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺪ – ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ » ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻭ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ « ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍي .ﺑﺮﻭﺱ ﮔﻠﺪﺷﺘﺎﻳﻦ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻫﻤﺎﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻬﻴﻦ – ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻩ ﺗﺒﺮﻳﺰ -ﻡ Psilocybin ٣ mescaline ٤ lysergic acid diethylamide ٥ﺑﻪ ،LSDﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. :dimethyltryptamine ٦ﺩي ﻣﺘﻴﻞ ﺗﺮﻳﭙﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ phencyclidine ٧ phenylcyclohexylpiperidine ٨
٢٩٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻫﺎﻟﺠﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻭﻳـﺖ ﺑـﻮﺭﻥ (١٩٩٧ ) ١ﺍﺛـﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺱ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺖ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ،ﺗﺮ ﹺ ﺕ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻭ ﭘﺎ ﺍﻓﺘﺎﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺩﺍﺷ ِ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،٢ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ،ﺑﺪﻓﻬﻤﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻇﻬﺎﺭﺍ ِ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﻋﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺷـﻌﻮﺭ ،ﺍﻓﮑـﺎ ﹺﺭ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﻧﻮﻳـﺎﻳﻲ ٣ﻭ ﺑـﻪ ﻃـﻮﺭ ﮐﻠـﻲ ﻋﻤﻠﮑـﺮ ِﺩ ﻫﻤـﺮﺍﻩ ﺑـﺎ ﺍﺧـﺘﻼﻝ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨـﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﺕ ﭼﺸﻤﮕﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮐﻲ ،ﻣﺴ ﹺ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﺦ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ، ٤ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ،ﻫﺬﻳﺎﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﮎ ﺗﻮﻫﻤﻲ ﭘﺎﻳﺪﺍﺭ « ٥ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻑ ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ » ﺍﺩﺭﺍ ِ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻞ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭼﻨﺪ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﻴﺮ ﭘﺲ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﻲ ،٦ﺍﻧﻮﺍ ﹺﻉ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ،ﻫﺬﻳﺎﻥ ٧ﻭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ﻣـﻲ ﺑﺎﺷـﺪ .ﺑﺴـﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺍﻓـﺮﺍﺩ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﺑﻪ » ﻧﺸﺌﻪ ي ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ « ٨ﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﻲ
Halgin , Whitbourne ١ anxiety ٢ : paranoid thinking ٣ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﭘﺎﺭﺍﻧﻮﻳﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺣﻤﻼﺕ ﻣﻮﻗﺖ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺗﻮﻫ ﹺﻢ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻭ ﺁﺯﺍﺭ ﺩﻳﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﻧﻮﻳﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩي ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺪﮔﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ،ﺣﺴﺎﺩﺕ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ،ﻟﺠﺎﺟﺖ ،ﻭ ﻏﺒﻄﻪ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ– ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ : depersonalisation ٤ﻓﻘﺪﺍﻥ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ،ﺷﺨﺼﻴﺖ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ ،ﺩﮔﺮﺳﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ :ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻣﺮﺿﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻣﺒﺘﻼ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﺵ ﻋﺎﺟﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ ﻣﻲ ﭘﻨﺪﺍﺭﺩ – .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ hallucinogen persisting perception disorder ٥ : flashbacks ٦ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺸﺖ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ : delusion ٧ﻫﺬﻳﺎﻥ :ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﻏﻠﻂ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻭ ﮔﻮﺍﻩ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﺳﺘﻲ ﺁﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺧﺼﺎﻳﺺ ﺐ ﺟﻨﻮﻥ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ – ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ hallucinogenic intoxication ٨
٢٩٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺶ ﺿﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻖ ،ﺗﭙﺶﹺ ﻗﻠﺐ ،ﺩﻳ ِﺪ ﺗﺎﺭ ،ﻟﺮﺯﺵ ،ﻧﺎﻫﻤـﺎﻫﻨﮕﻲ ﻭ ﻋـﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺸﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺮﺩﻣﮏ ،ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ. ﻂ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﻤﻨﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺁﻟﺒﺮﺕ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎ ﹺﻝ ١٩٤٣ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ LSD ،ﺷﻬﺮ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻒ ﺍﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺑﻮﺩ : ﻫﺎﻓﻤﻦ ١ﮐﺸﻒ ﺷﺪ .ﮐﺸ ِ ﺍﻭ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﻗﺎﺭﭺ ﮐﻪ ﮔﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺒﺘﻼ ﺕ ﺗﻨﻔﺴﻲ ﮐﻤﮏ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺭﺍ ﻗـﻮﺭﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﮑﻼ ِ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺑﺪﺑﺨﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍ ِﻩ ﺧﺎﻧـﻪ ﺩﭼـﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺗــﻮﻫ ﹺﻢ ﺷــﺪﻳﺪي ﮐـﺮﺩ .ﺑــﻪ ﮔﻔﺘــﻪ ي ﺧــﻮ ِﺩ ﺍﻭ " :ﺑــﻪ ﻗــﺪﺭي ﺍﻳــﻦ ﺣﺎﻟــﺖ ﻏﻴ ـ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟﻲ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﺳﻴﺪﻡ ﻣﺒﺎﺩﺍ ﺩﻳﻮﺍﻧﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺶ ﺑﺎﺷﻢ ! " ﺩﺭ ﺩﻫـﻪ ي LSD ١٩٦٠ﻧﻘـ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮓ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺨﺪﺭ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺗﻴﻤﻮﺗﻲ ﻟﻴﺮي ٢ﺍﺳﺘﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﻫﺎﺭﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﺮﻓ ﹺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻘﺸﻲ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ ! ﻦ ٤ﺗـﺎ ١٢ ﻑ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺖ » ﭘﺮﻭﺍﺯ «٣ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ Lsdﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻑ LSDﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﻓـﺮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ .ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﺗﻔﮑ ﹺﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺭﻳﺨﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺪﻩ ي ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻓﺮﻳﺐ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﮑ ﹺﺮ ﭘﺮﻭﺍﺯ ﻳﺎ ﭘﺮﻳﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﺑﺒﻴﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﮐﻨـﺪ.
Albert Hoffmann ١ Timothy Leary ٢ ﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ي ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ -ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :ﻧﻴﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧ ﹺ : psychological dependence ٣ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ،ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ
٢٩٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﮒ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔـﺮﺩﺩ .ﺑـﻪ ﻧﻈـﺮ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﻓﮑﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮﺳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻧﮑﻨـﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨـﻴﻦ ﺯﻣـﺎﻧﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻓـﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺳـﺘﻌﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻣﮑﺮ ﹺﺭ LSDﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﮎ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﻧﻴﺴـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﻣﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ١ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ. ﺁﻳﺎ LSDﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚِ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ
ﺕ ﺕ PCPﻳﺎ » ﮔﺮ ِﺩ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ « ﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ PCPﻧﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ LSDﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ PCPﺍﺯ LSDﻧﻴﺰ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ PCPﺩﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : PCPﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮ ،ﺑﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻭ ﻣﺘﺠﺎﻭﺯ ﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻋﻼﺋ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻭي ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺚ ﺳﺮﺩﺭﮔﻤﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﻑ PCPﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮐﻠﻴﺸﻪ ﺍي ٢ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻦ ﻓﺸﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻮﻥ ،ﺗﺸﻨﺞ ﻭ PCPﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻦ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ) .ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ( PCP ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﮐﻤﺎ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ
ﺕ ﺗﺨﺼﺼﻲ ﺑﺎﺯ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ : trip ١ﭘﺮﻭﺍﺯ .ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﻲ ﻋﺎﻣﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠﺎً ﺟﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﻻ ِ ﮓ ﻞ LSDﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻦ ﺁﻥ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﻳﺎ ﻣﻘﻠ ِﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺿﻤ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ : stereotyped behaviour ٢ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﮐﻠﻴﺸﻪ ﺍي ) ﺛﺎﺑﺖ ( ﻳﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﺒﻲ : .١ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻳﺎ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺍﻧﻌﻄﺎﻑ ﻧﺎﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﻭ ﻳﮑﻨﻮﺍﺧﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ ( ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﮐﻼﻣﻲ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻲ ﺣﺮﮐﺎﺕ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺻﻮﺍ ِ .٢ﺗﮑﺮﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻭ ﻃﻮﻻﻧ ﹺ
٢٩٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ LSDﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ : ﺖ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. • LSDﺁﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴ ِ • ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺭﻭﻳﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ) .ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ( ١٩٩٤ ١ ﺚ ﺍﻳﺠـﺎ ِﺩ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴـﺖ ﻫـﺎي ﺭﻭﻳـﺎ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺎ ﹺﺭﻫﻢ ﺑﮕﺬﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ LSDﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ،ﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺪﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﺐ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻭ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ) .ﮔﺮﻟﻴﮏ ﻭ PCPﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺖ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮ PCPﻗـﺮﺍﺭ ﻦ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺗﺤـ ِ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺘﺮ . ( ١٩٩٥ ٢ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻼﺵ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﺭﻭﺯﻧﺰﻭﻳﮓ ،ﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﻭ ﺑﺮﻳﺪﻻﻭ . ( ١٩٩٩
Carlson ١ Gorelick , Balster ٢
٢٩٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ:١ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳـﺎﮎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻴـﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺩﺳـﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ، ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﻣﺸﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺱ ﺗﺮﻳـﺎﮎ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺳـﺎ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎﮎ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮐﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺷﻴﺮﻩ ي ﭼﺴﺒﻨﺎﮎِ ﺧﺸﺨﺎﺵ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺸـﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ،ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻮﺩﺋﻴﻦ .ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﻋﻨﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﻭ ﮐﻮﺩﺋﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﻨﺪ.
ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ٢ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﺷﺪ ؟ ﺶ ﺩﺭﺩ، ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻪ ﭼﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺩﻭﺭ ،ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﺯﺍﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﺗﺰﺭﻳﻖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﺯﺍﻥ ﭘـﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﺪﺗﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥِ ﻗﺮﻥِ ﻧﻮﺯﺩﻫﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻓـ ﹺﻊ ﻲ ﺑـﺎﻳﺮ ) ،( bayerﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺸﮑﻞ ﮐﻤﭙﺎﻧﻲِ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳ ﹺ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﻣـﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﺛـ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻋﺘﻴـﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ﻧـﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﻋﺮﺿﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭي ﺷﺪ ﮐـﻪ ﻣـﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﺑـﺎ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﺑـﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺩﺍﺷﺖ! ٣
Opiates ١ ﻲ ﺁﻥ diacetylmorphineﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. : Heroin ٢ﻧﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻤ ﹺ ٣ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻـﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١٤ (
٢٩٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
: Opiates e ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺳﻪ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي opiates ،opiumﻭ opioidsﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻗﺎﺋﻞ ﺷﺪ :
ﮎ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﺧﺸﺨﺎﺵ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺳـﺖ ﻣـﻲ ﺁﻳـﺪ، : Opiumﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ) ﺍﻓﻴﻮﻥ ( :ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺷﻴﺮﻩ ي ﭼﺴﺒﻨﺎ ِ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
: Opiatesﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎِﺗﺘﺮﻳﺎﮎ ) ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻓﻴﻮﻧﻲ ( :ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ ﭼـﻪ ﻃﺒﻴﻌـﻲ ) ﻞ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ،ﮐﻮﺩﺋﻴﻦ ( ﻭ ﭼﻪ ﻧﻴﻤﻪ – ﻣﺼﻨﻮﻋﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ( ﻭ ﻗـﺎﺩﺭ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﺗﺼـﺎﻝ ﺑـﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧـﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺟﺰﻭ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ : Opioidsﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻓﻴﻮﻧﻲ :ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ﺗﺮﻳـﺎﮎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐـﺰ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺟـﺰﻭ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺷـﺒﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻓﻴﻮﻧﻲ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺪﻳﻬﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺍﻓﻴﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺷـﺒﻪ ﺍﻓﻴـﻮﻧﻲ ﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻣـﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﺗﺮﺍﻣـﺎﺩﻭﻝ ،Tramadol ﻣﺘﺎﺩﻭﻥ Methadoneﻭ ﻟﻮﭘﺮﺍﻣﻴﺪ Loperamideﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺕ ﻫﺮ ﺳﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ،ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺷﺒﻴﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ www.drugs-forum.co.uk/ :
٢٩٨
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ؟ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﭼﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻲ ﻫﺮﻭﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ
ﺕ ﺗﺮ ﮎ ﻳـﺎﮎ ﻑ ﻣﺸﺘﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ! ﻣﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺹﹺ ﻒ ﻣﻐﺰﺰ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺖ ﺫﻫﻨﻨﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴــﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺭ ) ﻣﺜﺜﻼً ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ( ،ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳــﺦ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺎ ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﺑﻪ ﺹ ﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﻮﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﭼﭼﺮﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻣﺎ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻣﻤﮑ ﺕِ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻲ ﻦ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧﻞﹺ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻉﹺ ﺍﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻞﹺ ﺪ ﺕ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧــﻮﻉ ﺲ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﻴﺎﺝ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﺎﮎ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﭘﺲ ﻣﺸـﺘﻘﺎﺕِ ﮎ ﺩﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺯﺍﺩ ١ﮔﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ .ﺩﻭ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻧـﻪ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎ ِ ﺕِ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﻼ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﺎﮎ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺍﺳﺖ ( ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻋﺒﺎﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮑﮑﻔﺎﻟﻴﻦ ٢ﻭ ﺑﺘﺘﺎﺍﻧﺪﻭﺭﻓﻴﻦ ) .٣ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺻ
ﺑﺪﻥ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻞ ﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ : endogenousﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺯﺍﺩ ،ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﮔﻔﺘﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻪ e s١ encephalinn ٢ B-endorphinn ٣
٢٩٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺲ ﺩﺭﺩ ،ﺗﻘﻮﻳـﺖ ،ﺗﺴـﮑﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻑ ﻣﮑﺮ ﹺﺭ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ،ﭼﻬﺎﺭ ﭘﻴﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ :ﻓﻘﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺣـ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮎ ﻣﺘﻤـﺎﻳﺰي ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳـﺎ ِ ﺶ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ .ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣـﻮﺍﺭﺩ ،ﮔﻴﺮﻧـﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺸـﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ :
ﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺯ -١ﻓﻘﺪﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﺲ ﺩﺭﺩ ) ١ﺑﻲ ﺩﺭﺩي ( :ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻐﺰﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ . ﺕ ﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟـﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺸـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐـ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ .ﻣﺸـﺘﻘﺎ ِ -٢ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ : ٢ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ،ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.٣ ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ِ ٥ﻣﺰﺍﻧﺴﻔﺎﻟﻴﮏ. ﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ -٣ﺗﺴﮑﻴﻦ : ٤ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ -٤ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﻮﺟـﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺎﺣﻴـﻪ ي ﺶ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ) ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺮﻣﻴﺎ : ( ٦ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ. ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳ ﹺ
e Analgesia ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٨ : reinforcement ٢ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ،ﻳﮏ ﺻﻔﺖ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺑﻬﺒﻮﺩ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ! – ﻡ e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٩ sedation ٤ ﺖ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ،ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ : reticulat formation ٥ﺳﺎﺧ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺸﺒﮏ :ﺑﻪ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ي ﺕ ﺷﺒﮑﻪ ﺍي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﮔﺴﺘﺮﺩﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎ ً ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻼ ِ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ١٣٢ hypothermia ٦
٣٠٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ : ﺖ ﺫﻫﻨ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﺑﺮ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﺚ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﺣﺎﻟـ ِ ﻑ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻓﺘﺮﻳﻦ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺸـﺎﺑ ِﻪ » ﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷﻲ ِ « ١ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺁﻧﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﺒﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺧﻮﺕ ﻭ ﺧﺮﺳـﻨﺪي ﻣـﻲ ﮔـﺮﺩﺩ .ﻣـﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺑﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺩﺭﺩﻫﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺁﻥ ،ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ
ﺶ ﺶ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕﺮي ،ﮐـﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻲ ﻭﺧﻴﻤﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻌﺎﺷﺮﺕ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻨﻈﻢ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﻣﻌﻴﻨـﻲ ﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﺼـﺮﻑ ﻦ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻑ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻌـﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ٢ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻳﻌﻨـﻲ ﻣﺼـﺮ ِ ﺕ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺟﺎي ﺗﻌﺠﺐ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻫﻤﻴﺸﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺁﻥ ﻭ ﻟﺬ ِ ﻦ ﻲ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷـﻮﻧﺪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑـﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍﺭ ﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺳﺘﻴﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎ ﺧﺒﺮ ﮎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮎ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺣﺘﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎي ﺧﻄﺮﻧﺎ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ،ﺗﺮ ِ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭼﺮﺍ ؟ ﺐ ﺁﻥ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ. ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ :ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗ ﹺ
ﺱ ﻣﺜﺒﺖِ " ﺳﺮﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈ ﹺﺮ ﺟﺴﻤﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ " ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ : euphoria ١ﻧﺸﺌﻪ ،ﮐﻴﻔﻮﺭي ،ﺷﻨﮕﻮﻟﻲ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻧﺸﺌﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻫﺮ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﺴﺮﺕ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ِ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( : tolerance ٢ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ :ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺧﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ ،ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺳﺎﺑﻖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ.
٣٠١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
◄ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ :ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺟﺴﻤﻲ ،ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ :
ﻞ ﺷـﺪﻳ ِﺪ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ ،ﺑـﺎ ﻣﻴـ ﹺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ
ﻑ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮔﺮﻳﺰ ﺍﺭ ﺁﺛﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻤـﺎﺭي ﻳـﺎ ﻧـﺎﺭﺍﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﻃـﻼﻕ ﻣـﻲ ﻣﺴﺘﻤﺮ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﻭﺏ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧـﻮﻉ ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ ﺑـﻪ ﻫﻨﮕـﺎ ﹺﻡ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺚ ﺕ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩي ﮐـﻪ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﮎ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺼﺮﻓﻲ ،ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺗﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ « ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ » ﺣﺸﻴﺶ « ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ
ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺕ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳـﮏ ﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴـﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺣـﺎﻻ ِ ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ
ﻑ ﻣﮑﺮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﭘﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﺧﺼﻮﺻـﻴﺘﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻧـﻮﻉ ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﺷﺪﻳ ِﺪ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺩﺭ ﭘـﻲ ﻗﻄـ ﹺﻊ ﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ ،ﺑﺮﻭ ﹺﺯ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕــﺮ ،ﻭﺍﺑﺴــﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣــﺎﺩﻩ ﻳــﺎ ﺗﺠــﻮﻳ ﹺﺰ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴــﺖ ﻫــﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺍﺳــﺖ .ﺑــﻪ ﻋﺒــﺎﺭ ِ ﻧﺎﮔﻬــﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﺑﺎ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭘﻴﺸﮕﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻭﻗﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣـﻲ ﻲ ﺟﺴﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩي ﮐـﻪ ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ،ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳــﺎﮎ ﻭ ﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳــﮏ « ﻣــﻲ ﺷــﻮﻧﺪ ﻣــﻲ ﺗــﻮﺍﻥ ﺑــﻪ ﻣﺸــﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺚ ﺍﻳﺠــﺎ ِﺩ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴــﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﺑﺎﺭﺑﻴﺘﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ.
ﻑ ﻒ ﻣﺼـﺮ ِ ﺐ ﺗﻮﻗـ ِ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪي ﺳـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗـ ﹺ ﺕ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﮑﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ◄ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ :ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺬﮐﻮﺭ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ.
٣٠٢
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﻤﻴﻢ ﻨﺎﻧﭽـﻪ ﺗﺼـﻤﻴ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠـﻪ ﭼﻨﺎ ﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﮔﺎ ِﻥ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﻧﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﺘﮕﻲ ١ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺭ ﻣﺼ ﺍﺯ : ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻧﺪ » ،ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ « ٢ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩي ﺭﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨـﺪ ﺯ ﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺗﺮﮎ ﺕ ﭘﺎﻫﻫﺎ .ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺣﺎﺎﻝ ﺧﻮﺍﺑﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻧﺪﺍﺷﺘﻦ ﺑﺮ ﺣﺣﺮﮐﺎ ِ ﻲ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻖ ،ﺑﻲ ﺶﹺ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻗﻠﺐ ،ﻖ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺮﺍﺑﻲ ،ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺍﻧﮕﻴـﺰ ﻭ ﺭﻗـﺖ ﺁﻭﻭﺭ ﺰ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ ﻏـﻢ ﺳـﻴﻨﻤﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﺸـﺎﻥ ﻩ ﻲ ﻫـﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﻪﻪ ﺣﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﻴﻠﻢ ي ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮎ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﺴﻮﻥ ( ١٩٩٤
ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ « ﻲ ﺍﺻـﻄﻼﺡ » ﺡﹺ ﻲ ،ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ ﺑــﻪ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺳﺳـﺎﻝ ﻫـﺎي ﺍﺧﻴــﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺘـﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻠﻤـﻲ، ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ : drug dependenceﻭﺍﺑﺴﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ d e١ ﺖ ﺟﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﺘﻴﺠـﻪ ﺭﺳـﻴﺪ ﮐﮐـﻪ ﺳﺎﻝ ،١٩٦٤ﺳﺎﺯﻣﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺑﻬﺪﺍﺷ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﻝﹺ ﻩ ﺣﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ » ﺍﻋﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ « ﻭ » ﻋﺎﺩﺩﺕ « ﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣ ﮕﺰﻳ ﹺ ﺟﺎﻳﮕ ﺻﻴﻪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﮐﻠﻤﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﻫﻨﻮﻮﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺗﻮﺻ ﻲ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ « ﺭﺍ ﻪ ﮕﺮ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺡ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺩﻳﮕ ﺍﺻﻄﻄﻼ ﹺ ِ ﻲ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺎﺭي ( ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ ﮓ ﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻡ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻢ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﺎﺑ ﹺﻊ ﮑﻲ ﻫﺎي ﮐﻨﺎﺭﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي : wﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ .ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ withdrawal symptomss ٢
٣٠٣
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ) ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﻮﺍﻧﺎ (١ﻭ ﺣﺸﻴﺶ : ﻑ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﺘﺘﻲ ﺼﺮ ِ ﻧﻈﺮﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺍﺳﻨﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺪﺍﺭﮐﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺩﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺼ ﻦﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﮏ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﻳﺎ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﺷﺎﻫﺪﺍﺍﻧﻪ ٢ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﻧــﺪ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﮔﻴــﺎﻩ ﮒ ﺧﺸ ِ ﺑﺮ ِ ٦ﻫﻫﺰﺍﺭﺳﺎﻟﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺭﺩ .ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻧﺎﻣﻲ ﺳﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺮ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺳﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺁﺏ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺍي ﮔﺮﺮﻡ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺖ ﺑﺪﺳـﺖ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻴـﺎﻩ ﺷـﺎﻩ ﺩﺍﻧـﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ.ﺣﺸﻴﺶ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﺍﻧﺎ ﻫﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺯ ٣ THCﺖ ﻋﻨﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﺷﺎﻩ ﺩﺍﻧﻪC ، ﺼ ﻞ ﺷـﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﻮﺍﻧـﺎ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﭼﭼـﺮﺍ ﮐـﻪ ﺣﺣﺸـﻴﺶ ﻣ ﺣﺸﻴﺶ ٤ﻗﻮﻳﺘﺮ ﺯ ﺁﻣﺪﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺣﺎﻭي THCﻫﺴﺘﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺶ ﺷﺎﻩ ﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ. THﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺻﻤﻤ ﹺﻎ ﮔﻴﺎ ِﻩ ﻩ HC
ﺷﻮﺩ – ﻡ ﺱ ) ﻋﻠﻒ ( ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩ : Mﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﮔﺮﺱ Marijuana or cannabiis ١ Hempp ٢ delta-٩-tetrahydrocannabinoll ٣ hashh ٤
٣٠٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
THCﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﻒ ﻣﻐـﺰ ،ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠـﻪ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﮐﺎﻣـﭗ ،ﻣﺨﭽـﻪ ،ﻫﺴـﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻣـﻲ ١ﻭ ﻖ ﻣﺨﺘﻠـ ِ THCﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟـﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨـﺎﻃ ﹺ ﻧﺌﻮﮐﺮﺗﮑﺲ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ) .ﻣﺎﺗﺴﻮﺩﺍ ،ﻟﻮﻟﻴﺖ ،ﺑﺮﺍﻭﻥ ﺍﺷﺘﺎﻳﻦ ،ﻳﺎﻧﮓ ﻭ ﺑﻮﻧﺮ. ( ١٩٩٠ ٢ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭼﻦ ﺕ THCﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻖ THCﺑـﻪ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ١٩٩٠ ) ٣ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺰﺭﻳـ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﺮﺍﻳﻲ ٤ﻣﻨﺠـﺮ ﺑـﻪ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺷـﺪﹺﻧﺪﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻲ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ي ﺩﻣﻲ ﻭ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﭘﻴﺸﺎﻧﻲ _ ﻣﻴﺎﻧ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻞ ﺳـﻴﮕﺎﺭي ﮐﺸـﻴﺪﻩ ﻣـﻲ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑـﻪ ﺷـﮑ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺁﻧﺮﺍ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺕ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ﺗـﺎ ﺣـﺪﻭ ِﺩ ٢ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﺰﺭﻳﻖ ﮐـﺮﺩ .ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻲ ﺁﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ THCﺗﺎ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ. ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻋﻨﺼ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ ﺖ ﻋﻨـﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﺧـﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،THCﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ،ﺣﺸﻴﺶ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﺗﺤـ ِ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﻨﻮﻳﺪ٥ﻫﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ .ﺩي ﺗﻮﻣﺎﺳﻮ ،ﺑﻠﺘﺮﺗﺎﻣﻮ ﻭ ﭘﻼﻣﻠﻲ ( ١٩٩٦ ) ٦ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨـﺪ ﮐـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷـﮑﻼﺕ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﻳﻨﻘـﺪﺭ ﺷـﮑﻼﺕ ﺩﻭﺳـﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﮐﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﻨﻮﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ! caudate nucleus ١ Matsuda ,Lolait , Brownstein , Young , Bonner ٢ Chen et al ٣ rats ٤ Cannabinoids ٥ Di Tomaso , Beltramo & Plomelli ٦
٣٠٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻳﺎ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﭼﻴﺴﺖ ؟ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻓـﺮﺩي ﻞ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺗﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ﺍي ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈـﺎﺭﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﺛﺮﺍﺕ ﺩﻭﺯﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ) ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻢ ( ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻇﺮﻳﻒ ﻭ ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﻲ ﻧﺎﻇﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ ) ( ١٩٧٢ﻓﺮﺩي ﮐﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﮐﻤـﻲ ﻣـﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧـﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﮐﻤﺴﻴﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﻠ ﹺ ﺕ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺣﺎﻻ ِ ﺖ ﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷﻲ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺖ ﺑﻲ ﺧﻴﺎﻟﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﻳﺎﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﺶ ﺑﻲ ﺗﺎﺑﻲ ﻭ ﺷﻨﮕﻮﻟﻲ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﺁﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ ﺵ ﻓﻀﺎ ﻭ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻞ ﮔﺴﺘﺮ ﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺱ ﺑﺴﺎﻭﺍﻳﻲ ) ﻻﻣﺴﻪ ( ،ﺑﻮﻳﺎﻳﻲ ،ﺷﻨﻮﺍﻳﻲ ،ﭼﺸﺎﻳﻲ ،ﺑﻴﻨﺎﻳﻲ ﻗﻮي ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺣﻮﺍ ﹺ ﻞ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﻭ ﭘﺎﻳﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﺮﻳﻨﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺱ ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﻣﻴ ﹺ ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻇﺮﻳﻒ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺤﻮﻩ ي ﺷﮑﻞ ﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﺑﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭ
ﺕ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : ﻑ ﺩﻭﺯﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻻ ) ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻳﺎ ِﺩ( ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﻭﻫﻤﺎﻫﻨﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﻧﺎﺗﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﻨﺎﺭﻩ ﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻒ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ
ي ﺣﻮﺍﺱ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﻒ ﻭ ﮐﮋﺍﻧﮕﺎﺭ ﹺ
ﭼﺸﻤﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﺷﮏ ﺁﻟﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻣﺮﻃﻮﺏ ﺟﻮﻳﺪﻩ ﺟﻮﻳﺪﻩ ﺳﺨﻦ ﮔﻔﺘﻦ
٣٠٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ. ﻑ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺑﺮ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻻﺑﺎﻣﺎ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ % ١٧ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ،ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺗﺼﺎﺩﻓﺎ ِ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ) ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ( ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ) .ﻓﻮﺭﺗﻦ ﺑﺮي ،ﺑﺮﺍﻭﻥ ﻭ ﺷﻮﻟﻴﻦ .( ١٩٨٦ ١ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺖ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺭﺍﻧﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺩﻳﺮﺗﺮ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎﺳـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﻣـﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧـﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳـﺮﻋ ِ ﻞ ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﺶ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺶ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ ) ﺳﺮﻋﺖِ ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ﻭﺍﮐﻨ ﹺ ( .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺩﻳﺮﺗﺮ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ! ) ﻣﻮﺳﮑﻮﻭﻳﺘﺰ ،ﻫﺎﻟﺒﺮﺕ ﻭ ﻣـﮏ ﮔﻠـﻮﺗﻴﻦ . ( ١٩٧٦
: causal ١ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻋﻠﻲ ،ﺳﺒﺒﻲ ،ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﻋﻠﺖ ﻭ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻝ lethargy ٢
٢
٣٠٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﮎ ﺁﻥ ) ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺗﻬﻮﻉ ،ﺍﺧـﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺧـﻮﺍﺏ ( ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﺧﻴﻠﻲ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮ ِ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺎً ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﻣﻼﻳﻢ ﻭ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﻣﻨﻈﻢ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﺕ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺩﭼـﺎﺭ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻫﺎي ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﮑﻼ ِ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ :
ﻖ ﺍﻳﺠـﺎ ِﺩ ﺳـﺮﻣﺎﺧﻮﺭﺩﮔﻲ ،ﺁﺳـﻢ ﻭ ﺑﺮﻭﻧﺸـﻴﺖ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑـﺮ ِﺩ ﺳﻴﺴـﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺗﻨﻔﺴـﻲ -١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ. -٢ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺩﺭﺟﻪ ي ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍﺯ ﮐﺎﺭ ﮐﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﮎ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻤـﻲ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻞ ﻣﻮﺛﺮ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺸـﺠﻮﻳﺎﻧﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﻳﻞ ﻭ ﮐﺮﻳﺴـﺘﻲ (١٩٧٤ ) ١ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨـﺪ ﻋﻤﻠﮑـﺮ ِﺩ ﺗﺤﺼـﻴﻠ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﻪ ي ﺩﺍﻧﺸﺠﻮﻳﺎﻥ ﻳﮑﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺼـﺮ ِ ﺩﺭﺍﺯﻣﺪﺕ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺎ ِﺩ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺧﻮﺕ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺪي ٢ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻑ ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣـﺪﺕ ﻭ ﺯﻳـﺎ ِﺩ ﮐﺎﻧـﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺩﺭ ﻣـﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻴـﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥِ -٣ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣـﻲ ﻲ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﻪ ،ﺗﺴﺘﺴﺘﺮﻭﻥ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺖ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) .ﭘﻴﻨﻞ ( ١٩٩٧ -٤ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺟﺴـﻤﻲ ﻣـﻲ ﮔـﺮﺩﺩ .ﭼـﺮﺍ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻑ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻤﻨ ﹺ ﮎ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ. ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ
Christie & Brill ١ Tennan & Rey ٢
٣٠٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ : ﻑ ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ) ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ( « ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﮔﺰﺍﺭﺵ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺖ » ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻟﻬﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ،ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ي ﺧﺸﻢ، ﻦ ﺁﻥ ﻓﻮﺭﺍﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮ ﻋﺎﺩ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ ،ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﺁﻟﻮﺩﮔﻲ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺭي ﻭ ﺗﻨﺎﻧﺖ . ( ٢٠٠٢ﻋﻠ ِ ي ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺗﺮﺍﮐ ﹺﻢ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ THCﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻭ ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻫﻢ ﻳﮏ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﹺ ﻗﻮي ﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ. ﻑ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ ﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻁ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻃﻮﻟﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻮﺋﺪ ،ﻫﻠﻨﺪ ،ﻧﻴﻮﺯﻟﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ﻫﻤﮕﻲ ﻭﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎ ِ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎ ِ ﻑ ﺶ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸ ﹺ ﺚ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﻣﺤﻘﻘﺎﻥ ﻣﺸﻐﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﻧﻬﻔﺘﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻳﺎ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﻲ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
٣٠٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ: ١ ﺕ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ :ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﺑﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. -١ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ :ﺁﻥ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ. -٢ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ
ﺢ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺩﻭﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﺷﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ، ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢﹺ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑـﺮ ﺳﻴﺴـﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼـﺒﻲ ﻧﻴﺴـﺖ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪﻧﻲ ﻏﻴﺮﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺑـﻪ ﺩﺭﻭﻍ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪﻧﻲ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈـﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﮐـﺮﺩ .ﻋـﻼﻭﻩ ﺑـﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﺍﻧﺘﻈـﺎﺭﺍﺕِ ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﻫـﺮ ﻓﺮﻫﻨـﮓ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺞ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ،ﻧﺘـﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘـﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺎﻧـﺪ ﻭ ﻫـﺎﻝ ، (١٩٨٦ ) ٢ﻧﺸـﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺭﻭﻍ ﺑـﻪ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﮔﻔﺘـﻪ ﺷـﺪﻩ ﺑـﻮﺩ ﮎ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷـﺪﻧﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﻲ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺳﺖ ،ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ي ﻣﺤﺮ ِ ﺁﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺭﻧﺪ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪﻧ ﹺ ﻑ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﻲ ﺱ ﮔﻨﺎ ِﻩ ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺻﺮ ِ ﻲ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮ ﻭ ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻧﺪ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ. ﻞ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ ،ﺑﻴﻦ ﻓﺮﺩي ،ﻭ ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﻁ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺰﻣﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻔﺮ ِ ي ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ : alcoholism ١ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻧﻮﻋﻲ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ ،ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ. Bond & Hull ٢
٣١٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ: ١ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺗﻨﻬـﺎ ﺑـﻪ ﺑﺮﺧـﻲ ﺍﻓـﺮﺍﺩ ) ﻫﺮ ﮐﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﺤﺴﻮﺏ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ( ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ ) .ﮐﻼﻧﻴﮕﺮ ،( ١٩٨٧ ) ( ٢ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﺩﻭ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : -١ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺋﻤﻲ : ٣ﮐﺴـﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻮﻻً ﻫﺮ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺮﺍﻳﺸﺎﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺩﺷـﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺷـﻴﺪﻥ ﺩﺳـﺖ ﺑﮑﺸـﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﮔــﺎﻫﻲ ﺣﺘــﻲ ﺑــﻪ ﺻــﻮﺭﺕِ ﻧﺎﺷــﺘﺎ ﻧﻴــﺰ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. -٢ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮ ﺧﻮﺭ : ٤ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭﻟﻲ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺟﻠﻮي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻧﺪ.
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٠ cloniger ٢ steady drinkers ٣ binge drinkers ٤
٣١١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺍﺷـﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷـﺪ. ﺕ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺖ ﺍﻳﻨﮏ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺖ ﮐﻼﻧﻴﮕﺮ ،ﺑﻮﻫﻤﻦ ،ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺍﺭﺩﺳـﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻭﺍﻥ ﻧﻮﺭﻳﻨـﮓ ( ١٩٨٥ ) ١ﻳـﮏ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌـﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺯﻧـﺪ ﺧﻮﺍﻧـﺪﮔﻲ ٢ﺟﻬـ ِ ﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ : ﺖ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑ ﹺ ﺶ ﺑﺴﺰﺍﻳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧـﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻭﻝ ) ﺍﻟﮑﻠـﻲ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﺍﺋﻤـﻲ ( ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ،ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻥ ،ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺪ ﹺﺭ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺷﺎﻥ ،٣ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﻭﻟﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﺴﺘﻌ ِﺪ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻣـﺎ ﺍﻟﮑﻠـﻲ ﺑـﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﻀـﺎي ﺧـﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﻏﻴـﺮ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ. ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺯ ﻧـﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺩﻭﻡ ) ﺍﻟﮑﻠـﻲ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﺧﻮﺭ ( ﻭﺿـﻊ ﺑـﻪ ﮔﻮﻧـﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕـﺮي ﺳﺖ .ﺍﻟﮑﻠـﻲ ﺷـﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻧـﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺩﻭﻡ ﭼـﻪ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﻞ ﻣــﺮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭ ﭼــﻪ ﺑــﺮﺍي ﺯﻧــﺎﻥ ﻫــﻢ ﺑــﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ـ ﹺ ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑـﻲ ﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﻭ ﻫـﻢ ﺑـﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣـ ﹺ ﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻫـﺎي ﭘﺮﺧـﻮﺭ ﺍﮐﺜـﺮﺍً ﻭﺍﻟـﺪﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﭘﺮﺧــﻮﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧــﺪ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺴــﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧــﻮ ﹺﻉ ﺍﻟﮑﻠــ ﹺ ﻲ ﺷـﺪﻳﺪ ﺐ ﻳﮏ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨـﺪ ﺍﻟﮑﻠـ ﹺ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺻﺎﺣ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﻏﻴﺮ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ.
Cloniger , Bohman , Sigvardsson , Von Knorring ١ : adoption study ٢ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﻭﻃﻠﺒﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﻓﺮﺯﻧـﺪي ﻣـﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧـﺪ ).ﻧﻘـﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨـﮓ ﻋﻠـﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ ( ٣ﭘﺪﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ % ٥٠ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻭ ﻣﺸﺘﺮﮎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ – ﭘﺪﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻲ -ﻡ
٣١٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻂ ﺍﺳـﻤﻴﺖ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑـﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ﻞ ﮊﻧﺘﻴﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑـﺘﻼ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴـﻢ ﺗﻮﺳـ ِ ﺖ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﮎ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑـﺮ ﺭﻭي ﻳـﮏ ﮊﻥ ﺑـﺎ ﻧﺸـﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﺸـﻬﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮑـﻲ ﺍﺯ ( ١٩٩٢ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺪ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸـﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘـﺎ ِ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺘﻤﺮﮐﺰ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﮊ ِﻥ ﻣﺨﺼـﻮﺹ ﺩﺭ % ٦٩ﺍﻟﮑﻠـﻲ ﻫـﺎ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ % ٢٠ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺍﻳﻦ ﮊﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﮊﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.
ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﺒﺪ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻟﺪﻫﻴﺪ ١ﮐـﻪ ﻳـﮏ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺳﻤﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﺰﻳ ﹺﻢ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻟﺪﻫﻴﺪ ﺩﻫﻴﺪﺭﻭﮊﻧﺰ ، ٢ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻟﺪﻫﻴﺪ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻴﮏ ﮐـﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻨﺒﻊﹺ ﺍﻧﺮﮊي ﺳﺖ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً % ٥٠ﺁﺳﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺴـﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻤـﻲ ﺍﺳـﺘﺎﻟﺪﻫﻴﺪ ﺩﻫﻴـﺪﺭﻭﮊﻧﺰ ﺱ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﭼﻬﺮﻩ ﺷﺎﻥ ﺳـﺮﺥ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺁﺳﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻫﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ acetaldehyde ١ acetaldehyde dehydrogenase ٢
٣١٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﭼﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮊﺍﭘﻨﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻏﺮﺑﻲ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻤﺘـﺮ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻬﻴﻪ ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪﻩ ،ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺳﺘﺎﻟﺪﻫﻴﺪ ﺩﻫﻴﺪﺭﻭﮊﻧﺰ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻃﻲ ٢ﺭﻭﺯ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ.
ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺷﺪﻥ ﭼﻪ ﭘﻴﺎﻣﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺚ ﺳﻴﺮﻭﺯ ِ١ﮐﺒﺪ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧـﺪ ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻂ ﮐﺒـﺪ، ﻦ ﺗﻴـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ) ( B ١ﺗﻮﺳـ ِ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺗﺠﺰﻳـﻪ ي ﻭﻳﺘـﺎﻣﻴ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺪي ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﮐﻤﺒﻮ ِﺩ ﺗﻴﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻨﺠـﺮ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑـﻴﻦ ي ﻓﺮﺍﻣﻮﺷـﻲ ﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺳﺮﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻦ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ
٢
ﻞ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭ ﹺﻡ ﮐﺮﻭﺳﺎﮐﻮﻑ ٣ﮔـﺮﺩﺩ. ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺐ ﺁﮔـﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳـﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ﻣﺒـﺘﻼ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺴـ ﹺ ﺕ ﺟـﺪي ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻬﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺮﺍﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﻭ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎﺗﺸﺎﻥ ﺑـﺎ ﻣﺸـﮑﻼ ِ ﻣﻮﺍﺟﻬﻨــﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬــﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺎﻓﻈــﻪ ي ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣــﺪ ِ ﺕ ﺿــﻌﻴﻔﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭﻧــﺪ.٤
: cirrhosis ١ﺗﺸﻤﻊ ،ﺳﻴﺮﻭﺯ ،ﺍﻟﺘﻬﺎﺏ ﺑﻴﻨﺎﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﺎﻓﺘﻬﺎي ﻳﮏ ﻋﻀﻮ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﮐﺒﺪ -.ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﻟﻨﺪ Amnesia ٢ Korsakoff `s syndrome ٣ e ٤ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١١
٣١٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ: ١ ﻒ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺭﻧﺞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﺩ ﹺﻡ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺏ ﺭﺍﻫﻨﻤـﺎي ﺗﺸﺨﻴﺼـﻲ ﻭ ﻒ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﻭ ﻗﺎﻧﻊ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﭼﻨﺪﺍﻥ ﺳﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻴﺴـﺖ .ﮐﺘـﺎ ﹺ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ ﺕ ﺶ ﺍﺧـﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺕ ﺫﻫﻨﻲ ) ١٩٩٤ DSM –IVﺍﻧﺠﻤﻦ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﺎﻥ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎ ( ﺍﻋﺘﻴـﺎﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨـ ﹺ ي ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺁﻣﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻖ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺠﻤﻦ ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ) ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ( ﺭﻧﺞ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ،ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ٢ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻳـﮏ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ﻞ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ،ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﻭ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺍﻭ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﮐـﺮﺩﻩ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﻌﻨﻲ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻋﻼﺭﻏ ﹺﻢ ﺯﻳﺎﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ
e Addiction ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٢ dependence ٢
٣١٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ،ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ : ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ DSM _ IVﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺸﺨﻴ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ) ١ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺷـﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ(. ﺗﻼﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺼﺮﻓﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺷﮑﺴﺖ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﻭ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺗـﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺣـﺪي ﮐـﻪ ﻓـﺮﺩ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻣﻘﺮﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻓﺮﺩ ،ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺻﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﻣﻄﻤﺌﻦ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺳﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣـﻲ ﻳﺎﺑـﺪ ﻭ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ،ﺷﻐﻠﻲ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻔﺮﻳﺤ ﹺ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺗﻌﻄﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﭘـﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﻣـﺜﻼً ﻧﻮﺷـﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻤـﻲ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻂ ﮐﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮﮔﺰ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻧﮑـﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑـﻪ ﻫﻤـﻴﻦ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍﺭ ﻲ ﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﻧﺨﻮﺍﻫـﺪ ﺩﺍﺷـﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻫﻴﭻ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮي ﺑﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻟﮑﻠ ﹺ ﻲ ﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻟﮑﻠ ﹺ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺕ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ » ﺗﺤﻤﻞ « ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻓـﺮﺩ ﻣﺠﺒـﻮﺭ ﺷـﻮﺩ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﺭﺳـﻴﺪﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﻟـﺬ ِ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﻘﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻓـﺮﺩ ﻧﺴـﺒﺖ ﺶ ﺑﻌﺪ ،ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﻫﻴﻢ. ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .١ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨ ﹺ tolerance ١
٣١٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻞ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﻨﺪ ؟ ﭼﻪ ﭼﻴﺰي ﺑﺎﻋِﺜﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺌﻠﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ : -١ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺞ ﺳﺮﻋﺖِ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ﻭ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﺰﻩ ﺷﺪﻥ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﻓـﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻳﺎﺑـﺪ. ﻂ ﮐﺒﺪ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘـﻪ ﻑ ﭘﻴﺎﭘﻲ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺁﻧﺰﻳﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺳﺮﻋﺖِ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ي ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.
ﺕ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣـﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈـﺮ ﭘـﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺖ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ -٢ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ،ﺣﺴﺎﺳﻴ ِ ﺖ ﺳﺎﺑﻖ ،ﻣﻘـﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻴﺸـﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣـﻮﺭﺩ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺕ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﻴﺸـﺘﺮي ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﺳﻴﺪﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﻟـﺬ ِ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﺪ. -٣ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻞ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺮ ﹺﺯ ﺷﮕﻔﺖ ﺁﻭﺭي ﻣﻬﻢ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑـﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧـﻪ ،ﻟـﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑـﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ(١٩٧٩ ) ٢ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺷﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ. ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺷﺪﻧﺪ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫﺎي ﺻﺤﺮﺍﻳﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﺎﻥ ﺍﺗﺎﻕ ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﺷﺪ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﻧﺴـﺒﺖ ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ) .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺩﻣـﺎي ﺑـﺪﻥ ﻣـﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﭘـﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺷـﻴﺪ ِﻥ ﻂ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﮐﻤﺘﺮ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺖ (.ﺍﻣﺎ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺤﻴ ِ ﻞ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ ﺭﺥ ﻧﺪﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﻣﺎي ﺑـﺪ ِﻥ ﻣـﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ﻫﻤـﺎﻥ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍﺭ ﺟﺪﻳﺪي ﺗﮑﺮﺍﺭ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﺤﻤ ﹺ ﺶ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺛﺒﺖ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ! ﮐﺎﻫﺸﻲ ﺭﺍ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺮﻭ ﹺﻉ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ
e ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٣ Le et al ٢
٣١٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮ ﻓﺮﺩي ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺧﺎﺹ ،ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﺷﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ ) ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ( ﺩﭼﺎﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺣﺮﻓﻪ ﺍي ﺩﻭ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﮔﻮﺳﻮﭖ(١٩٩٥ ١
ﭼﺮﺍ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ؟ ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ( ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺖ ﺍﺑﺘﻼ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ) ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ : ٢ﻃﺒﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣـﻪ ﻣـﻲ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪ ﺗـﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛـﺮﺍﺕ .١ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺐ ﺗﺮﮎ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ ) ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ( ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ. ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪي ﮐﻪ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ، ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺵ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ : ٣ﻃﺒﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ .٢ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ ي ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺑﺮ ﻣﺴﻴﺮﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﹺ
ﻲ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻭ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺭﺳ ﹺ
Gossop ١ physical dependence theory ٢ positive reward theory ٣
٣١٨
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﻧﻈﺮﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ : ﺐ ﻃﺮﻓﻓﺪﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﻘﺎﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ ﮐﮐـﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻴـﺎﺩ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠـ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑـﺪﻧﻲ ﺑـﻪ ﻲ ﺑﺪﺪﻧﻲ « ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻞ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ ﺝ ﻣﻌـﻴﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻴـﺎ ﹺ ﮏ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﺳﺖ ﻪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﭼﻨﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺎﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﻣـﻮﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈـﺮ ﻣﺒﺮﺮﻣﻲ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻲ ﮎ ﺟﺟﺪي ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮ ِ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﻧﺒﺎﺷﺷﺪ ،ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﮕﻲ ﺑـﺪﻧﻲ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕ ﻪ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪﻪ ،ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺘ ﻣﺼـﺮﻑِ ﻑ ﺳـﻮي ﺁﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺩﻭ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ،ﻣﻌﻌﺘﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺭ ﮕﻲﹺ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﮐﻪ " ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺽ ﻓـﺮ ِﺩ ﺕ ﺩﺩﻳﮕـﺮ ﻫﻨﮕـﺎﺎﻣﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺳﺎﺯﺩ " .ﺑﺑﻪ ﻋﺒـﺎﺭ ِ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻲ ﺗﺮﮎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮎ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ي ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ي ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ﭼﺎ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮎ ﻳﺎ ﮐﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺎﺩ ،ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﺑﺑﻪ ﺗﺮ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﺷﺪﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﻧﺎﭼــﺎﺭ ﻦ ﻏﻴﻴﺮﻣﺘﺨﺼﺼـﺎﺎﻥ ،ﻫـﻮﺍﺩﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻈﺮﻳـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑـﻴ ﹺ ﻪ ﭘﻴﻨـﻞ .(١٩٩٧ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻑ ﻣﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﺩﻫﺪ ) .١ﻞ ﺖ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﻧﺘﻘﺎﺩ ﻫﺎي ﺟﺟﺪي ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﺷﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ :
ﺐ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻋﮑﺲ ﻋﻮﺍﻗ ﹺ ﺖ ﺲﹺ ﻋﻮﺍﻗﺒﻲ ﺩﺭﺳ ِ ﻲ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺍﻧﺪﺪﺍﺯﺩ ﺗﺎ ﻲ ﺽ ﻣﺎﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﮔﻴﺮﺩ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ ﻣﮑﺮﺭﺍً ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﺮ ﹺ ﺍ ١ﻣﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺣﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﻝﹺ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻣﻐﺰ ﺑﺎ ﮐﻤﻤﮏ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻫﺪ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﻑ ﺁﺁﻥ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺣﻔﻆ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﻭﻟﻲ ﻫﻤﻤﻴﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺎﻻ ﻣﻘﺎﻭﻡ ﻫﻢ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻟﺬﺕ ﻪ ﻢ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻧﺒﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪﺪ .ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻧﺎﺧ ﺕ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺎﺩﺩﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﺮﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻧﺸﺎﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﺭﺍ ﺲ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﺑﺑﻮﺩ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪﺪي ﮐﻪ ﻋﮑ ﹺ ﻩ ﮑﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﺷﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑِ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺩﻫﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑ ﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﺪ ﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺍﻧﮕ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﻴﻌﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ – ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻠﺨﻴﺺ ﺍﺍﺯ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻫﻴﻠﮕﺎﺎﺭﺩ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻲ ﺗﺮﮎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻣﺎﻥ ﺪ ﮎ ﭼﺎﭖ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي (٢٢ ﭖ
٣١٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻲ ﺑـﺪﻧﻲ ﺣﻤﺎﻳـﺖ ﻧﻤـﻲ • ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ ﺑﺪﺳﺖ ﺁﻣﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺵ » ﺳﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ « ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺳﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ ،ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗـﺪﺭﻳﺞ ﮐﻨـﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷـﺘﻪ ﻣـﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻭ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻴﭻ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻲ ﺕ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ،ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﻳﺰﺩ ( .ﺍﮔﺮ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﺩﭼﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ ﻒ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ }.ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐـﻪ ﻇـﺎﻫﺮ ﺷـﺪﻥ ﻧﺸـﺎﻧﻪ ﻫـﺎي ﺚ ﺗﻮﻗ ِ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺳﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺫﮐﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳـﻖ ﺳـﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳـﻲ ﺣـﺬﻑ ﻣـﻲ ﺖ ﻧﺎﺗﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺎﺭﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺗﺮﮎ ﮐﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ { ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﭼﻴ ﹺﺰ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺭﺍ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ،ﺑﺴـﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺘـﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﻳـﮏ ﻑ ﺕ ﮐﻤﻲ ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍً ﺷﺮﻭﻉ ﺑـﻪ ﻣﺼـﺮ ِ ﺖ ﺳﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪ ِ ﺭﻭﻧ ِﺪ ﺳﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ ١ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﻓﻘﻴﺖ ﭘﺸ ِ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻓﺮﺽ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ • ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺣﺘﻤﺎً ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ،ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺍﺳـﺖ .ﺍﻣـﺎ ﺍﺳــﺘﺜﻨﺎﻫﺎي ﺑﺴــﻴﺎﺭي ﻧﻴــﺰ ﻭﺟــﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐــﻪ ﻑ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺭﺍ ﺛﺎﺑـﺖ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ .ﺑـﺮﺍي ﺧﻼ ِ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺁﻣﻔﺘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﮎ ﺟـﺪي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺪﺭﺕ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺑﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮ ِ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﮐﺎﻻﺕ( ٢٠٠٠ ٢
detoxification ١ Kalat ٢
٣٢٠
٣٢١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺢ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﺣﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑـﻪ ﻫﻤـﻪ ي ﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ﺗﻮﺿﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﻢ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺪﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍً ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺷﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﺳـﺖ. ﺫﺭﺍ ِ ﻞ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﺴـﺎﻟﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨـ ِﺪ ﺷـﺮﻃﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺳﺘﺎ ،ﮐﻮﺏ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ١٩٩٣ ) ١ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﻟﻴـ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗـﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﺕ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ي ﻗﺎﺑـ ﹺ ﺷﺪﻥ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﻓﺮﺽ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻭ ﻣﺤﻴﻄﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺷـﺮﻃﻲ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﻳﺎ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ
٢
ﻑ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﻭ ﺁﻭﺭﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗـﻊ ،ﻣﻌﺘـﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺶ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻣﺠﺪﺩﺍً ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﺎً ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺮﮔﺮﺩﺍﻧﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺷـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺕ ﻣﻨﻔـ ﹺ ﺗﻤﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺍﺛـﺮﺍ ِ ﺗﺮﮎ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﻨﺪ ﻣﺎﻳﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﻣﺠﺪ ِﺩ ﻑ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .٣ﻣﺜﻼً ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ » ﻫﻴﻮﻻﻫﺎي ﺳﻮﺯﻧﻲ « ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺯﻳـﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐـﻪ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻓـﺮﻭ ﮐـﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺳﻮﺯﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﻟﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻟـﺬﺕ ﻣـﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ. Koob et al ١ ﺕ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ .ﻫﺮ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﺛﺮي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﺳﺎﺯي ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻬﺘ ﹺﺮ : conditioned effects ٢ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺖ ﻦ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﺳﺎﺯي ﮐﻼﺳﻴﮏ ﻭ ﺍﺑﺰﺍﺭي ﺑﺎﺧﺒﺮ ﺑﺎﺷﻴﺪ .ﻣﮑﺎﻧﻴﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﺳﺎﺯي ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﺴ ِ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻗﻮﺍﻧﻴ ﹺ ﺭﻭﺱ ،ﺍﻳﻮﺍﻥ ﭘﺎﻭﻟﻮﻑ ﮐﺸﻒ ﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﺳﺎﺯي ﮐﻼﺳﻴﮏ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺷﺮﻃﻲ ﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ي ﺍﺑﺰﺍﺭي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺳﺘﺎﻭﺭ ِﺩ ﺑﻲ ﺍﻑ ﺍﺳﮑﻴﻨﺮ ﺱ ﺁﻣﺮﻳﮑﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎ ﹺ e ٣ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١٤
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺍﺭﺯﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ : ﻣﻔﻴﺪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺪ 9ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻣﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢﹺ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻪ ﺐ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺭﺩ ﭘـﺲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﮐﻨـﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷــﺘﻦ ﻣـﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣـﻮﺭﺩ ﻧﻈـﺮﺮ، ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺭ 9ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﻪ ﺗﺮﮎ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﮎ ﺳﻢ ﺯﺩﺍﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﺩﺭﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﺍﻋﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺜ ﻞ ﻢ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻊ ﺑﺎ ﺷﮑﺴﺖ ﺭﻭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ، 8ﺍﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺩﺭ ﺗﻀﺎﺩ ﺖ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ « ﺭ ﺑﺎ ﭘﻴﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻂ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﭘﻴﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﻲ 8ﻧﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺷﺪﻳ ِﺪ ﺗﺮﮎ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺩﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ).ﻣﺜﻼً ﺩﺩﺭ ﮐﻮﮐﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺁﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ( ﺘﮕﻲ ﺑـﻪ ﻣـﻮﻮﺍﺩ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺩﻫﻨـﺪﻩ ١ي ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻋﺘﻴــﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻭﺍﺑﺴـﺘﮕ ﺶ ﺵ 8ﻃﻃﺮﻓﺪﺍﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻈﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻧﻲ ،ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﻧﺎﺩﻳﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺮﻧﺪ.
ﮑﻠﻴﻒ ﻋﺮﺿﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﻞ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺗﮑ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻭ ﺭﺍﺿﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ : rewardd ١ﭘﺎﺩﺩﺍﺵ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﮐﮐﻠﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺮ ﺭﺧﺧﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺎ ﭼﻴﺰي ﮐﻪ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺶ ﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻔﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﻭ ﻣﻔﻬﻮ ﹺﻡ » ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ « reeinforcementﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﺷﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺑﺮﺮﺧـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣـﻮﻟﻔﻔﻴﻦ ﺖ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺷﻮﺩ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺷﺒﺎﻫﻫ ِ ﺩ ﺪﺍﻧﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﺟﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻣﻔﻬﻮﻡ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺎً ﻳﻳﮑﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺁﻥ ﺩﺩﻭ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﺑﺪ
٣٢٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺵ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ: ١ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻂ ﻭﺍﻳﺰ ) ( ١٩٩٦ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ :ﻃﺒ ﹺ ي ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻣﺨﺘﺼﺮ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺽ ﮐﻠﻴﺪ ﹺ ﻓﺮ ﹺ ﺚ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧـﺪ .ﺯﻳـﺮﺍ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ي ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ " ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺴﺌﻮ ﹺﻝ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻫﺎي ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻟﺤـﺎﻅ ﺯﻳﺴـﺖ ﺷـﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻫﻤﻴـﺖ ) ﻣﺜـﻞ ﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ : ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ،ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ".٢ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭ ِ
ﻲ ﻣﻐـﺰ ﮐـﻪ ﻣﺮﺑـﻮﻁ ﺑـﻪ ﻲ ﺍﺻﻠ ﹺ • ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻧﻈﻴـ ﹺﺮ » ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋـﻪ ﺏ ﺑﺨــﺶ ﻣﻴــﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻐــ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸــﻴﻦ ،« ( MFB ) ٣ﻧﺎﺣﻴــﻪ ﺍﻋﺼــﺎ ﹺ ﮐﻼﻫﮑﻲ -ﺷﮑﻤﻲ ،( VTA ) ٤ﻫﺴـﺘﻪ ي ﺁﮐـﻮﻡ ﺑﻨـﺰ ٥ﻭ ﭘـﻞ ﻣﻐﺰ ٦ﺟﺎي ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. • ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷـﺪﻳﺪﺍً ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺮﺍﮐ ﹺﻢ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤـﻴﻦ ﻧـﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺑـﺎﻻ ﻣـﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ) .ﻭﺍﻳﺰ .( ١٩٩٦
positive reward theory ١ ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺭﺍ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺣﺪي ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺒﺮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ٢ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎً ﺑﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺭﻧﺪ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺘﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺸﻮﻕ ﻫﺎي ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ) ﻏﺬﺍ ،ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻭ ( ...ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻄ ﹺ medial forebrain bundle ٣ ventral tegmental area ٤ nucleus accumbens ٥ pons ٦
٣٢٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﭘﻴﺪﺍ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣـﻲ ﻳﺎﺑـﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩي ﺧﻮﺩ ﻟﺬﺕ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ ،ﺑﺴـﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻖ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ي ﺭﺍﺑﻴﻨﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺑـﺮﻳﺞ ،( ١٩٩٣ ) ١ﺑـﺮﺍي ﻓﻬـ ﹺﻢ ﻑ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ! ﭼﺮﺍ ؟ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻗﺎﺋﻞ ﺷﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ، ﺕ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﻟﺬ ِ ﺕ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻦ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺕ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺑﺨﺸﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺳـﺖ .ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻞ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﻟﺬﺕ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ ﺑﻠﮑﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﮐﺜـﺮﺍً ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺩﻟﻴـﻞ ﻞ ﺑـﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻟﺬﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎﺳﺖ ﺩﺳﺖ ﻳﺎﺑﻨﺪ } .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧـﻮﻉ ﻟـﺬﺕ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﺑـﻪ ﺩﻟﻴـ ﹺ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ » ﺗﺤﻤﻞ « ﺭﻭﺯ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﺮ ﻭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺗﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ{.
Berridge & Robinson ١
٣٢٤
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺷﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮎ : ﺷﻨﺎﺳـﺎﻳﻲ ﺟﺎﻳﮕـﺎﻩِ ﻳﻳـﮏ ﻲ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﺗﻼﺵ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻲ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺩﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺗﻮﺳﺳﻂ ﺍﻭﻟﺪ ﻭ ﻣﻴﻠﻨـﺮ١٩٥٤ ) ١ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﻣــﻮﺵ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﺖ (ﺻ ﺻــﺤﺮﺍﻳﻲ ) ﺭﺍﺕ ﻫـــﺎ ( ﺭﺍ ﺁﻣــﻮﻮﺯﺵ ﺩﺍﺩ ﺗــــﺎ ﺑــﺎ ﻲ ﻫــﺎي ـﭙﺘﺎﻝ ٢ﻣﻐــﺰ ﺧــﻮﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺸــﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﻳــﮏ ﺍﺍﻫــﺮﻡ ،ﻧﺎﺣﻴــﻪ ي ﺳـ ﻝ ﻣﻮﺵ ﻫـﺎ ي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﻘﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﺵ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳﮏ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﮕﻴﺰي .( ٣ﺁﻧﻧﻬﺎ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﮕ ﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﺪ ﺷﺪﻳﻳﺪﺍً ﺗﻼﺵ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ ﺗﺗﺎ ﺑﺘﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺸﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﺍﻫﺮﻡ ،ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐـﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﻬـﺎ ﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺍﻫﺮﺮﻡ ﺭﺍ ﻓﺸﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺗﺎ ٢٠٠٠٠ﺑﺎﺭ ﺭ ﻲ ﻖ » ﺧﻮﻮﺩﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰي « ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻧﺪ. ﺍﺯ ﻃﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺳـﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺑﺨـﺶﹺ ﻭﺳـﻴﻊ ﺯ ﺗﺤﺮﻳـﮏ ﻳـﮏ ﺶ ﮏ ﺍﻭﻟـﺪﺯ (١٩٦٣ ٤ﻧﻧﺸـﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﮐـﻪ ﺯ ﻟﺪﺯ ﻭ ﺑﻌﺪي ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﻭﻟﺪ ﺕ ي ﺗﺤﻘﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﹺ ﺏ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ » ،ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻐﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ « ) ﺑﺨﺶ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺭ ﻟﻴﻤﺒﺒﻴﮏ ﻭ ﺩﻳﺎﻧﺴﺴﻔﺎﻟﻴﮏ ﻧﻴﺰﺰ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺶ ﺖ ﻭﻳﮋﻩ ﺍﺍي ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ. ( MFﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻤﻴ ِ FB ﮏ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻮﺍﺍﺣ ﹺ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻉ ،ﻳﺎﻓﻓﺘﻪ ي ﮐﻠﻴﺪي ﻲ ﺁﮐﺴـﻮﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﺁﺯﺯﺍﺩ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨـﺎي ﺁﻧﺴﺴـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﺩﻭﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺶﹺ ﻧﻘـﺶ ﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻣﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺩﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺵ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻣﻐ
Olds & Milnerr ١ ﻲ » ﻧﺎﺣﻴﻪ ي ﺟﺟﺪﺍﺭي « ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻤﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. : septall ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻭﺍﮊﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﺷﻮﮐﻲ ﺑﻪ » ﻣﺮﮐﺰ ﻟﺬﺕ « ) ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺳﺨﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﺐ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻲ : self - stimulationﺧﻮﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰي :ﺩﺩﺭ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕِ ﺣﻴﻴﻮﺍﻧﻲ، s n٣ ﻲ ﺩﮐﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭ ﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي ( ﮓ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﺵ ( ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ Olds & Oldss ٤
٣٢٥
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﻧﻘـﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻦ ﺷـﻮﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣـﺪﺍﺍﺭﮎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺍﺑﺑﻄـﻪ ﺑـﺎ ﺶ ي ﻣﻨﺎﺳـﺒﻲ ﻲ ﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻭ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ،ﺭﺭﻭﺵ ﺩﻭﭘﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴ ﻣــﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺵ ﺑــﺎ ﺍﺳــﺘﻔﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺍ ﻭﺟـــﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﺩﺭ ﺍﻳــﻦ ﺭﻭﺵ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﻲ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ،ﮔﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴﺪﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺭﻭﺩ ،ﻳﻦ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﻴـﺰي ﺩﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫــﺎ ﺑﺎﻋـﺚ ﮐــﺎﻫﺶ ﺩ ﻫﻤﮑـﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ﺶ ﺣﻴﻮﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷـﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﺭﻭﻭﺯﻧﺰﻭﻳـﮓ ﻭ ( ٢٠٠٢ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ،ﻣﻄﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭﻭي ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﺍﺳـﺖ ﮐﮐـﻪ ﺑﮑـﺎﺭ ﺑــﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻮﻧﻴﺴـﺖ ﻫـﺎي ﻥ ﺑﺮﮔـﺮ ﻭ ﻦ ﻣﻣﻴﻞ ﺷـﺪﻳﺪ ١ﺑـﻪ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﺋﻴﻦ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﻮﺩ ) .ﺮ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ،ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﻦ ﻫﻤﮑـﺎﺭﺍﻥ .( ١٩٩٦ ٢ﺍﺳـﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﺯ ﻑ ﺁﻣﻔﺘــﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻫـﺎ ﻧﻴــﺰ ﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼ ﺕ ﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷ ﹺ ﺁﻧﺘﺎﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻫﺎﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻨﺮﺮﮊﻳﮏ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺳﺎ ِ ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﺜﻼً ﻭﺍﺍﻳﺰ ﻭ ﺑﻮﺯﺍﺭﺕ ﺕ .( ١٩٨٤
ﻧﻮﺷـﻴﺪﻥ ﻭ ﺭﺍﺑﻄـﻪ ي ﻥ ﻣﻬﻢ ﻃﺒﻴﻌـﻲ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺴـﺘﻲ ) ﻣﻣـﺜﻼً ﺧـﻮﺭﺩﺩﻥ، ﺺ ﺷﻮﺩ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻫﺎي ﹺﻢ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺖ ﺷـﺪ. ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺰي ﺑﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺷﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﺪ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﺎﺕ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﻪ ﺕِ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻨﺴﺴﻲ ( ،ﺩﺭ ﻫﻤﻤﺎﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺷﻲ ﺶ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ) . ﺚ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻋ ) ﻭﺍﻳﺰ ( ١٩٩٦ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﺍﺍﺳﺘﺎ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﺠﺎ ِﻥ ﺟﻨ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻣـﺎﻳﺮﻧﻮﻳﮑﺰ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻻﻻﺕ ( ٢٠٠٠ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺍﺭﺭﺍﺋﻪ ي ﺁﺏ ﻣﻴﻮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻴﻤﻤﻮﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻄﺢﹺ ﺷﻮﻟﻟﺘﺰ( ١٩٩٦ ٣ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺧﺎﺹ .ﺣﺣﺎﻟﺘﻲ ﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻩ ﺵ ﻗﻮي ﺑﺮﺮﺍي ﻳﮏ ﭼﻴﺰ ﺧﺸﻨﻮﺩ ﮕﻴﺰ ﹺ : cravingg ١ﺍﺷﺷﺘﻴﺎﻕ ،ﻣﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﺪﻳﺪ ،ﻫﻮﺱ ،ﻭﻳﻳﺎﺭ :ﻣﻴﻞ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻧﮕ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺩﻗﺖ ﻭ ﻭﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﮐﻨﺪ) . ﺐ ﺧﺸﺸﻨﻮﺩي ﻭي ﻲ ﻋﻼﻗﻪ ﻣﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻩ ﺍي ﮐﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺁﻥ ﺍﺍﺭﮔﺎﻧﻴﺴﻢ ،ﺑﻲ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺁﺭﺍﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻪ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩﺩ ( Berger B et all ٢ M Mirenowiczz & Schultzz ٣
٣٢٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺕ ﻖ ﺳﻴﺴـﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘـﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺍﻋﻤـﺎﻝ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪ ؟ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘـﺎ ِ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺗﺸـﺎﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳـ ﹺ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﺮﺳﺶ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ : ﺶ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻳﺴﻴﺘﻪ ﺍﻧﺠـﺎﻡ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﺪ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨ ِﺪ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳ ﹺ .١ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﻓﺸﺮﺩ ِﻥ ﺍﻫﺮﻡ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ.ﺍﻳﻦ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠـﻪ ﺁﻣﻔﺘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ، ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ،ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ،ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﺲ ) ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ( ﺗﺎﻳﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻭﺍﻳﺰ ١٩٩٦ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺴـﺎﻟﻪ ﻖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ( . ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻏﺎﺑﺎً ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺵ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳـﺪﻳﻢ ،ﺑﺴـﻴﺎﺭي ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ .٢ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺧـﻮﺍﻩ ﺑـﻪ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﻣﺴـﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺧـﻮﺍﻩ ﺑـﻪ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﻏﻴـﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳـﺎﮎ ) ﻣﺜـﻞ ﻫـﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻣـﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ (، ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸـﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎ ) ﻣﺜﻞ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ( ،ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻭ PCPﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﺿـﺢ ﻧﻴﺴـﺖ ﮐـﻪ ﺖ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻳﺎ ﻧـﻪ .ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ، ﺁﻳﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺕ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺍﻭﺭ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﺗـﺎ ﺣـﺪي ﺑﺴـﺘﮕﻲ ﺑـﻪ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﮐﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) .ﺳﺎﻣﺴﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ.( ١٩٩٣ ١ ﺖ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺗﻮﺳﻂِ ﮐﻴﻮﻫﺮ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑـﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ( ١٩٩١) ٢ﮔـﺰﺍﺭﺵ ﮎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ .٣ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺪﺍﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﺨﺎﺑﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﺷﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻃﻲ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻨﺮﮊﻳﮏ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺧﺘﻨﺪ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻈﺮﻳـﻪ ي ﭘـﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻣﺜﺒـﺖ ﭘـﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨـﻲ ﺶ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﺩﻧﺪ. ﺕ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺑﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴﺎ ِ
Samson et al ١ Kuhar et al ٢
٣٢٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺖ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻭ ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭﻣﺴـﺎﻟﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ي ﺍﻋﺘﻴــﺎﺩ ﺍﻏــﺮﺍﻕ ﻧﮑﻨــﻴﻢ .ﺑــﺮﺍي ﻧﻤﻮﻧــﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴــﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻭﺍﻳــﺰ(١٩٩٦ ) ١ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺣﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ، ﺕ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ LSDﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ
ﻗﺮص هﺎﯼ اﮐﺴﺘﺎﺳﯽ
ﺍﻳﻨﮑﻪ ﺑﻪ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳـﮏ ﮐﻨـﺪ ،ﺑـﺎ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﮐﺴﺘﺎﺯي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻢ ﺑﺎﻋـﺚ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷـﺪ ِﻥ ﺕ ﻗﻮﻳﺘﺮي ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﻣـﻲ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﺗﺼﺎﻋﺪي ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ.
ﺍﺯ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺎﻻ ﭼﻪ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺍي ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ؟ ﻭﺍﻳﺰ ) ( ١٩٩٦ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺮﻭﺭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﭼﻨـﻴﻦ ﺟﻤـﻊ ﺑﻨﺪي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ : " ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﺍﻧﻲ – ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ، ﮏ» ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳــﺎﮎ ،ﻧﻴﮑــﻮﺗﻴﻦ ،ﻓﻨﺴــﻲ ﻟﻴــﺪﻳﻦ ﻭ ﮐﺎﻧــﺎﺑﻴﺲ ( ﺑــﺎ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ـ ِ ﻣﺸــﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺏ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻣﻴﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ « ) ( MFBﺳـﺮ ﻭ ﮐـﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ. ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍﻋﺼﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺗﺠﻤـ ﹺﻊ ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺴـﺘﻪ ي ﺁﮐـﻮﻡ ﺑﻨـﺰ ﻭ ﺗﻤﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ". ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﺎﻧ ﹺ
Carlezon & Wise ١
٣٢٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺍﺭﺯﻳﺎﺑﻲ : ﻲ ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫـﺎ ﻭ ﻣـﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﻴﺸـﻤﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠـﻪ 9ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺗﺎ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎ ،ﻣﺎﺭي ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺎ ﻭ PCPﺭﺍ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﺑﻴﻢ. ﺶ ﮐﻠﻴـﺪي ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ 9ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﻣﻐﺰ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺢ ﺧـﺎﺭﺝ ﺳـﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺶ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺁﺳﺘﺎﻧﻪ ي ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺮﺩﻥ ﺳﻄ ﹺ " 8ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩﺁﻭﺭ ﺑﺎﻋﺚِ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ) " .ﻭﺍﻳﺰ ( ١٩٩٦ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣـﺪﻝ ﭘﻴـﺮﻭي ﻧﻤـﻲ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨـﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮑـﻞ، ﮐﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ ،ﺑﺎﺭﺑﻴﺘﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺑﻨﺰﻭﺩﻳﺎﺯﭘﺎﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ. 8ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﮏ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ،ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻳﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ.
٣٢٩
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺩﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ،ﻣﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺧﻼ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺏ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﺱﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺩﺍﺭﻭي ﮐﮐﻨﺪﺳﺎﺯ ﺖ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﮏ ﺭﺿـﺎﻳﺖ ﻭ ﺧﺮﺳـﻨﺪي ﺖ ﺐ ﺁﺁﻥ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ،ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ( ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻦ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ) ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﺕ ﺱ ﺳﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷـﻲ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻌﺎﻗـ ﹺ ﮕﺮي ﻭ ﻡ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﮕ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺮ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺳﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺩﺭﺍﺯﻣﺪﺕ ﻦ ﻋـﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﺍﻧـﺎﻳﻲ ﺩﺩﺭ ﺕ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻲ ﮔﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﺑﺮﻗﺮﺍﺭي ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﺎﺕ ي ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﻣﻲ ﺷﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺮﺩ ﺍﺣﺴﺎﺱ ﺳﺳﺮﺧﻮﺷﻲ ،ﻗﻗـﺪﺭﺕ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺷـﻴﺎﺭي ﻗﻗﺎﺑـﻞ ﺗـﻮﺟﻬﻬﻲ ﻑ ﺕِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﭘﺮﻳﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﮐﻨﺪ. ﻪ ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﺸﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻭﻭﺍﻥ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺩﺩﻫﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺭ ﮐﻮﮐـﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻫـﺮ ﺩﻭ ﺁﮔﮔﻮﻧﻴﺴـﺖ ﻫـ ﻦ ﺕ ﮐﻮﮐﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺁﻣﻔﺘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻴﻦ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﺸﺎﺑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ( . ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻲ ﺵ ﺰ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ ﻢﹺ ﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ) .ﻭ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ
٣٣٠
ﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ ﻣﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎ
ﺕ ﻓﮑـﺮﺮي ﺚ ﺍﻳﺠﺎ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻮﻫﻢ ،ﺧﻄﺎﻫﺎي ﺍﺩﺭﺍﮐﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳﻔﺎ ِ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻞ LSDﻭ PCPﻋ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍﻳﻲ ﻣﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﻮ ﺚ ﺍﺍﻳﺠـﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﺿـﻄﻄﺮﺍﺏ ،ﺍﻓﮑــﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﻣـﺪﺕ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻣـﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﺗـﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﺍﻧـﺪ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﻫﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻲ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﻧﻮﻳﺎﺎﻳﻲ ﻭ ﭘﺮﺧﺎﺷﺷﮕﺮي ﺩ ﺶ ـ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎﻋﻋﺚ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﺁﺭﺭﺍﻣﺶ ،ﺵ ي THCﻫﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻲ ﮐﺎﻧﺎﺑﻴﻨﻮﻮﻳﺪ ﻫﺎ ﺣﺎﻭﻭ ﹺ ﻞ ﻣﻴـ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺵ ﺧﻠﻘﻲ ﻭ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﮐﺎﺭﮐﺮ ِﺩ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜـﻞ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻣﻨﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺶﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﺍﺳﺘﻔﻔﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻃﻮﻻﻻﻧﻲ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻟﻮﺩﮔﻲ ﻳﺪ ﺳﺴﺘﻲ ﻭ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﺁﻟﻮ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﺩﻭﭘـﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﺩﺍﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎي ﻣﺤﺮﺮﮎ ( ﺢ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺎﺩ ﺁﻭﺭ ) ﺜﻼ ﻣﻐـ ﹺﺰ ﺑﺨـﺶ ﻣﻴـﺎﻧﻲ ـ ﺼـﺎﺏ ﺶ ﺠﻤﻮﻋـﻪ ﺍﻋﺼ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠـﻪ » ﻣﺠ ﺖ ﺘﻢﹺ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻓﻌﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺶ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﺘﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺭ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ « ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺕ ﻧﺎﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮑــﻞ ،ﮐـﺎﻓﺌﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻲ ﻧﺪﺍﺭﺩ . ﺑﺎﺭﺑﻴﺘﻮﺭﺭﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻘﺸﻲ
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﺟﻢ :
٣٣١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻞ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺮﺩﻡ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻌﺪﻳ ﹺ ] [١ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﮕﻮﻫﺎي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺶ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮﻫﺎي ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ) ﺏ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﺜﺒﺖ -٢ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺖ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ -١:ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﺗﺠﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺩﻭ ﻋﻠ ِ ﺽ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﻣﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﻖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﮕﻮ ،ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﺪ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﻡ ﺑﺎ ﻋﻮﺍﺭ ﹺ ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ( .ﺑﺮ ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٠٩ ﻧﻘ ﹺ
ﺐ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ ﺷﻮﺩ : ﻖ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺳﺒ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ] [٢ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﻏﺬﺍ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺶ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺚ ﮐﻢ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﺷﺘﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﻐﺬي ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﺶ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻦ ﻏﺬﺍ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺰﻳ ﹺ ﺐ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻝ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻀﻢ ﻭ ﺟﺬﺏ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺩﺳﺘﮕﺎ ِﻩ ﮔﻮﺍﺭﺵ ﺍﺛﺮ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺳﺒ ﹺ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻖ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮ ﮐﺒﺪ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺗﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ،ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻐﺬي ﮔﺮﺩﺩ. ﺖ ﻑ ﺧﺮﻳ ِﺪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﺳﺒﺐ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭِﮐﻤﺘﺮي ﭘﻮﻝ ﺟﻬ ِ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﺎ ﭘﻮﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺻﺮ ِ ﺧﺮﻳ ِﺪ ﻏﺬﺍ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﺩﺭ ﺧﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻏﻴﺮﻣﺮﻓﻪ ﻣﻮﺭﺩ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﭖ ﺷﺸﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٤ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ ،ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻩ.ﺍ.ﮔﺘﺮي – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺮﻭﺯﺍﻧﻲ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﭼﻬﺮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
ﻦ ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﺭ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺍي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ] [٣ﺟﺎﻟﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮي ﺍﺯ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺢ ﺍﺳﻴﺪ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﻻ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻧﻴﮑﻮﺗﻴ ﹺ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻞ ﺶ ﺗﻤﺎﻳ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﺳﻴ ِﺪ ﺍﺩﺭﺍﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻴﮕﺎﺭ ﮐﺸﻴﺪﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي - ٣٣٧ﻡ
٣٣٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻑ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠﺎً ﺩﻣﺎي ﻣﻐﺰ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ] [٤ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺖ ﺢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ PETﺍﺳﮑﻦ ﻫﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺖ ﭼﭗ ( ﺩﺭ ﻣﻐﺰ ِ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮ ِﺩ ﻋﺎﺩي ) ﺗﺼﻮﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺳﻤ ِ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻓﺮﺩي ﮐﻪ ﮐﻮﮐﺎﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺫﮐﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭي ﮐﻪ ﺖ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ، ﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ي ﺁﺑﻲ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻑ ﮔﻠﻮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎ ﹺ ﻑ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺰ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺮﻣﺰ ﺣﺎﮐﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺰ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﺢ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ي ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻣﻨﺒﻊ Onken LS, Blaine JD, Boren JJ. Integrating behavioral therapies with medications in the : treatment of drug dependence. Rockville, MD: National Institutes of Health, National Institute on Drug Abuse. ١٩٩٥
][٥ﺩﻭ ﻧﻮﻉ ﮐﻢ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺶ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ : ﺶ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺁﻥ ﻣﻲ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﻧﺪ. ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﻟﺬﺕ ﮔﺮﺍ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺍﺛﺮ ﻟﺬﺕ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺯﻧﻨﺪ. ﺍﻓﺮﺍ ِﺩ ﺭﻭﺍﻥ ﺭﻧﺠﻮﺭ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺧﻼﺻﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﺩﺳﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰ ﻳﺎ ﺍﺟﺘﻨﺎﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺁﻭﺭﻧﺪ، ﻞ ﺗﻔﺮﻳﺢ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻄ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻥ ) ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ( ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١٣ – ٣٠٨
٣٣٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻑ ﻣﺘﺎﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ) ﮐﺮﻳﺴﺘﺎﻝ ( ي ﺍﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺖ ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ١٤ﻣﺎﻩ ﺧﻮﺩﺩﺍﺭ ﹺ ] [٦ﺑﻬﺒﻮ ِﺩ ﻭﺿﻌﻴ ِ
ﺖ ﭼﭗ :ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻳﮏ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺳﺎﻟﻢ • ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺳﻤ ِ ﺕ ١ﻣﺎﻩ ﻑ ﺁﻣﻔﺘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺪ ِ ﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ • ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﻭﺳﻂ :ﻣﻐ ﹺﺰ ﻓﺮﺩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﺎﺭ ﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﺍﺳﺖ :ﻣﻐﺰ ﻓﺮﺩ ١٤ ،ﻣﺎﻩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﮎ • ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺳﻤ ِ • ﺡ ﺑﺎﻻي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﮓ ﻗﺮﻣﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺼﻮﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻻ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ي ﺳﻄﻮ ﹺ ﺭﻧ ِ ﮓ ﺁﺑﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺒﺰ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺭﻧ ِ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻣﻨﺒﻊ Onken LS, Blaine JD, Boren JJ. Integrating : behavioral therapies with medications in the treatment of drug dependence. Rockville, MD: National Institutes of Health, National Institute on Drug Abuse. ١٩٩٥
٣٣٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
] : working memory [٧ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﺎﺭي .ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ) ( short term memory ﻲ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﺍي ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ،ﺑﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴ ﹺ ي ﺑﻠﻨﺪﻣﺪﺕ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ي ﺳﺮﻳﻌﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺳﻴﻠﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺭﻣﺰﺷﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺕ ﮔﺬﺷﺘﻪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺷﺪﻩ ،ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻣﺰﻫﺎي ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻴﺎ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺡ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺖ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺪ ِ ﺍﻟﮑﺘﺮﻭﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ( ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﺎﭼﻴﺰ ﻧﮕﻬﺪﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕِ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻻﻥ ،ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻟﺤﻈﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺳﭙﺮﺩ ،ﺍﺯ ﻫﻔﺖ ﻗﻄﻌﻪ ي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﺗﺠﺎﻭﺯ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ،ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻦ ﻫﻔﺖ ﺭﻗﻤﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺫﻫﻦ ﺑﺴﭙﺎﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ،ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮐﺎﺭي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﻳﮏ ﺷﻤﺎﺭﻩ ﺗﻠﻔ ﹺ ﺕ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮔﻴﺮﻧﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺣﺴﻲ ﻭ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﻪ ي ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺩﺳﺘﮑﺎﺭي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎ ِ ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣﺪﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﺧﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﮑﺎﻥ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ. ﭖ ﻦ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ – ﺗﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻮﺭي ﻫﺎﻧﺲ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺎﻣ ِﺪ ﺑﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي – ﺣﻤﻴﺪﺭﺿﺎ ﺁﻗﺎ ﻣﺤﻤﺪﻳﺎﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻧﻮﻳ ﹺ ﺍﻭﻝ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٩ - ٨٤
ﻞ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺭﻓﻴﻦ ،ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﭼﻨﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ] [٨ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ،ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي pﺑﺮ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ) .ﺟﺎﻑ ﻭ ﻣﺎﺭﺗﻴﻦ ،١٩٩٠ﺩﺍﻳﮑﺴﺘﺮﺍ ( ١٩٩٢ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺶ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ﺩﺧﻴﻞ ي Pﺩﺭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﺭﺩ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﺳﺮﻭﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١٥
٣٣٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
] [٩ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ﭼﻪ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺩﺭ ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﮔﻔﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻪ ي ﺵ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻌﺪي ﻁ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺎﺩﺍ ﹺ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺖ ،ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎ ِ ﺖ ﻞ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﻴ ِ ﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺑﺎ ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺳﺮ ﻭ ﮐﺎﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻳﺪ ،ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﺕ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﺳﻴﻨﺎﭘﺲ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﻲ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﺗﻘﻮﻳﺘ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬﺎي ﺁﺯﺍﺩﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي GABAﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﭼﺮﺍ ﻏﻴﺮﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ؟ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ GABA .ﻧﻴﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺗﺮ ﮔﻔﺘﻴﻢ ،ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺯﺩﺍﺭي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ،ﻣﻲ ﻞ ﻏﻴﺮﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ) .ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ي ﺩﻭﭘﺎﻣﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺕ ﺗﺮﻳﺎﮎ ،ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﻣﺸﺘﻘﺎ ِ = ﻣﺜﺒﺖ (
٣٣٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻪ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺮ ﻫﻤﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : ي ،DSM-III- Rﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻖ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ] [١٠ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﺖ ﺭﻭﺯﺍﻧﻪ ﻑ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺯﻳﺎ ِﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺑﺎ ﮐﻔﺎﻳ ِ .١ﻧﻴﺎﺯ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﺁﺧ ﹺﺮ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ﻲ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻌﻄﻴﻼ ِ ﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻃ ﹺ .٢ﺑﺎﺩﻩ ﻧﻮﺷ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻁ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﭘﺮﻫﻴﺰ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﻪ ي ﺑﻴ ﹺ .٣ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻃﻮﻻﻧ ﹺ ﻫﻔﺘﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺎﻩ ﻫﺎ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ ،ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻭﻳﮋﮔﻲ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺭ ِﺩ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ : ﺶ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻳﺎ ﻗﻄ ﹺﻊ ﺑﺎﺩﻩ ﺧﻮﺍﺭي ﻧﺎﺗﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺶ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻁ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻦ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﺎ ﭘﺮﻫﻴﺰﻫﺎي ﻣﻮﻗﺘﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺳﺎﺧﺘ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﮑﺮﺭ ﺑﺮﺍي ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻳﺎ ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﮐﻮﺷ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻋﺎﺕِ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻲ ﻣﻤﺘﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﺩﻭ ﺭﻭ ﹺﺯ ﭘﻴﺎﭘﻲ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺑﮑﺸﺪ. ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺴﺘ ﹺ ﺏ ﺗﻘﻄﻴﺮي ) ﻳﺎ ﻣﻌﺎﺩ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ﺁﺑﺠﻮ ﻳﺎ ﺷﺮﺍﺏ ( ي ﻣﺸﺮﻭ ﹺ ﻑ ﮔﺎﻩ ﺑﻪ ﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﻳﮏ ﭘﻨﺠ ﹺﻢ ﺑﻄﺮ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻓﺮﺍﻣﻮﺷﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﺎﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﻲ ﺭﻭي ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻭﺧﻴﻤﺘﺮ ﻣﻲ ﻲ ﺟﺪي ﮐﻪ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺩﺍﻧﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻞ ﺟﺴﻤ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ﻋﻼﺭﻏ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺴﺎﺋ ﹺ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ. ﻞ ﺳﻮﺧﺖ (. ي ﺍﻟﮑﻞ ،ﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺣﺎﻭ ﹺ ﺕ ﺻﻨﻌﺘ ﹺ ﻞ ﺷﺮﺏ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻻ ِ ﻞ ﻏﻴﺮﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻑ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺍﻣﺮﻭﺯﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﮐﺸﻮﺭﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻟﮑﻠﻴﺴﻢ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻳﮏ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺟﺮﻡ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : .١ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻣﺮﺿﻲ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺳﺎﺭﺍﺳﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﺠﺎﺭﻳﺎﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺭﺷﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٦ ﮓ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻭ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﭙﺰﺷﮑﻲِ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﭘﻮﺭﺍﻓﮑﺎﺭي .٢ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ
٣٣٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻞ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ) : ( FAS ] [١١ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻟﻬﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ،ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻟﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ » ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻟﮑ ﹺ « ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺐ ﻣﺸﺮﻭﺑﺎﺕِﺍﻟﮑﻠﻲ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﮐﻢ ﻣﺜﻼ ﻑ ﻣﺮﺗ ﹺ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ً ٩٠ﻣﻴﻠﻲ ﻟﻴﺘﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻭﺯ ،ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺣﺎﻣﻠﮕﻲ ﭘﻴﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﻋﻼﺋ ﹺﻢ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺕ ﻧﺎﻣﺮﺗﺐ ﻭ ي ﺭﺷﺪ ،ﺳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻮﭼﮏ ،ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﺪ ﹺ ﻲ ﮐﻮﺩﮎ .ﺑﺮﺁﻭﺭﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻲ ﺫﻫﻨ ﹺ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺮﻩ ﻋﻘﺐ ﺍﻓﺘﺎﺩﮔ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺳﺎﻟﻴﺎﻧﻪ ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ٥٠٠٠ﮐﻮﺩﮎ ﺑﺎ ﻳﮑﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻋﻼﺋ ﹺﻢ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻣﺘﻮﻟﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ.
ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﻐﺬﻳﻪ ،ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻩ.ﺍ.ﮔﺘﺮي – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻓﺮﻭﺯﺍﻧﻲ .ﻧﺸﺮ ﭖ ﺷﺸﻢ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٦ ﭼﻬﺮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ
٣٣٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ « ﻭ » ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ « ﺭﺍ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ « » ،ﺳﻮﺀ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺡ » ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﺳﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ] [١٢ﻻﺯﻡ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻒ » ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﻠﻲ ﺳﻮﺀ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ : « NIDA ﻖ ﺗﻌﺮﻳ ِ ﻣﺘﺬﮐﺮ ﺷﻮﻳﻢ :ﻃﺒ ﹺ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ) : ( Drugﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ " ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ) ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻣﺨﺪﺭ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﺯﺍ ( ﮐﻪ ﺚ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎ ً ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﭼﻨﺪي ﻲ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ،ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﮓ ﻭﺑﺴﺘﺮ ( ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺷﻮﺩ ) ".ﻓﺮﻫﻨ ِ ﻑ ﺍﺗﻔﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ » ﺗﺤﻤﻞ « ﻭ ﻳﺎ » ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ « ﺑﻪ ﻫﻨﮕﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ) : ( Useﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻦ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ. ﮐﻨﺎﺭﮔﺬﺍﺷﺘ ﹺ ﺳﻮﺀ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ) " : ( Drug Abuseﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﻧﺎﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐﹺ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ". ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻏﻴﺮﻗﺎﻧﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ي ﭘﻴﭽﻴﺪﻩ ي ﻣﻐﺰي ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ) " : ( Drug Addictionﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﻳﮏ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﻞ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ » ﺗﺤﻤﻞ « ﻭ » ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﮎ « ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺮﻭ ﹺﻉ ﺁﻥ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﻣﺸﺨﺼﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺁﻥ ﻣﻴ ﹺ ﺐ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺟﺴﺘﺠﻮ ﻭ ﺗﺪﺍﻭ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺣﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﻩ ي ﻋﻮﺍﻗ ﹺ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮﺀ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ي ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻓﺮﺩ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪ ﺯﻳﺎﺩي ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ِ ﻧﺎﺧﻮﺷﺎﻳﻨﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ .ﺟﺴﺘﺠﻮ ﹺ ﻑ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺕ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﺩﺭﺍﺯ ﻣﺪ ِ ﺍﺟﺒﺎﺭي ﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﺟﺒﺎﺭي ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﺪ ﻧﺎﺷﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻣﻐﺰ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ .ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ، ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺸﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻮﺀ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺣﺘﻲ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺸﺖ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭي ﺭﺥ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ » ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ « ﻭ » ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺡ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ « ﺟﺎﻳﮕﺰﻳ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺧﻴﺮ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺘﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺡ ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺖ ﺟﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﺭﺳﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ « ﮔﺮﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎ ﹺﻝ ،١٩٦٤ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻥِ ﺑﻬﺪﺍﺷ ِ ﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻳﻲ « ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﺁﻥ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻪ ﻧﻤﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ،ﮐﻠﻤﻪ ي ﺍﻋﺘﻴﺎﺩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﻲ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﻭ » ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕ ﹺ ﻫﻨﻮﺯ ﻫﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻊﹺ ﭘﺰﺷﮑﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻦ ﻋﻮﺍﻡ ﺭﺍﻳﺞ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻣﻨﺒﻊ ( http://www.nida.nih.gov :
٣٣٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻫﺸﺘﻢ
ﺖ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﺑﺎ ﺕ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺷﻲ ﻣﻌﺎﺻﺮ ،ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻫﺎ ﮐﻮﺷﺸﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻬ ِ ] [١٣ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭي ﺍﺯ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﺎ ِ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﺎﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﮔﺮ ﻫﻤﻪ ي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﮐﻮﺷﺸﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺍﺳﺖ، ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺭﺳﺪ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺩﺍﺩ ؟ ﻧﻈﺮﻳﻪ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﻣﺴﺘﻠﺰ ﹺﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﻲ ﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﭘﺮﺩﺍﺯﺍ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻮﺍﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺐ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻮﺍ ِﺩ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺎ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺍﺯ ﺳﺎﺯﻭ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗ ﹺ ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻭي ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﻏﺬﺍ ﻲ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ.ﺑﻪ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺭﺍﻫﻲ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﺮ ،ﺩﺭ ﻣﺴﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟ ﹺ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ،ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺦ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗﻲ ،ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺷﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻃﻮﺭي ﮐﻪ ،ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺟﺎي ﭘﺎﺩﺍﺵ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﭘﺎﺳ ﹺ ﻂ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ، ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺣﺪﺍﻗﻞ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺷﺮﺍﻳ ِ ﻦ ﭼﻨﻴﻦ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻓﻬﻤﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈﺮ ﮔﺮﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺵ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻕ .ﺗﻼﺷﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﻣﻌﮑﻮﺱ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻣﺪ. ﺑﺎﺯﺗﺎﺑﻲ ﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻼ ﹺ ﻦ ﺷﻤﺲ ﺍﺳﻔﻨﺪ ﺁﺑﺎﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ -ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣١ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴ ﹺ
ﺖ ﻣﺤﻴﻂ ﺩﺭ ﮔﺮﺍﻳﺶ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ،ﺫﮐﺮ ﻧﮑﺘﻪ ي ﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﻲ ﻓﺎﻳﺪﻩ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ :ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪ ﺏ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ] [١٤ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﺯﺍﻥ ﺩﺭ ﺟﻨﮓِ ﻭﻳﺘﻨﺎﻡ ،ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺍﺭﺗﺶ ﺗﺼﻤﻴﻢ ﮔﺮﻓﺖ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﺯﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤ ِ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺁﺯﻣﺎﻳﺶ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺷﺪ ﺗﻌﺪﺍ ِﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺠﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻳﮏ ﻦ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﺯﺍ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ % ٩٠ﺣﺘﻲ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺟﻨﮓ ﻭ ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺸﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮي ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎﺕ ،ﺍﺭﺗﺶ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺑﻴﻨﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻲ ﻑ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﺩﺍﻣﻪ ﺧﻮﺍﻫﻨﺪ ﺩﺍﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺑﺎﺯﮔﺸﺖ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺯﻧﺪﮔ ﹺ ﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ِ ﺕ ﺍﺭﺗﺶ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺷﮕﻔﺘﻲ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ١٥ﺩﺭﺻ ِﺪ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﮔﺎﻥِ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ،ﭘﮋﻭﻫﺸﮕﺮﺍﻥ ﻭ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﺎ ِ ﻖ ﻧﺘﺎﻳﺞ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ١٥ﺩﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﮐﺜﺮﺍً ﮐﺴﺎﻧﻲ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻞ ﺩﻗﻴ ﹺ ﻫﺮﻭﺋﻴﻦ ﺩﻭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺗﺤﻠﻴ ﹺ ﮓ ﻭﻳﺘﻨﺎﻡ ﻧﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻭﻗﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﺘﻨﺎﻡ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺮﺩﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﺗﺠﺮﺑﻪ ي ﺟﻨ ِ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﻣﺨﺪﺭ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﺠﺒﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﻣﻌﺘﺎﺩ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﺪ. ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﻓﺮﺍﻧﮑﻦ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻧﻲ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢٢ -٣٢٠
٣٤٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻬﻢ ﻓﺼ ﺘﻢ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﻳﺰ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻣﻮﻧﻬﺎ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ
٣٤١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ : ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻬﺎ ٣٤١ .......................................................................................................... ﻓﻬﺮﺳﺖ ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ ٣٤٢ .................................................................................................................................................... : ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ٣٤٣ ............................................................................................................................................... : ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ٣٤٤ ................................................................................................................................................................ : ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝﹺ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ٣٤٥ .. ………………………………………………………: ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟٣٦٠ ........................................................................................................................... ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢﹺ ﻏﺪﺩِ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ٣٦٢ ............................................................................................. ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ ٣٦٣ ................................................................................................................................................ : ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ٣٦٥ ................................................................................................................................... :
٣٤٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ: ١ ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ،ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻃﻲ ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﮔﻔﺘـﻪ ﺕ ﺑﻴﺸـﻤﺎﺭي ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﺮﭼﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ،ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ،ﺍﻣﺎ ﻓﻌـﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﻔﻌـﺎﻻ ِ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺎﻣﺶ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﺩ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ :ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ،ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ،ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﭘﺎﺭﺍ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ،ﻏﺪﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ،ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ﻭ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﻳﺎ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺻﻨﻮﺑﺮي. ﮐﺎﺭ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻭ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ٢ﻫﺎﺳﺖ .ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﺩي ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐـﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳـﺎ ِﻥ ﺧـﻮﻥ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻖ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪ ﻫﺎي ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺳﻮﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯ ،ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﺟﻨﺴـﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻫـﺪﺍﻳﺖ ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘـﺮﻝ ﻣـﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢﹺ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ -ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﻲ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.
ﺕ ﺧـﻮﺩ ) ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎ ( ﺭﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﭼﺮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﺩ ،ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ؟ ﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏـﺪﺩ ﻣﺤﺼـﻮﻻ ِ ﻁ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒِ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻣـﻲ ﺷـﻮﻧﺪ.ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗـﻊ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﻞ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺭﻳﺨﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺯﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻘﺎ ِ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺭﻳﺰ ،ﻏﺪﺩي ﺑﺪﻭ ِﻥ ﻣﺠﺮﺍ ٣ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ي ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺑﺎ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻣﺠـﺮﺍ ﻧﻈﻴـ ﹺﺮ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﺢ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﻣﻘﺎﻳﺴﻪ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﻖ ﻣﺠﺮﺍﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺍﺷﮏ ﻳﺎ ﻋﺮﻕ ﮐﻪ ﻣﺤﺼﻮﻻﺕِ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ
: Endocrine gland ١ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ :ﻫﺮ ﻏﺪﻩ ﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻓﻮﻕ ﮐﻠﻴﻮي ﻳﺎ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻬﺮﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﻥ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺮﺷﺤﻲ ﻖ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻟﻨﻒ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﺵ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣١٢ ﻂ ﻳﮏ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻟﻨﻒ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑﻲ :Hormone ٢ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ :ﻫﺮ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻖ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ) . ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣١٥ ductless ٣
٣٤٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ : ﺕ ﺷﮕﺮﻓﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭ ﺧﻮ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﺪ .ﺑـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻭﺟـﻮﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑـﻪ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻖ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺁﺭﺍﻣﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﻣﻲ ﮔﻴﺮﺩ ،ﻣﺪﺗﻲ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﺸﺪ ﺗـﺎ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﻞ ﮐﻠـﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣـﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺕ ﺭﻭﺯﻧﺰﻭﻳﮓ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻧﺶ ) ١٠ ،(١٩٩٩ﺍﺻـ ﹺ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺤﻘﻴﻘﺎ ِ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : .١ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠﻲ ﻭ ﺁﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. .٢ﺑﺮ ﺧﻼ ِ ﺐ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺎﺩﺭﻧﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﺪﺕ ﻭ ﻑ ﺑﺎﻭﺭ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﻲ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﻧﻤﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻏﻠ ﹺ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺭﺥ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺚ ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﻞ ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻞ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ .٣ﻫﻢ ﻋﻮﺍﻣ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﺛﺮﮔﺬﺍﺭي ﺑﺮ ﺭﻭي ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎ ،ﺑﺎﻓـﺖ ﺕ ﻣﺘﻌﻌﺪ ﻭ ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺷﺎﻣ ﹺ .٤ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. .٥ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳ ﹺﺮ ﮐﻢ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﻭ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﺎﮔﻬﺎﻧﻲ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻭ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﺖ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﭼﺮﺧـﻪ ي ٢٤ﺳـﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﺑـﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠـﻪ ﺳـﻄ ﹺ .٦ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺗﺤ ِ ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﺩﺭ ﻃﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺷﺒﺎﻧﻪ ﺭﻭﺯ ﻣﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. .٧ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﮐﺜﺮﺍً ﺑﺮ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ. .٨ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﮑﻲ ) ﺳﻮﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎﺯي ( ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺠﺰﻳﻪ ي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻫﺎ ،ﭼﺮﺑﻲ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮐﺮﺑﻮﻫﻴﺪﺭﺍﺕ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. .٩ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻫﺮ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺩﺭ ﻫﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﻮﺭي ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﺎ ﺟﺎﻧﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ. .١٠
ﻳﮏ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ .ﺑﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ،ﻫﺮ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺗﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺮ ﺳـﻠﻮﻝ
ﺺ ﺁﻥ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ. ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦﹺ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﺸﺨﻴ ﹺ
٣٤٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻞ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﺎﻳﻲ ﺗﺎﮐﻨﻮﻥ ﺗﻌﺪﺍﺩي ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻪ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻳﮕﺮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺮﺍﺣ ﹺ ﻭ ﮐﺸﻒ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﻪ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﺴﻴﻢ ﮐﺮﺩ : -١ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻨﻲ ) ١ﻣﺜﻼً ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ( ﮎ ﻓﻮﻟﻴﮑﻮﻝ ( -٢ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﭙﺘﻴﺪي ) ٢ﻣﺜﻼً ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﺤﺮ ِ -٣ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪي : ٣ﻫﻤـﻪ ي ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﺭﻭ ِﻥ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺩﺳـﺘﻪ ﺍﺯ ٤ﺣﻠﻘـﻪ ي ﮐـﺮﺑﻦ ي ﻣﻬﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺗـﻮﺍﻥ ﺑـﻪ ﭘﺮﻭﮊﺳـﺘﺮﻭﻥ ،٤ﺗﺴﺘﺴـﺘﺮﻭﻥ، ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺩﺍﻳﻮﻝ ،٥ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﺳﺘﺮﻭﻥ ٦ﻭ ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻝ ٧ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﺮﺩ.
ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﮐﻠﻲ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻨﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ( ﺕ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﮐﻢ ) ﭼﻨﺪ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻳﺎ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻪ ( ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑﻪ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪي ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺗﺴﺘﺴﺘﺮﻭﻥ ( ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺗﺎ ﭼﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺯ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﺁﺷﮑﺎﺭ ﻧﻤﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
protein hormones ١ peptide hormones ٢ estroid hormones ٣ progesterone ٤ estradiol ٥ corticosterone ٦ cortisol ٧
٣٤٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺼﺒﻲ : ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝﹺ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻋﺼ ﻞ ﻂ ﺍﻧﺘﻘـﺎﺎﻝ ﺗﻮﺳـ ِ ﻫـﺎي ﺍﺭﺳـﺎﻟﻲ ﺗﻮ ﻂ ﻫﻮﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎ ﻭ ﭘﻴـﺎﻡ ي ﺍﺭﺳﺎﻟﻲ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻲ ﻦ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﺳﻮﺍﻝ ﮐﻨﻴﻴﺪ ﭼﻪ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﺗﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺪ ﺼﺒﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ؟ ﺩﻫﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ ﺼﺒﻲ ﺷﺒﺎﻫﺖ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎ ﹺﻝ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻋﺼ .١ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ﺗﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﻻﻻﺯﻡ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﻧﻮﺭﻭﻧﻬـﺎ ﻧﻴــﺰ ﺳﺎﺯي ﺩﺭ ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﺫﺧﻴﺮﻩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺑﺮﺍي ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ي ﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ي ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ ﻫـﻢ ﺑـﻪ ﻋﻨـﻮﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻲ-ﻧﻴﻦ ( ١ﻫـ ﺳﻴﺲ -ﺗﻮ -ﻲ ﮐﻮ -ﻟﻪ – ﺲ .٢ﭼﻨﺪ ﻣﺎﺩﻩ ي ﺷﻴﻤﻴﺎﻳﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻞﹺ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﺎﻟﻴﻦ ،ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻮ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥﻥِ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﻋﺼﺒﺒﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻲ
ﻣﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ « ﺕ ﮔﻮﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺸﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺑﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧﺎﺎﺕ ﻭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺎ » ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﻫﺎ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ
choleecyctokininn ١
٣٤٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ : ﺩ ﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﻧﻘﻞ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻘﺎﻝ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻮﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﻭ ﻋﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﭼﻨﻨﺪي ﻧﻴﺰ ﻥِ ﮑـﻪ ﺪﻥ ﭘﺮﺍﮐﻨﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﺩﺭ ﭼﻨـﺪ ﻣﻣﻴﻠـﻲ ﺛﺎﻧﻴـﻪ ( ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺑﻪﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺭ .١ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ي ﺳﺎﻋﺖ ( ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ ) .ﭼﭼﻨﺪ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﻪ ،ﺩﻗﻴﻘﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺖ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺞ ﭘﺨﺶ ﻲ ﺁﻫﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺞ ﻲ ﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ي ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻦ ﻣﺎﻫﻴﭽﻪ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎ ،ﻓﻌﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻮ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻭﺍﺩﺍﺷﺷﺘ ﹺ ﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻌ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺍﺯﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ .٢ﭘﻴﺎﻡ ي ﻞ ﻏﻏﻴﺮﻣﺴـﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﮐﻨﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷـﮑ ﹺ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺍﻋﻤﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻥ ﺍﺯ ﻖﹺ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺩ ِﻥ ﮑـﻪ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺗـﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕِ ﮐـﺎﻣﻼً ﻣﺸﺸـﺨﺺ ﻭ ﻣﻮﻮﺿـﻌﻲ ﺩﺍﺭﻧـﻧـﺪ ﺩﺭﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑ ﻲ .٣ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﭘﺨﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ. ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺶ ﺳ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻﻻً ﺩﺭ ﻥ ﮑﻪ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭﺣﺎﻟﻴﮑ ﺼﺒﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼ ﺕِ .٤ ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﺑﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨﺪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺪﺪﺗﻲ
٣٤٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻞ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺟﻤﻊ ﺑﻨـﺪي ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ " : ﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﻭﺳﺘﻦ ) ( ١٩٩٦ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺐ ﻦ ﺩﻫﺎﻥ ﻭ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺮﻣﺨﺎﻃﺐ ﺍﺳﺖ ) .ﻣﺨﺎﻃ ﹺ ﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺗﻔﺎﻭ ِ ﻦ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻣﺜ ﹺ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺕ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﺩﻫﺎ ِﻥ ﻳﮏ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻭ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺪﺍﮐﺜﺮ ﭼﻨﺪ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺎﻟﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺭﺳﺎﻧﻪ ﻫـﺎي ﭘﺮﻣﺨﺎﻃـﺐ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧﻨـﺪ ﺩﺭ ﻳـﮏ ﻟﺤﻈـﻪ ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺻﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ" (.
» ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ «
» ﺍﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ « .١ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
.١ﺁﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
.٢ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣـﻲ
.٢ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﻏﻴ ﹺﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ
ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. .٣ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻭ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻲ ﺍﻳﺠـﺎﺩ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. .٤ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﮐﻮﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﺪﺕ ﻭ ﻣﻘﻄﻌﻲ ﺳﺖ.
ﮐﻨﺪ. .٣ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﺗﺎﺳ ﹺﺮ ﺑﺪﻥ ﭘﺨﺶ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﻧﺪ. .٤ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﺪﺕ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﻃﻮﻻﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺟﺮﻳﺎ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻗﻲ ﻣﻲ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ.
ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻗﺼﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﻳﻢ ﻧﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﺟﻤﺎﻟﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﺍﺻـﻠﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒـﺎﻁ ﺑـﺎ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺑﻴﺎﻧـﺪﺍﺯﻳﻢ : ﻒ ﻒ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳـﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺴـﻤﺖ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠـ ِ ﻞ ﺭﻭﺑﺮﻭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻴﺪ ،ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺷﮑ ﹺ ﺑﺪﻥ ﭘﺮﺍﮐﻨﺪﻩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ .ﻣﻤﮑﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺗﺼﻮﺭ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﮑـﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﻋﻤـﻞ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪ .ﺍﻣـﺎ ﻒ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻫﻤﺒﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻦ ﺑﺨﺶ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻤﻴﺸﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺩﺭ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺖ ﺑﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳـﺰ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴـﺰ ﻞ ﺗﻮﺟﻬﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ .ﻋﻼﻭﻩ ﺑﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﮐ ﹺ ) ﻭﺍﺑﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ( ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺗﻠﻘﻲ ﮐﺮﺩ. ﺑﺨﺸﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢِ ﻋﻤﻮﻣ ﹺ
٣٤٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺍﻣﺎ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﻲ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ،ﺑﺎﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺨﺶ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻐﺰ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ :ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻂ ﺖ ﺍﻋﻈ ـ ﹺﻢ ﺳﻴﺴــﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏــﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳــﺰ ﺗﻮﺳ ـ ِ ﻞ ﻣﻐــﺰ ﺍﺳــﺖ .ﻗﺴــﻤ ِ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗــﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺳــﺎﺧﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﮐــﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺩﺍﺧ ـ ﹺ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ،ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺻـﻮﺭﺕ ﻣـﻲ ﮔﻴـﺮﺩ .ﺑـﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﮐﻪ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺑﺮ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﺩ ﻭ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺳـﺎﻳ ﹺﺮ ﻞ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .١ﺍﮔﺮ ﺑﺨﻮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺗﺮ ﺳﺨﻦ ﺑﮕﻮﻳﻴﻢ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗـﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ) ﻣـﺜﻼً ﻋﺎﻣـ ﹺ ﮏ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻭ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷـﺪ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ﺚ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ي ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﺗﺮﻭﭘﻴﻦ ( ٢ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﻞ ﻣﻮﻳﺮﮒ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻳﺰي ﮐﻪ ﺁﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ١ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺑﺎ ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﻧﻤﺎﻳﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺵ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﺭﺷﺎﻝ ﺭﻳﻮ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﻳﺤﻴﻲ ﺳﻴﺪ ﻣﺤﻤﺪي ﻧﺸﺮ ﻭﻳﺮﺍﻳﺶ – ﭼﺎﭖ ﺩﻫﻢ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٥٤ corticotropin ٢
٣٤٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻂ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﻗﺴـﻤﺖ ﻫـﺎي ﺩﻳﮕـ ﹺﺮ ﺳﻴﺴـﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺳﭙﺲ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺑﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻧﻴﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﺎﺩﮔﻲ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﻌﻨـﻲ ﮐـﻪ ﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻂ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﻭ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤ ِ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﮏ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ،ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻓﻴﺪﺑﮏ ١ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ) ﻭﻳﮑﻨﺰ .( ٢٠٠٠ﻣﻨﻈﻮﺭ ﺍﺯ ﻓﻴﺪﺑ ِ ﻂ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻃﺮﻳـﻖ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ،ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺶ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﭘﻴﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﻁ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﺖ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ.٢ ي ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺗﺤ ِ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺭﻭﻧﺪ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ
ﻞ ﻂ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳ ﹺ : feedback ١ﺑﺎﺯﺧﻮﺭﺩ ،ﭘﺲ ﺧﻮﺭﺍﻧﺪ :ﺍﺳﺎﺳﺎ ً ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻋﻼﺋﻤﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺕ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺗﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﺮﺍي ﺭﻭﺷﻦ ﻳﺎ ﺧﺎﻣﻮﺵ ﮐﺮﺩﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺧﻮﺩ ﺁﻥ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺑﮑﺎﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻣﺜﻼ ً ﺗﺮﻣﻮﺳﺘﺎ ِ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺗﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺮﺍﺭ ِ ﺶ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﺕ ﺍﺗﺎﻕ ﻓﻴﺪﺑﮏ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﻳﮏ ﻣﺜﺎ ﹺﻝ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺳﺨﻨﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻣﺨﺎﻃﺒﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﺡ ﻓﻴﺪﺑﮏ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺷﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻒ ،ﮐﺎﺭﺑﺮﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﻔﺎﻭﺗﻲ ﺁﻳﺎ ﺳﺨﻨﺎﻧﺶ ﺧﺴﺘﻪ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻪ ،ﻓﻴﺪﺑﮏ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﺻﻄﻼ ﹺ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. e ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][١
٣٥٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ : ﺖ ﺑـﺎﻻي ﻏـﺪﻩ ي ﺖ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﻩ ،ﺍﻏﻠﺐ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ " ﭘﺎﺩﺷﺎ ِﻩ ﻏﺪﻩ ﻫﺎ " ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻫﻤﻴـ ِ ﻞ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ،ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﻞ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻲ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ.
ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ : ﻂ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ي ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨ ِﺪ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺗﻨﺪ ﺍﺯ : .١ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ ) ﺳﻮﻣﺎﺗﻮﺗﺮﻭﭘﻴﻦ :( ١ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﺟـﺐ ﺭﺷـ ِﺪ ﻒ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠ ِ ﺕ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﭘﺴـﺘﺎﻧﻲ ﺭﺍ .٢ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﭘﺮﻭﻻﮐﺘﻴﻦ : ٢ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺷـﺤﺎ ِ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﺕ ﻗﺸـ ﹺﺮ ﺁﺩﺭﻧـﺎﻝ ﺭﺍ .٣ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ : ٣ ACTHﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺷـﺤﺎ ِ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﮎ ﻓﻮﻟﻴﮑـﻮﻝ : ٤ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﺑﺨﺸـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﮐﻨﺘـﺮﻝﹺ .٤ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﺤـﺮ ِ ﺕ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ) ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ( ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺗﺮﺷﺤﺎ ِ ﺕ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. .٥ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺯﺭﺩ : ٥ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺗﺮﺷﺤﺎ ِ ﺕ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﮎ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﻳﻴﺪ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺷﺤﺎ ِ .٦ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﺤﺮ ِ
somatotropin ١ prolactin ٢ adrenocorticotrophic ٣ follicle –stimulating ٤ luteinising ٥
٣٥١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻢ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻫﻴﭙﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻴﻦ : ﻫﻴﭙﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﺴﻴﻦ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺩﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺗﺮﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ : ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻮﻥ ﻦ : ١ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ،ﻫﻮﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﮐﺎﻫﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﺩﺭﺍﺭ ٢ﻧﻴﺰ ﻪ .١ﻭﺍﺯﻭﭘﺮﺳﻴﻦ ي ﺁﺏ ﺑﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻮﺩ. ﮏ ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺟﻤﻊ ﺁﺁﻭﺭ ﹺ ﻣﻮﺟ ﹺ ﺐ ﺗﺤﺮﺮﻳ ِ ﺭﺣـﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻫﻨﮕـﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺯﺍﻳﻤـﺎﻥ ﻣــﻲ ﻑ ﻢ ﺽ ﺑﺎﻓﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺻ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺍﻧﻘﺒﺎ ﹺ .٢ﺍﮐﺴﻲ ﺗﻮﺳﺳﻴﻦ : ٣ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺚِ ﺻـﺎ ِ ﺩﻫﺪ ﺍﮐﺴﻲ ﺗﻮﺳﺳﻴﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻫ ﹺ ﺱ ﺍﺳـﺘﺮﺱ ﺍﺿـﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﻭ ﺏ ﺶ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺷﻮﺍﻫﻫﺪي ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﻧﺸﺸﺎﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺪ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺍﺭﺩ. ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻤﻮﺩﺍﺭ ﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺷﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ : ﺰ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺑﺮﺧﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺖ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻓﻴﺰ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﻩ
ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺰ ﻏﺪﻩ ي
ﭘﺴﻴﻦ
ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺍﮐﺴﻲ ﺗﻮﺳﻴﻦ
ﺭﺣﻢ ) ﺯﻫﺪﺍﻥ (
vasopressin v n١ Antidiureti A c٢ oxytocinn ٣
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﮐﺎﻫﻨﺪﻩ ي ﺍﺩﺩﺭﺍﺭ
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ
ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺗﺮﻭﭘﻴﮏ ﮏ
ﮔﻨﻨﺎﺩﻭﺗﺮﻭﭘﻴﮏ
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ACT
ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺭﺷﺪ
) ﺁﻧﺘﻲ ﺩﺩﻳﻮﺭﺗﻴﮏ (
ﮐﻠﻴﻠﻴﻪ ﻫﺎ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﻭﻳﺪ
ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫﺎ
ﻗﺸﺮ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ
ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ) ﻟﻮﺯﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﻩ (
٣٥٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫﺎ : ﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎي ﻣﺮﺩﺍﻧﻪ ﺑﻴﻀﻪ ﻫﺎ ١ﻭ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎي ﺯﻧﺎﻧﻪ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ٢ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺑﻴﻀـﻪ ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﻏﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴ ﹺ ﻂ ﻳﮑـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﺖ ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫـﺎ ﺗﻮﺳـ ِ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻭ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻳﺎ ﺍﻭﻭﻡ ٣ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .٤ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺟﺴ ﹺﻢ ﺯﺭﺩ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﮔﻨﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﺳﺎﻳﺮ ﻏـﺪﺩ ﺑـﺪﻥ ﺍﺯ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎﻳﻲ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ : ﺶ ﺳـﺎﺋﻖ ٦ﻭ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﻧـﺪﻩ ي .١ﺁﻧﺪﺭﻭﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ : ٥ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﺁﻧﺪﺭﻭﮊﻥ ،ﺗﺴﺘﺴﺘﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩي ﻧﻘـ ﹺ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻳﻔﺎ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. .٢ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ : ٧ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ٨ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ﺗﻨﻬـﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺨﻤـﺪﺍﻥ ﻫـﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴـﺪ ﻣـﻲ ﻲ ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺩﻳﻮﻝ ٩ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺭﺷ ِﺪ ﭘﺴﺘﺎﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻞﹺ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺎي ﺗﻨﺎﺳـﻠ ﹺ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺵ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺯﻧﺎﻧﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰ ﹺ ﻂ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ .٣ﮊﺳﺘﺎﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ : ١ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺯ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﻞ ﺣﺎﻣﻠﮕﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻤﭽﻨﻴﻦ ﺣﻔـﻆ ﺣـﺎﻣﻠﮕﻲ ﮐﻤـﮏ ﻣـﻲ ﻦ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﭘﺮﻭﮊﺳﺘﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺑﻪ ﺗﺴﻬﻴ ﹺ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺻﻠﻲ ﺗﺮﻳ ﹺ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. testes ١ ovaries ٢ ovum ٣ e ٤ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٢ androgens ٥ ﺖ ﻋﻀﻮي ﺩﺭﻭﻧﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮ ِﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺑﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺩ – ٢ .ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﻭ -١ : drive ٦ﻫﺮ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺣﺎﻟ ِ ﺁﺷﻔﺘﮕﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻌﺎﺩﻝ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﺯﻳﮏ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻣﺎﻧﻨﺪ ﮔﺮﺳﻨﮕﻲ ،ﺗﺸﻨﮕﻲ ،ﻭ ﻣﻴﻞ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﮐﻪ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺯﻧﺪﻩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺑﺮﻃﺮﻑ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﻦ ﺁﻥ ﺑﻪ ﮐﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺨﺼﻮﺻﻲ ﻭﺍﺩﺍﺭ ﻭ ﺭﻫﺒﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ – .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻓﺮﻫﻨﮓ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺷﻌﺎﺭي ﻧﮋﺍﺩ – ﻡ oestrogens ٧ e ٨ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٣ oestradiol ٩
٣٥٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
gestagens ١
٣٥٤
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻏﺪﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ : ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻي ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻭ ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ،ﻳﮏ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺑﻪ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧـﺎﻝ ،ﻏـﺪﺩ ﻓـﻮﻕ ﺖ ﺳﺎﻳ ﹺﺮﻏﺪﺩ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ. ﮐﻠﻴﻮي ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺩﻳﺪﻳﻢ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺗﺎﺛﻴ ﹺﺮﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺑﺮ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺷﮑﻞ ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ACTHﺗﻮﺳـﻂ ﻏـﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ،ﻏﺪﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺗﺤﺮﻳﮏ ﻏﺪﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﺍﺯ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ.
٣٥٥
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻲ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ١ﻭ ﻳـﮏ ﻻﻳـﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺮﻭﻧـﻲ ﺶ ﻣﻴﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺶ ﻣﺮﮐﺰي ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﻫﺮ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﻳﺎ ﻓﻮﻕ ﮐﻠﻴﻮي ﺍﺯ ﻳﮏ ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻗﺸ ﹺﺮ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ٢ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ : ﻲ ﻏــﺪ ِﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧــﺎﻝ ﻫﻮﺭﻣــﻮﻥ ﻫــﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ـ ﹺﺮ ﺍﭘــﻲ ﻧﻔــﺮﻳﻦ ) ﺁﺩﺭﻧ ـﺎﻟﻴﻦ ( ﻭ ﻧــﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔــﺮﻳﻦ ) ﺶ ﻣﻴــﺎﻧ ﹺ ﺑﺨ ـ ﹺ ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ( ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.٣ ﻗﺸــ ﹺﺮ ﺁﺩﺭﻧــﺎﻝ ﻧﻴــﺰ ﻭﻇﻴﻔــﻪ ي ﺗﺮﺷــ ﹺ ﻞ ﮐــﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻥ،٥ ﺢ ﺧــﺎﻧﻮﺍﺩﻩ ي ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳــﺪ ﻫــﺎ ٤ﺷــﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻫﻴﺪﺭﻭﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻥ ٦ﻭ ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﺳﺘﺮﻭﻥ ٧ﻭ ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻝ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ. ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻭﻇﺎﻳﻒ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳﺪ ﻫﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ : ﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﺗﺮ ﺑـﺮﺍي ﺑـﺪﻥ ﻞ ﭘﺮﻭﺗﺌﻴﻦ ﻭ ﭼﺮﺑﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺷﮑﻞ ﻫﺎي ﻗﺎﺑ ﹺ .١ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳﺪ ﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺗﺒﺪﻳ ﹺ ﮐﻤﮏ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﺏ ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﺍﻳﻤﻨﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ.٨ .٢ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺮﮐﻮ ﹺ ﻂ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ي ﺿﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﺎﺏ ١ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﮐـﻨﺶ ﺑـﻪ ﺟﺮﺍﺣـﺎﺕ ﺗﻮﺳـ ِ ﺕ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻗﻮ ﹺ .٣ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
ﻕ ﮐﻠﻴﻮي ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳﻤﺸﺎﻥ ﭘﻴﺪﺍﺳﺖ ،ﺩﺭ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻕ ﮐﻠﻴﻮي ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﻓﻮ ﹺ ﻲ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﻓﻮ ﹺ ﺶ ﺩﺭﻭﻧ ﹺ : adrenal medulla ١ﺑﺨ ﹺ ﺢ ﮐﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ. ﺳﻄ ﹺ adrenal cortex ٢ ﺶ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ِﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﻭ ﻓﺸﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺧﻮﻥ ( ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺑﺮ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ٣ﻫﻢ ﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﭘﻲ ﻧﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺍﻧﮕﻴﺨﺘﮕﻲ ) ﻣﺜﻼً ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺶ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺍﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ) .ﻓﺼﻞ ( ٥ ﺢ ﺑﺎﻻي ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺳﻨﺠ ﹺ ﻧﻘﺶ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻄ ﹺ glucocorticoids ٤ Cortisone ٥ hydrocortisone ٦ Corticosterone ٧ ﺕ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺍﻳﻤﻨﻲ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺳﺮﮐﻮﺏ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﻳﻬﺎ ﻭ ﺢ ﺩﺭﺍﺯﻣﺪ ِ ٨ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﺕ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﺢ ﺩﺭﺍﺯﻣﺪ ِ ﻋﻔﻮﻧﺖ ﻫﺎ ﺁﺳﻴﺐ ﭘﺬﻳﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﻋﻮﺍﻣﻠﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺗﺮﺷ ﹺ ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻨﺠﺎ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻘﺶ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺎﻥ ﺁﻭﺭ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﭘﻲ ﺑﺮﺩ ).ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮏ ﮐﺎﺭﻟﺴﻮﻥ ﺹ ( ٣٠٧
٣٥٦
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻏﺪﺩ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﻭ ﭘﺎﺭﺍ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ : ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ :ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﺩﺭﺳﺖ ﺯﻳ ﹺﺮ ﺣﻨﺠﺮﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘـﻪ ﺍﺳـﺖ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻏـﺪﻩ ﺍﺯ ﺧـﻮﺩ ﻲ ﺑـﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﮐﺴﻴﻦ ٢ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥ ﻣﻘـﺪﺍ ﹺﺭ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴـﺖ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺘـﺎﺑﻮﻟﻴﮑ ﹺ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﮐﺴﻴﻦ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓـﺮﺍﺩ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ » ﭘﺮﮐﺎﺭي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ « ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺍﻳﻦ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭي ،ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﻫﺎي ﺳـﻮﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﻳﺎﺑﺪ .ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﺍﮐﺜ ﹺﺮ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﺩﭼﺎ ﹺﺭ ﮐﻤﺒﻮ ِﺩ ﻭﺯﻥ ﻭ ﺑـﻲ ﺧـﻮﺍﺑﻲ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ. ي ﻋﻤـﻮﻣﻲ ﻣـﻲ ﺚ ﭼـﺎﻗﻲ ﻭ ﮐﻨـﺪ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻧﺸﺪ ِﻥ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﮐـﺎﻓﻲ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ ) .ﮐﻢ ﮐﺎﺭي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ (
ﮏ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴـﺖ ﻏﺪﺩ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ :ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ٤ﺗﺎ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳ ِ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﻣﺤﺪﻭﺩ ﺗﺮ ﺍﺳـﺖ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﻏـﺪﺩ ﻫﻮﺭﻣـﻮﻥِ ﮐﺎﻟﺴـﻴﺘﻮﻧﻴﻦ ٣ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣـﻲ ﻦ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﮐﻠﺴﻴﻢ ﺍﺯ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻮﺍﻥ ﺭﺍ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﺩﺍﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺑﺪﻳﻦ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺑـﺎﻻ ﺭﻓـﺘ ﹺ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﮐﻠﺴﻴ ﹺﻢ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ.
anti- inflammatory effects ١ thyroxin ٢ Calcitonin ٣
٣٥٧
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ) ﻟﻮﺯﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﻩ ( : ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺰﺩﻳﮑﻲ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﻭ ﻣﻌﺪﻩ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺷﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻬﻢ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ :ﺍﻧﺴـﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺎﮔﻮﻥ.١
ﻦ ﮔﻠﻮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺧﻮﻥ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ . ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ :ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺍﺯ ﺑﻼ ﺭﻓﺘ ﹺ ﺩﺭ ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺩﻳﺎﺑﺘﻲ ،٢ﺑﺪﻥ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻗﺎﺩﺭ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﮐﺎﻓﻲ ﺍﻧﺴـﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﮐﻨﺪ ،ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﻪ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﮔﻠﻮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺧـﻮﻥ ٣ﺑـﺎﻻ ﺭﻓﺘـﻪ ﻭ ﺳـﻼﻣﺘﻲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻄﺮ ﻣﻲ ﺍﻓﺘﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻋﺎﺭﺿﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮ ﹺﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻮﻩ ﻣﺮﮔﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﻣـﺎ ﻖ ﻣﺪﺍﻭ ﹺﻡ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ( ﺍﺯ ﺑﺮﻭ ﹺﺯ ﻖ ﺗﺰﺭﻳ ﹺ ﻣﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﺑﺎ ﮐﻨﺘﺮ ﹺﻝ ﺁﻥ ) ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺟﻠﻮﮔﻴﺮي ﮐﺮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮي ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﭼﻨﺎﻧﭽﻪ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ِﺪ ﻻﺯﻡ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺷﻮﺩ ،ﻣﻨﺠﺮ ﺑـﻪ ﭘـﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺢ ﻗﻨ ِﺪ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻭ ﻋﻼﺋﻤﻲ ﻧﻈﻴ ﹺﺮ ﺧﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺳﺮﮔﻴﺠﻪ ي ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺮﺩﺩ .ﻫﻤﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐـﻪ ﻣﻤﮑـﻦ ﺁﻣﺪ ِﻥ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺢ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺧﻮﺭﺩﻥ ﺭﺍ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻓﺼﻞ ( ١٠ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺣﺪﺱ ﺯﺩﻩ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ ،ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﻞ ﺟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷـﻮﺩ } .ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗـﻊ ﻣـﻲ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺎﮔﻮﻥ :ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻋﺚ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺧ ﹺ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﮔﻔﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﻋﮑﺲ ﻫﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ ) {.ﻓﺼﻞ ( ١٠
glucagons ١ diabetes mellitus ٢ blood – suger ٣
٣٥٨
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺻﻨﻮﺑﺮي: ١ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺻﻨﻮﺑﺮي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎً ﮐﻮﭼﮑﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎً ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺯﻩ ي ﻳﮏ ﻧﺨﻮﺩ ! ﺍﻳﻦ ﻏـﺪﻩ ﺩﺭ ﺑـﺎﻻي ﺳـﺎﻗﻪ ي ﻲ ﺳﻤﭙﺎﺗﻴﮏ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ .ﻏـﺪﻩ ي ﺻـﻨﻮﺑﺮي ﻣﻐﺰ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﮔﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺩﺭﻭﻧﺪﺍﺩ٢ﻫﺎي ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒ ﹺ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻧﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﻼﺗﻮﻧﻴﻦ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﻓﻘﻂ ﺷﺐ ﻫﺎ ) ﺩﺭ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﮑﻲ ( ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﺯ ﺶ ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺍي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻞ ﻧﻘ ﹺ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺭﻭ ﮔﺎﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺁﻥ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ » ﺩﺭﺍﮐﻮﻻ « ﻧﻴﺰ ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹺ ﺖ ﺑﺎﻻﻳﻲ ﺑﺮﺧﻮﺭﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ. ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ
Pineal gland ١ ﻂ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺩﺭﻳﺎﻓﺖ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ » ،ﺩﺭﻭﻧﺪﺍﺩ« ﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺩﺭ : input ٢ﺗﻤﺎ ﹺﻡ ﻣﺤﺮﮎ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ) ﺍﻃﻼﻋﺎﺗﻲ ( ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻳﮏ ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻦ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺖ ﻞ ﻋﻀﻼﻧﻲ ﻳﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴ ِ ﺐ ﻋﻤ ﹺ ﻞ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ،ﻭﺍﮊﻩ ي » outputﺑﺮﻭﻧﺪﺍﺩ « ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻨﺎي ﭘﺎﺳﺦ ) ﻳﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ( ﺍﺳﺖ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻗﺎﻟ ﹺ ﻣﻘﺎﺑ ﹺ ﻏﺪﻩ ﺍي ﺑﺮﻭﺯ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﻳﺎﺩﮔﻴﺮي ﻭ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝﹺ ﺣﺮﮐﺘﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺩﻳﺪﮔﺎ ِﻩ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﻋﺼﺐ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺳﻴﭻ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺮﺗﻀﻮي ﻧﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﺒﻠﻪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٨٩
٣٥٩
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺍﻫﻤﻴﺖ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺗﺎ ﭼﻪ ﺣﺪ ﺍﺳﺖ ؟
ﺕ ﻫﻤــﺎﻧﻄﻮﺭ ﮐــﻪ ﺩﻳــﺪﻳﻢ ،ﻫﻮﺭﻣــﻮﻥ ﻫــﺎ ﺗــﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍ ِ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﻭ ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺑﺮ ﻋﻮﺍﻃﻒ ﻭ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻧـﺎﺕ ﻭ ﻞ ﺭﻓﺘﺎ ﹺﺭ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺑﻨﺎﺑﺮﺍﻳﻦ ﺟﻬﺖِ ﻓﻬ ﹺﻢ ﮐﺎﻣ ﹺ ﻲ ﺍﻧﺴــﺎﻥ ،ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌــﻪ ي ﻫﻮﺭﻣــﻮﻥ ﻫــﺎ ﻭ ﭼﮕــﻮﻧﮕ ﹺ ﻋﻤﻠﮑﺮ ِﺩ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺿﺮﻭﺭي ﺳﺖ.
ﻲ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﻧﻤﺎﻳـﺎﻥ ﻣـﻲ ﺖ ﺣﻴﺎﺗ ﹺ ﺍﻫﻤﻴ ِ ﺷﻮﺩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈـﺮ ﺑﮕﻴـﺮﻳﻢ ﭼـﻪ ﺍﺗﻔـﺎﻗﻲ ﺧﻮﺍﻫـﺪ ﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺨﺘﻠـﻒ ﮐـﻢ ﻳـﺎ ﺍﻓﺘﺎﺩ ﺍﮔﺮ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺯﻳــﺎﺩ ﺷــﻮﺩ .ﺑــﺮﺍي ﻣﺜــﺎﻝ ،ﺍﻓــﺮﺍﺩي ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻈــﺮ ﺑﮕﻴﺮﻳﺪ ﮐﻪ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﺁﻧﻬـﺎ ﺑـﻪ ﻃـﻮﺭ ﻏﻴـﺮ ﻋﺎﺩي ﮐﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ :
ﺁﻧﻬﺎﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪي ﺑﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ ،ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﺑﺴﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻀـﻄﺮﺏ ﻭ ﺁﺷـﻔﺘﻪ ﻫﺴﺘﻨﺪ. ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩي ﮐﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﺑﺎ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﺗـﺮ ﺍﺯ ﻣﻌﻤـﻮﻝ ﻫﺴـﺘﻨﺪ ،ﺍﻏﻠـﺐ ﺍﻓﺴـﺮﺩﻩ ﺕ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺩﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﻮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﺷﻮﺍﻫﺪي ﻣﺒﻨﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻻ ِ
٣٦٠
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺑﺪ ﻧﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭ ﻣﻮﺭ ِﺩ ﺩﻳﮕﺮ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺍﺷﺎﺭﻩ ﮐﻨﻴﻢ : .١ﺩﺭ ﺑﺮﺧﻲ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻗﺸﺮ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﺑﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻌﻤـﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﻮﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﮑﻮﻳـﺪ ﺗﺮﺷـﺢ ﻣـﻲ ﮐﻨـﺪ .ﺍﻳـﻦ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺩ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺍﺯ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭ ﹺﻡ ﮐﻮﺷﻴﻦ ١ﺭﻧﺞ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺮﻧﺪ .ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺪﺭﻭﻡ ﺑﺎ ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎﻳﻲ ﻧﻈﻴـﺮ ﺍﻓﺴـﺮﺩﮔﻲ،٢ ي ﻣﻮ ﺩﺭ ﺑﺪﻥ ﻣﺸﺨﺺ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺧﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﻭ ﺗﻮﺯﻳ ﹺﻊ ﻏﻴﺮﻋﺎﺩ ﹺ ﻲ ﺶ ﺗـﺪﺭﻳﺠ ﹺ ﺚ ﺍﻓـﺰﺍﻳ ﹺ .٢ﺍﮔﺮ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ﺑﻪ ﻃﻮﺭ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻋـﺎﺩي ﮐـﺎﺭ ﮐﻨـﺪ ﻣـﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧـﺪ ﺑﺎﻋـ ِ ﺏ ﮐﻠﺴﻴﻢ ﺩﺭ ﻋﻘﺪﻩ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺎﻳﻪ ٣ﺷﺪﻩ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﻧﺘﻴﺠـﻪ ﻣﻨﺠـﺮ ﺑـﻪ ﻃﻴﻔـﻲ ﺍﺯ ﻧﺸـﺎﻧﻪ ﻫـﺎي ﻣﺸـﺎﺑ ِﻪ ﺭﺳﻮ ﹺ ي ﺍﺳﮑﻴﺰﻭﻓﺮﻧﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. ﺑﻴﻤﺎﺭ ﹺ ﺕ ﺭﻓﺘــﺎﺭي ،ﺁﻧ ـﺎﺗﻮﻣﻴﮑﻲ ﻭ ﺢ ﻧﺎﮐــﺎﻓﻲ ﻳــﺎ ﺑــﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺣ ـ ِﺪ ﻫﻮﺭﻣــﻮﻥ ﻫــﺎ ﻣــﻲ ﺗﻮﺍﻧــﺪ ﺍﺧــﺘﻼﻻ ِ ﺩﺭ ﻣﺠﻤــﻮﻉ ،ﺳــﻄ ﹺ ﻲ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺍﻳﺠﺎﺩ ﮐﻨﺪ.٤ ﻓﻴﺰﻳﻮﻟﻮﮊﻳﮑ ﹺ
Cushings syndrome ١ e depression ٢ﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎي ﻓﺼﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻉ ﮐﻨﻴﺪ ][٤ basal ganglia ٣ ﺶ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﻴﺎ ِﻥ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﺪﻥ ﻭ ﮐﻢ ﻭ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﮐﻨ ﹺ ٤ﺑﻪ ﻫﻢ ﺧﻮﺭﺩ ِﻥ ﻧﻈ ﹺﻢ ﭼﺮﺧﻪ ي ﻗﺎﻋﺪﮔﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠ ِ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻣﻴﺰﺍ ِﻥ ﻫﺮ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ) .ﻧﻘﻞ ﺑﺎ ﺍﻧﺪﮐﻲ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ( ٣٤٥
٣٦١
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﺧﻼﺻﻪ ي ﻓﺼﻞ :ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﻭ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ • ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺍﺯ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﺷـﺪﻩ ﺍﺳـﺖ .ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠـﻪ ﻏـﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙـﻮﻓﻴﺰ ،ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴـﺪ ﭘﺎﺭﺍﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ،ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ،ﭘﻴﻨﻪ ﺁﻝ ) ﺻﻨﻮﺑﺮي ( ،ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ) ﻟﻮﺯﺍﻟﻤﻌﺪﻩ ( ﻭ ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫﺎ ) ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ (. ي ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ. • ﮐﺎ ﹺﺭ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻳﺎ ﺁﺯﺍﺩﺳﺎﺯ ﹺ • ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺕِ ﺗﺪﺭﻳﺠﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﻭ ﻏﺎﻟﺒﺎً ﺑﺨـﺶ ﻫـﺎي ﻭﺳـﻴﻌﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺑـﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺑـﻪ ﺷـﮑﻞ ﻫـﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺗﺤﺖ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ. ﻂ ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﮐﻨﺘﺮﻝ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ. • ﺑﺨﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ • ﻫﻴﭙﻮﺗﺎﻻﻣﻮﺱ ﺩﺭ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﺑﺎ ﻏـﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙـﻮﻓﻴ ﹺﺰ ﭘﻴﺸـﻴﻦ ﺍﺳـﺖ. ﻂ ﭘﻴﺸﻴﻦ ﺑﻪ » ﭘﺎﺩﺷﺎ ِﻩ ﻏﺪﺩ « ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴ ِ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺑﻴﺸﻤﺎﺭي ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺑـﺪﻥ ﻣـﻲ ﺑﺎﺷـﻨﺪ .ﻣﺴـﺌﻮﻟﻴﺖ ﺗﺮﺷـﺢ • ﮔﻨﺎﺩ ﻫـﺎ ﻏـﺪ ِﺩ ﺟﻨﺴـ ﹺ ﺁﻧﺪﺭﻭﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺮﻭﮊﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﮊﺳﺘﺎﮊﻥ ﻫـﺎ ﺑـﺮ ﻋﻬـﺪﻩ ي ﮔﻨـﺎﺩ ﻫﺎﺳﺖ. • ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻝ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﮔﻮﻧﺎﮔﻮﻧﻲ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨـﺪ ).ﺍﺯ ﺟﻤﻠﻪ ﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ،ﻧﻮﺭﺁﺩﺭﻧﺎﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮐﻮﺭﺗﻴﺰﻭﻝ (. • ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﺗﻴﺮﻭﺋﻴﺪ ،ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻝ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﮐﺴﻴﻦ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﺗﻴﺮﻭﮐﺴﻴﻦ ﻣﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺳﻮﺧﺖ ﻭ ﺳﺎ ﹺﺯ ﺑﺪﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺍﻓﺰﺍﻳﺶ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ. ﺢ ﮔﻠـﻮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺧـﻮﻥ ﺭﺍ ﮐﻨﺘـﺮﻝ • ﭘﺎﻧﮑﺮﺍﺱ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮ ِﻥ ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﻭ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺭﺍ ﺗﺮﺷﺢ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﺍﻧﺴﻮﻟﻴﻦ ﺳﻄ ﹺ ﺚ ﺗﺤﺮﻳ ِ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ .ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺎﮔﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻋ ِ ﮏ ﺁﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﺪ ِﻥ ﮔﻠﻮﮐﺰ ﺩﺭ ﺧﻮﻥ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ.
٣٦٢
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
ﻳﺎﺩﺩﺍﺷﺖ ﻫﺎي ﻣﺘﺮﺟﻢ : ] [١ﺍﺯ ﺁﻧﺠﺎﻳﻴﮑﻪ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺭﻭي ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺍﺛﺮ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ ،ﺷﺎﻳﺪ ﻏﻴﺮﻋﺎﺩي ﺟﻠﻮﻩ ﮐﻨﺪ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺨﻤﺪﺍﻥ ﻫﺎ ﻧﻴﺰ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺑﻪ ي ﺧﻮﺩ ﺭﻭي ﻏﺪﻩ ي ﻫﻴﭙﻮﻓﻴﺰ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺑﮕﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺍﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﻗﻊ ﻧﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺍي ﺍﺳﺖ ﻋﺎﺩي ﺍﺯ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﻪ ﻓﺮﺍﻳﻨﺪﻫﺎي ﺟﺴﻤﺎﻧﻲ ﭼﮕﻮﻧﻪ ﺗﻨﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﻫﺮ ﮐﻨﺸﻲ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻً ﻭﺍﮐﻨﺸﻲ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻧﺒﺎﻝ ﺩﺍﺭﺩ :ﻳﮏ ﮏ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﺪ. ﻖ ﻓﻴﺪﺑ ِ ﻧﻈﺎ ﹺﻡ ﺧﻮﺩ ﻓﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻃﺮﻳ ﹺ ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﺖ ﻧﻔﺮﺁﺑﺎﺩي– ﻧﺸ ﹺﺮ ﻧﻮ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﺖ ﺯﻳﺴﺖ ﺷﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺛﺮ ﺁﻧﺘﻮﻧﻲ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻨﻲ – ﻣﺎﻩ ﻃﻠﻌ ِ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻳ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي٦٠
] [٢ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺩﺍﺭﺍي ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻡ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﮐﺮﻭﺯﻭﻣﻮﻫﺎي ﻣﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﺳﺖ .ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻧﻴﺰ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻂ ﺍﺳﭙﺮﻡ ﻳﮏ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﺍﺯ ﻫﺮ ﺟﻔﺖ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻡ ﻫﺎي ﭘﺪﺭ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺍﺭﺍﺳﺖ .ﻫﻨﮕﺎﻣﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺗﺨﻤﮏ ﺗﻮﺳ ِ ﺑﺎﺭﻭﺭ ﺷﺪ ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺠﻤﻮﻋﻪ ي ﻧﺎﻗﺺ ) ﻫﺎﭘﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ( ﮐﺮﻭﻣﻮﺯﻭﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻳﮑﺪﻳﮕﺮ ﭘﻴﻮﺳﺘﻪ ﻭ ﻳﮏ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ) ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ ( ﺭﺍ ﺗﺸﮑﻴﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﻨﺪ .ﺑﻪ ﺍﻳﻦ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﮐﺎﻣﻞ ،ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ) ﺗﺨﻢ ( ﮔﻔﺘﻪ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ .ﺯﻳﮕﻮﺕ ﺳﻠﻮﻟﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺕ ﺩﻭ ﺳﻠﻮ ﹺﻝ ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺣﺎﺻﻞ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﺩ ﻭ ﺩﺭ ﺁﻥ ﻫﺴﺘﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺩﻭ ﺳﻠﻮﻝ ﺑﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻳﮑﻲ ﻣﻲ ﺷﻮﻧﺪ .ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﻳﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺍﺯ ﻭﺣﺪ ِ ﻞ ﺩﻳﭙﻠﻮﺋﻴﺪ. ﺗﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﻧﺴ ﹺ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ : ﭖ ﺳﻮﻡ – ﮏ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﺭﺍﺑﺮﺕ ﭘﻼﻣﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻫﻤﮑﺎﺭﺍﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻧﻴﮑﺨﻮ ﻭ ﺁﻭﺍﺩي ﻳﺎﻧﺲ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﻣﻬﺘﺎﺏ – ﭼﺎ ﹺ ﮊﻧﺘﻴ ِ ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي٣٦ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺳﻮﺳﻴﻮﺑﻴﻮﻟﻮﮊي ﺍﺛﺮ ﺍﺩﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻳﻠﺴﻮﻥ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ي ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﻭﻫﺎﺏ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ – ﻧﻈﺮ ﺟﻬﺎﺩﺩﺍﻧﺸﮕﺎﻫﻲ ﻣﺸﻬﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢٥
٣٦٣
ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ :ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ
] [٣ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﻪ ي ﺍﺳﺎﺳﻲ ﺍﺯ ﺭﺷﺪ ﻭ ﺗﺤﻮ ﹺﻝ ﻓﺮﺩ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ : ﻦ ﻟﻘﺎﺡ ﻭ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ( .١ﺯﻣﺎ ِﻥ ﭘﻴﺶ ﺍﺯ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ) ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻲ ﺑﻴ ﹺ .٢ﺩﺭ ﻃﻲ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ ِﻥ ﺑﻠﻮﻍ ﻭ ﭘﺲ ﺍﺯ ﺁﻥ ) ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ (. ﺕ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺩﻫﻨﺪﻩ ﻣﺘﺨﺼﺼﺎ ِﻥ ﻏﺪ ِﺩ ﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺭﻳﺰ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺛﺮﺍﺗﻲ ﮐﻪ ﺩﺭ ﺩﻭﺭﻩ ي ﺟﻨﻴﻨﻲ ﺭﺥ ﻣﻲ ﺩﻫﺪ ،ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎً » ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ي ﺑﺮﺧﻲ « ) ( organizing effectsﻣﻲ ﮔﻮﻳﻨﺪ ،ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﻳﮏ ﺍﺛ ﹺﺮ ﻧﺴﺒﺘﺎ ً ﺩﺍﺋﻤﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﻨﺪ ﹺ ﺕ ﻫﻮﺭﻣﻮﻥ ﻫﺎ ﺭﺍ ﺩﺭ ﺳﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ،ﻫﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﻫﻢ ﺩﺭ ﺳﻴﺴﺘ ﹺﻢ ﺗﻮﻟﻴ ِﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﻲ ﮔﺬﺍﺭﻧﺪ .ﺩﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﺕ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﮐﻨﻨﺪﻩ ) ( activation effectsﻧﺎﻣﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﻧﺪ ،ﭼﺮﺍ ﮐﻪ ﺁﻧﻬﺎ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎي ﺧﺎﺻﻲ ﺭﺍ ﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﺑﺰﺭﮔﺴﺎﻟﻲ ،ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ِ ﻳﺎ ﺧﻨﺜﻲ ﻣﻲ ﮐﻨﻨﺪ. ﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٣٢٣ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
] [٤ﻃﺒﻖ ﺩﺳﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺪي ﺑﮏ ﻭ ﮔﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﺮﮒ ) ( ١٩٧٤ﻧﺸﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻓﺴﺮﺩﮔﻲ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﺳﺖ ﺍﺯ: ﺱ ﺑﻲ ﺍﺭﺯﺵ ﺑﻮﺩﻥ ﻖ ﻏﻤﮕﻴﻦ ،ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ .١ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﻋﺎﻃﻔﻲ :ﻳﮏ ﺧﻠ ﹺ ﺕ ﻣﻨﻔﻲ ﺩﺭﺑﺎﺭﻩ ي ﺁﻳﻨﺪﻩ ﻦ ﮐﺎﻫﺶ ﻳﺎﻓﺘﻪ ﻭ ﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﺭﺍ ِ .٢ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺘﻲ :ﺍﺣﺘﺮﺍﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﻳﺸﺘ ﹺ ﺵ ﭘﺎﻳﻴﻦ ﻭ ﻧﺎﺗﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺣﺮﮐﺖ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﺧﻮﻳﺶ ﺑﺮﺍي ﺍﻧﺠﺎﻡ ﺩﺍﺩ ِﻥ ﻓﻌﺎﻟﻴﺖ .٣ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰﺷﻲ :ﺍﻧﮕﻴﺰ ﹺ ﺶ ﺍﺷﺘﻬﺎ ،ﺍﺧﺘﻼ ﹺﻝ ﺧﻮﺍﺏ ،ﺑﻲ ﻋﻼﻗﮕﻲ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺍﺑﻄﻪ ي ﺟﻨﺴﻲ ،ﺗﻤﺮﮐ ﹺﺰ ﺿﻌﻴﻒ ﻭ .٤ﺟﻨﺒﻪ ﻫﺎي ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭي :ﮐﺎﻫ ﹺ ﺱ ﺧﺴﺘﮕﻲ ﺍﺣﺴﺎ ﹺ ﻲ ﺯﻧﺎﻥ – ﺍﺛﺮ ﺟﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﻴﺒﻠﻲ ﻫﺎﻳﺪ – ﺗﺮﺟﻤﻪ ﺩﮐﺘﺮ ﺧﻤﺴﻪ – ﻧﺸﺮ ﺁﮔﻪ ﻭ ﺍﺭﺟﻤﻨﺪ – ﺻﻔﺤﻪ ي ٤٤٩ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﺯ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳ ﹺ
٣٦٤
٣٦٥
ﻓﺼﻞ ﻧﻬﻢ: ﻣﺒﺎﻧﻲ ﺷﻨﺎﺧﺖ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ
: ﻣﻨﺎﺑﻌﻲ ﺑﺮﺍي ﻣﻄﺎﻟﻌﻪ ي ﺑﻴﺸﺘﺮ Buss,D.M.( ١٩٩٩ ). Evolutionary psychology : The new science of the mind. Boston : Allyn & Bacon. ﺍﻭﻟﻴﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺩﺭﺳﻲ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﻧﺸﻨﺎﺳﻲ ﺗﮑﺎﻣﻠﻲ ﺍﺳﺖ ﻭ ﺑﻪ ﺧﻮﺑﻲ ﺿﻌﻒ ﻫﺎ ﻭ ﻗﻮﺕ ﻫﺎي ﺍﻳﻦ،ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ .ﺭﻭﻳﮑﺮﺩ ﺭﺍ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﮐﺮﺩﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ Kalat , J.W. ( ٢٠٠٠ ). Biological psychology ( ٧th ed. ) Belmont , CA : Wadsworth. .ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺷﺎﻣﻞ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤﺎﺕ ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﺩﺳﺘﺮﺱ ﺩﺭ ﺯﻣﻴﻨﻪ ي ﺳﻴﺴﺘﻢ ﻋﺼﺒﻲ ﻭ ﺗﺎﺛﻴﺮ ﺁﻥ ﺑﺮ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﻣﻲ ﺑﺎﺷﺪ Rosensweig , M. R. , Breedlove , S.M. , % Leiman , A. L. ( ٢٠٠٢ ). Biological psychology : An introduction to behavioural , cognitive , and clinical neuroscience ( ٣rd ed. ) Sunderland, MA: Sinauer Associates. .ﺍﺳﺎﺱ ﺯﻳﺴﺘﻲ ﺭﻓﺘﺎﺭ ﺑﺎ ﺗﻤﺎﻡ ﺟﺰﺋﻴﺎﺕ ﺩﺭ ﺍﻳﻦ ﮐﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﺮﺭﺳﻲ ﺷﺪﻩ ﺍﺳﺖ